From 3562e78743202e43aec8727005182a2558117eca Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: marha Date: Sun, 28 Jun 2009 22:07:26 +0000 Subject: Checked in the following released items: xkeyboard-config-1.4.tar.gz ttf-bitstream-vera-1.10.tar.gz font-alias-1.0.1.tar.gz font-sun-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-sun-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-sony-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-schumacher-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-mutt-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-misc-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-misc-meltho-1.0.0.tar.gz font-micro-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-jis-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-isas-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-dec-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-daewoo-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-cursor-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-arabic-misc-1.0.0.tar.gz font-winitzki-cyrillic-1.0.0.tar.gz font-misc-cyrillic-1.0.0.tar.gz font-cronyx-cyrillic-1.0.0.tar.gz font-screen-cyrillic-1.0.1.tar.gz font-xfree86-type1-1.0.1.tar.gz font-adobe-utopia-type1-1.0.1.tar.gz font-ibm-type1-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bitstream-type1-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bitstream-speedo-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bh-ttf-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bh-type1-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bitstream-100dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bh-lucidatypewriter-100dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bh-100dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz font-adobe-utopia-100dpi-1.0.1.tar.gz font-adobe-100dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz font-util-1.0.1.tar.gz font-bitstream-75dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz font-bh-lucidatypewriter-75dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz font-adobe-utopia-75dpi-1.0.1.tar.gz font-bh-75dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz bdftopcf-1.0.1.tar.gz font-adobe-75dpi-1.0.0.tar.gz mkfontscale-1.0.6.tar.gz openssl-0.9.8k.tar.gz bigreqsproto-1.0.2.tar.gz xtrans-1.2.2.tar.gz resourceproto-1.0.2.tar.gz inputproto-1.4.4.tar.gz compositeproto-0.4.tar.gz damageproto-1.1.0.tar.gz zlib-1.2.3.tar.gz xkbcomp-1.0.5.tar.gz freetype-2.3.9.tar.gz pthreads-w32-2-8-0-release.tar.gz pixman-0.12.0.tar.gz kbproto-1.0.3.tar.gz evieext-1.0.2.tar.gz fixesproto-4.0.tar.gz recordproto-1.13.2.tar.gz randrproto-1.2.2.tar.gz scrnsaverproto-1.1.0.tar.gz renderproto-0.9.3.tar.gz xcmiscproto-1.1.2.tar.gz fontsproto-2.0.2.tar.gz xextproto-7.0.3.tar.gz xproto-7.0.14.tar.gz libXdmcp-1.0.2.tar.gz libxkbfile-1.0.5.tar.gz libfontenc-1.0.4.tar.gz libXfont-1.3.4.tar.gz libX11-1.1.5.tar.gz libXau-1.0.4.tar.gz libxcb-1.1.tar.gz xorg-server-1.5.3.tar.gz --- openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_OBJECT_new.pod | 43 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_length.pod | 81 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_new.pod | 44 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_print_ex.pod | 96 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_generate_nconf.pod | 262 +++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_ctrl.pod | 128 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_base64.pod | 81 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_buffer.pod | 69 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_cipher.pod | 76 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_md.pod | 138 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_null.pod | 32 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_ssl.pod | 313 +++++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_find_type.pod | 98 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_new.pod | 65 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_push.pod | 69 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_read.pod | 66 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_accept.pod | 195 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_bio.pod | 182 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_connect.pod | 192 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_fd.pod | 89 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_file.pod | 144 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_mem.pod | 115 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_null.pod | 37 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_socket.pod | 63 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_set_callback.pod | 108 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_should_retry.pod | 114 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_BLINDING_new.pod | 109 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_new.pod | 53 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_start.pod | 52 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add.pod | 126 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add_word.pod | 61 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_bn2bin.pod | 95 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_cmp.pod | 48 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_copy.pod | 34 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_generate_prime.pod | 102 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_inverse.pod | 36 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_montgomery.pod | 101 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_reciprocal.pod | 81 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_new.pod | 53 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_num_bytes.pod | 57 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_rand.pod | 58 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_set_bit.pod | 66 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/BN_swap.pod | 23 + openssl/doc/crypto/BN_zero.pod | 59 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_free.pod | 47 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_load_file.pod | 60 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/CRYPTO_set_ex_data.pod | 51 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_key.pod | 50 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_parameters.pod | 73 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/DH_get_ex_new_index.pod | 36 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DH_new.pod | 40 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DH_set_method.pod | 129 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/DH_size.pod | 33 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_SIG_new.pod | 40 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_do_sign.pod | 47 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_dup_DH.pod | 36 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_key.pod | 34 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_parameters.pod | 105 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_get_ex_new_index.pod | 36 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_new.pod | 42 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_set_method.pod | 143 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_sign.pod | 66 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_size.pod | 33 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_GET_LIB.pod | 51 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_clear_error.pod | 29 + openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_error_string.pod | 73 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_get_error.pod | 76 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_crypto_strings.pod | 46 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_strings.pod | 54 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_print_errors.pod | 51 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_put_error.pod | 44 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_remove_state.pod | 34 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_set_mark.pod | 38 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_BytesToKey.pod | 67 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_DigestInit.pod | 256 +++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_EncryptInit.pod | 511 ++++++++++++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_OpenInit.pod | 63 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_new.pod | 47 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA.pod | 80 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SealInit.pod | 85 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SignInit.pod | 95 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_VerifyInit.pod | 86 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/OBJ_nid2obj.pod | 149 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_Applink.pod | 21 + openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER.pod | 101 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_config.pod | 82 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_ia32cap.pod | 43 ++ .../doc/crypto/OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules.pod | 51 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms.pod | 66 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_create.pod | 75 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_parse.pod | 50 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_decrypt.pod | 53 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_encrypt.pod | 65 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_sign.pod | 101 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_verify.pod | 116 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_add.pod | 77 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_bytes.pod | 50 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_cleanup.pod | 29 + openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_egd.pod | 88 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_load_file.pod | 53 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_set_rand_method.pod | 83 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_blinding_on.pod | 43 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_check_key.pod | 67 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_generate_key.pod | 69 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_get_ex_new_index.pod | 120 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_new.pod | 41 ++ .../doc/crypto/RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1.pod | 124 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_print.pod | 49 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_private_encrypt.pod | 70 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_public_encrypt.pod | 84 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_set_method.pod | 202 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign.pod | 62 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING.pod | 59 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_size.pod | 33 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_read_PKCS7.pod | 71 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_write_PKCS7.pod | 61 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object.pod | 72 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt.pod | 114 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID.pod | 106 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_print_ex.pod | 105 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/X509_new.pod | 37 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/bio.pod | 54 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/blowfish.pod | 112 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/bn.pod | 181 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/bn_internal.pod | 226 ++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/buffer.pod | 73 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/crypto.pod | 85 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_ASN1_OBJECT.pod | 29 + openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DHparams.pod | 30 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DSAPublicKey.pod | 83 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey.pod | 56 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_RSAPublicKey.pod | 67 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509.pod | 231 ++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_ALGOR.pod | 30 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_CRL.pod | 37 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_NAME.pod | 31 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_REQ.pod | 36 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_SIG.pod | 30 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/des.pod | 358 ++++++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/des_modes.pod | 255 +++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/dh.pod | 78 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/dsa.pod | 114 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/ecdsa.pod | 210 ++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/engine.pod | 599 +++++++++++++++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/err.pod | 187 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/evp.pod | 45 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/hmac.pod | 102 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/lh_stats.pod | 60 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/lhash.pod | 294 ++++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/md5.pod | 101 ++++ openssl/doc/crypto/mdc2.pod | 64 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/pem.pod | 476 ++++++++++++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/rand.pod | 175 ++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/rc4.pod | 62 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/ripemd.pod | 66 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/rsa.pod | 123 +++++ openssl/doc/crypto/sha.pod | 70 +++ openssl/doc/crypto/threads.pod | 175 ++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/ui.pod | 194 +++++++ openssl/doc/crypto/ui_compat.pod | 55 ++ openssl/doc/crypto/x509.pod | 64 +++ 161 files changed, 15261 insertions(+) create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_OBJECT_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_length.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_print_ex.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_generate_nconf.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_ctrl.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_base64.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_buffer.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_cipher.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_md.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_null.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_ssl.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_find_type.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_push.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_read.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_accept.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_bio.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_connect.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_fd.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_file.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_mem.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_null.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_socket.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_set_callback.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_should_retry.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_BLINDING_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_start.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add_word.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_bn2bin.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_cmp.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_copy.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_generate_prime.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_inverse.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_montgomery.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_reciprocal.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_num_bytes.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_rand.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_set_bit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_swap.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/BN_zero.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_free.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_load_file.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/CRYPTO_set_ex_data.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_key.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_parameters.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DH_get_ex_new_index.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DH_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DH_set_method.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DH_size.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_SIG_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_do_sign.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_dup_DH.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_key.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_parameters.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_get_ex_new_index.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_set_method.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_sign.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_size.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_GET_LIB.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_clear_error.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_error_string.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_get_error.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_crypto_strings.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_strings.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_print_errors.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_put_error.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_remove_state.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_set_mark.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_BytesToKey.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_DigestInit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_EncryptInit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_OpenInit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SealInit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SignInit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_VerifyInit.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OBJ_nid2obj.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_Applink.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_config.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_ia32cap.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_create.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_parse.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_decrypt.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_encrypt.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_sign.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_verify.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_add.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_bytes.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_cleanup.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_egd.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_load_file.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_set_rand_method.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_blinding_on.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_check_key.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_generate_key.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_get_ex_new_index.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_print.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_private_encrypt.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_public_encrypt.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_set_method.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_size.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_read_PKCS7.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_write_PKCS7.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_print_ex.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/X509_new.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/bio.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/blowfish.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/bn.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/bn_internal.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/buffer.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/crypto.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_ASN1_OBJECT.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DHparams.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DSAPublicKey.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_RSAPublicKey.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_ALGOR.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_CRL.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_NAME.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_REQ.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_SIG.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/des.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/des_modes.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/dh.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/dsa.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ecdsa.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/engine.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/err.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/evp.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/hmac.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/lh_stats.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/lhash.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/md5.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/mdc2.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/pem.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/rand.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/rc4.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ripemd.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/rsa.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/sha.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/threads.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ui.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/ui_compat.pod create mode 100644 openssl/doc/crypto/x509.pod (limited to 'openssl/doc/crypto') diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_OBJECT_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_OBJECT_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..51679bfcd --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_OBJECT_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ASN1_OBJECT_new, ASN1_OBJECT_free, - object allocation functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + ASN1_OBJECT *ASN1_OBJECT_new(void); + void ASN1_OBJECT_free(ASN1_OBJECT *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The ASN1_OBJECT allocation routines, allocate and free an +ASN1_OBJECT structure, which represents an ASN1 OBJECT IDENTIFIER. + +ASN1_OBJECT_new() allocates and initializes a ASN1_OBJECT structure. + +ASN1_OBJECT_free() frees up the B structure B. + +=head1 NOTES + +Although ASN1_OBJECT_new() allocates a new ASN1_OBJECT structure it +is almost never used in applications. The ASN1 object utility functions +such as OBJ_nid2obj() are used instead. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +If the allocation fails, ASN1_OBJECT_new() returns B and sets an error +code that can be obtained by L. +Otherwise it returns a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +ASN1_OBJECT_free() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ASN1_OBJECT_new() and ASN1_OBJECT_free() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_length.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_length.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..c4ec693f1 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_length.pod @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ASN1_STRING_dup, ASN1_STRING_cmp, ASN1_STRING_set, ASN1_STRING_length, +ASN1_STRING_length_set, ASN1_STRING_type, ASN1_STRING_data - +ASN1_STRING utility functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + int ASN1_STRING_length(ASN1_STRING *x); + unsigned char * ASN1_STRING_data(ASN1_STRING *x); + + ASN1_STRING * ASN1_STRING_dup(ASN1_STRING *a); + + int ASN1_STRING_cmp(ASN1_STRING *a, ASN1_STRING *b); + + int ASN1_STRING_set(ASN1_STRING *str, const void *data, int len); + + int ASN1_STRING_type(ASN1_STRING *x); + + int ASN1_STRING_to_UTF8(unsigned char **out, ASN1_STRING *in); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions allow an B structure to be manipulated. + +ASN1_STRING_length() returns the length of the content of B. + +ASN1_STRING_data() returns an internal pointer to the data of B. +Since this is an internal pointer it should B be freed or +modified in any way. + +ASN1_STRING_dup() returns a copy of the structure B. + +ASN1_STRING_cmp() compares B and B returning 0 if the two +are identical. The string types and content are compared. + +ASN1_STRING_set() sets the data of string B to the buffer +B or length B. The supplied data is copied. If B +is -1 then the length is determined by strlen(data). + +ASN1_STRING_type() returns the type of B, using standard constants +such as B. + +ASN1_STRING_to_UTF8() converts the string B to UTF8 format, the +converted data is allocated in a buffer in B<*out>. The length of +B is returned or a negative error code. The buffer B<*out> +should be free using OPENSSL_free(). + +=head1 NOTES + +Almost all ASN1 types in OpenSSL are represented as an B +structure. Other types such as B are simply typedefed +to B and the functions call the B equivalents. +B is also used for some B types which consist +entirely of primitive string types such as B and +B. + +=head1 NOTES + +Other string types call the B functions. For example +ASN1_OCTET_STRING_new() calls ASN1_STRING_type(V_ASN1_OCTET_STRING). + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ASN1_STRING_new() and ASN1_STRING_type_new() return a valid +ASN1_STRING structure or B if an error occurred. + +ASN1_STRING_free() does not return a value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_print_ex.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_print_ex.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3891b8879 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_STRING_print_ex.pod @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ASN1_STRING_print_ex, ASN1_STRING_print_ex_fp - ASN1_STRING output routines. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int ASN1_STRING_print_ex(BIO *out, ASN1_STRING *str, unsigned long flags); + int ASN1_STRING_print_ex_fp(FILE *fp, ASN1_STRING *str, unsigned long flags); + int ASN1_STRING_print(BIO *out, ASN1_STRING *str); + + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions output an B structure. B is used to +represent all the ASN1 string types. + +ASN1_STRING_print_ex() outputs B to B, the format is determined by +the options B. ASN1_STRING_print_ex_fp() is identical except it outputs +to B instead. + +ASN1_STRING_print() prints B to B but using a different format to +ASN1_STRING_print_ex(). It replaces unprintable characters (other than CR, LF) +with '.'. + +=head1 NOTES + +ASN1_STRING_print() is a legacy function which should be avoided in new applications. + +Although there are a large number of options frequently B is +suitable, or on UTF8 terminals B. + +The complete set of supported options for B is listed below. + +Various characters can be escaped. If B is set the characters +determined by RFC2253 are escaped. If B is set control +characters are escaped. If B is set characters with the +MSB set are escaped: this option should B be used if the terminal correctly +interprets UTF8 sequences. + +Escaping takes several forms. + +If the character being escaped is a 16 bit character then the form "\UXXXX" is used +using exactly four characters for the hex representation. If it is 32 bits then +"\WXXXXXXXX" is used using eight characters of its hex representation. These forms +will only be used if UTF8 conversion is not set (see below). + +Printable characters are normally escaped using the backslash '\' character. If +B is set then the whole string is instead surrounded by +double quote characters: this is arguably more readable than the backslash +notation. Other characters use the "\XX" using exactly two characters of the hex +representation. + +If B is set then characters are converted to UTF8 +format first. If the terminal supports the display of UTF8 sequences then this +option will correctly display multi byte characters. + +If B is set then the string type is not interpreted at +all: everything is assumed to be one byte per character. This is primarily for +debugging purposes and can result in confusing output in multi character strings. + +If B is set then the string type itself is printed out +before its value (for example "BMPSTRING"), this actually uses ASN1_tag2str(). + +The content of a string instead of being interpreted can be "dumped": this just +outputs the value of the string using the form #XXXX using hex format for each +octet. + +If B is set then any type is dumped. + +Normally non character string types (such as OCTET STRING) are assumed to be +one byte per character, if B is set then they will +be dumped instead. + +When a type is dumped normally just the content octets are printed, if +B is set then the complete encoding is dumped +instead (including tag and length octets). + +B includes all the flags required by RFC2253. It is +equivalent to: + ASN1_STRFLGS_ESC_2253 | ASN1_STRFLGS_ESC_CTRL | ASN1_STRFLGS_ESC_MSB | + ASN1_STRFLGS_UTF8_CONVERT | ASN1_STRFLGS_DUMP_UNKNOWN ASN1_STRFLGS_DUMP_DER + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_generate_nconf.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_generate_nconf.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1157cff51 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ASN1_generate_nconf.pod @@ -0,0 +1,262 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ASN1_generate_nconf, ASN1_generate_v3 - ASN1 generation functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + ASN1_TYPE *ASN1_generate_nconf(char *str, CONF *nconf); + ASN1_TYPE *ASN1_generate_v3(char *str, X509V3_CTX *cnf); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions generate the ASN1 encoding of a string +in an B structure. + +B contains the string to encode B or B contains +the optional configuration information where additional strings +will be read from. B will typically come from a config +file wherease B is obtained from an B structure +which will typically be used by X509 v3 certificate extension +functions. B or B can be set to B if no additional +configuration will be used. + +=head1 GENERATION STRING FORMAT + +The actual data encoded is determined by the string B and +the configuration information. The general format of the string +is: + +=over 2 + +=item B<[modifier,]type[:value]> + +=back + +That is zero or more comma separated modifiers followed by a type +followed by an optional colon and a value. The formats of B, +B and B are explained below. + +=head2 SUPPORTED TYPES + +The supported types are listed below. Unless otherwise specified +only the B format is permissible. + +=over 2 + +=item B, B + +This encodes a boolean type. The B string is mandatory and +should be B or B. Additionally B, B, B, +B, B, B, B, B, B, B, B and B +are acceptable. + +=item B + +Encode the B type, the B string must not be present. + +=item B, B + +Encodes an ASN1 B type. The B string represents +the value of the integer, it can be preceeded by a minus sign and +is normally interpreted as a decimal value unless the prefix B<0x> +is included. + +=item B, B + +Encodes the ASN1 B type, it is otherwise identical to +B. + +=item B, B + +Encodes an ASN1 B, the B string can be +a short name, a long name or numerical format. + +=item B, B + +Encodes an ASN1 B structure, the value should be in +the format B. + +=item B, B + +Encodes an ASN1 B structure, the value should be in +the format B. + +=item B, B + +Encodes an ASN1 B. B represents the contents +of this structure, the format strings B and B can be +used to specify the format of B. + +=item B, B + +Encodes an ASN1 B. B represents the contents +of this structure, the format strings B, B and B +can be used to specify the format of B. + +If the format is anything other than B the number of unused +bits is set to zero. + +=item B, B, B, B, B, +B, B, B, B, +B, B, B, B, +B, B, B + +These encode the corresponding string types. B represents the +contents of this structure. The format can be B or B. + +=item B, B, B + +Formats the result as an ASN1 B or B type. B +should be a section name which will contain the contents. The +field names in the section are ignored and the values are in the +generated string format. If B is absent then an empty SEQUENCE +will be encoded. + +=back + +=head2 MODIFIERS + +Modifiers affect the following structure, they can be used to +add EXPLICIT or IMPLICIT tagging, add wrappers or to change +the string format of the final type and value. The supported +formats are documented below. + +=over 2 + +=item B, B + +Add an explicit tag to the following structure. This string +should be followed by a colon and the tag value to use as a +decimal value. + +By following the number with B, B, B

or B UNIVERSAL, +APPLICATION, PRIVATE or CONTEXT SPECIFIC tagging can be used, +the default is CONTEXT SPECIFIC. + +=item B, B + +This is the same as B except IMPLICIT tagging is used +instead. + +=item B, B, B, B + +The following structure is surrounded by an OCTET STRING, a SEQUENCE, +a SET or a BIT STRING respectively. For a BIT STRING the number of unused +bits is set to zero. + +=item B + +This specifies the format of the ultimate value. It should be followed +by a colon and one of the strings B, B, B or B. + +If no format specifier is included then B is used. If B is +specified then the value string must be a valid B string. For B the +output must be a set of hex digits. B (which is only valid for a BIT +STRING) is a comma separated list of the indices of the set bits, all other +bits are zero. + +=back + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +A simple IA5String: + + IA5STRING:Hello World + +An IA5String explicitly tagged: + + EXPLICIT:0,IA5STRING:Hello World + +An IA5String explicitly tagged using APPLICATION tagging: + + EXPLICIT:0A,IA5STRING:Hello World + +A BITSTRING with bits 1 and 5 set and all others zero: + + FORMAT=BITLIST,BITSTRING:1,5 + +A more complex example using a config file to produce a +SEQUENCE consiting of a BOOL an OID and a UTF8String: + + asn1 = SEQUENCE:seq_section + + [seq_section] + + field1 = BOOLEAN:TRUE + field2 = OID:commonName + field3 = UTF8:Third field + +This example produces an RSAPrivateKey structure, this is the +key contained in the file client.pem in all OpenSSL distributions +(note: the field names such as 'coeff' are ignored and are present just +for clarity): + + asn1=SEQUENCE:private_key + [private_key] + version=INTEGER:0 + + n=INTEGER:0xBB6FE79432CC6EA2D8F970675A5A87BFBE1AFF0BE63E879F2AFFB93644\ + D4D2C6D000430DEC66ABF47829E74B8C5108623A1C0EE8BE217B3AD8D36D5EB4FCA1D9 + + e=INTEGER:0x010001 + + d=INTEGER:0x6F05EAD2F27FFAEC84BEC360C4B928FD5F3A9865D0FCAAD291E2A52F4A\ + F810DC6373278C006A0ABBA27DC8C63BF97F7E666E27C5284D7D3B1FFFE16B7A87B51D + + p=INTEGER:0xF3929B9435608F8A22C208D86795271D54EBDFB09DDEF539AB083DA912\ + D4BD57 + + q=INTEGER:0xC50016F89DFF2561347ED1186A46E150E28BF2D0F539A1594BBD7FE467\ + 46EC4F + + exp1=INTEGER:0x9E7D4326C924AFC1DEA40B45650134966D6F9DFA3A7F9D698CD4ABEA\ + 9C0A39B9 + + exp2=INTEGER:0xBA84003BB95355AFB7C50DF140C60513D0BA51D637272E355E397779\ + E7B2458F + + coeff=INTEGER:0x30B9E4F2AFA5AC679F920FC83F1F2DF1BAF1779CF989447FABC2F5\ + 628657053A + +This example is the corresponding public key in a SubjectPublicKeyInfo +structure: + + # Start with a SEQUENCE + asn1=SEQUENCE:pubkeyinfo + + # pubkeyinfo contains an algorithm identifier and the public key wrapped + # in a BIT STRING + [pubkeyinfo] + algorithm=SEQUENCE:rsa_alg + pubkey=BITWRAP,SEQUENCE:rsapubkey + + # algorithm ID for RSA is just an OID and a NULL + [rsa_alg] + algorithm=OID:rsaEncryption + parameter=NULL + + # Actual public key: modulus and exponent + [rsapubkey] + n=INTEGER:0xBB6FE79432CC6EA2D8F970675A5A87BFBE1AFF0BE63E879F2AFFB93644\ + D4D2C6D000430DEC66ABF47829E74B8C5108623A1C0EE8BE217B3AD8D36D5EB4FCA1D9 + + e=INTEGER:0x010001 + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ASN1_generate_nconf() and ASN1_generate_v3() return the encoded +data as an B structure or B if an error occurred. + +The error codes that can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ASN1_generate_nconf() and ASN1_generate_v3() were added to OpenSSL 0.9.8 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_ctrl.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_ctrl.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..722e8b8f4 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_ctrl.pod @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_ctrl, BIO_callback_ctrl, BIO_ptr_ctrl, BIO_int_ctrl, BIO_reset, +BIO_seek, BIO_tell, BIO_flush, BIO_eof, BIO_set_close, BIO_get_close, +BIO_pending, BIO_wpending, BIO_ctrl_pending, BIO_ctrl_wpending, +BIO_get_info_callback, BIO_set_info_callback - BIO control operations + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + long BIO_ctrl(BIO *bp,int cmd,long larg,void *parg); + long BIO_callback_ctrl(BIO *b, int cmd, void (*fp)(struct bio_st *, int, const char *, int, long, long)); + char * BIO_ptr_ctrl(BIO *bp,int cmd,long larg); + long BIO_int_ctrl(BIO *bp,int cmd,long larg,int iarg); + + int BIO_reset(BIO *b); + int BIO_seek(BIO *b, int ofs); + int BIO_tell(BIO *b); + int BIO_flush(BIO *b); + int BIO_eof(BIO *b); + int BIO_set_close(BIO *b,long flag); + int BIO_get_close(BIO *b); + int BIO_pending(BIO *b); + int BIO_wpending(BIO *b); + size_t BIO_ctrl_pending(BIO *b); + size_t BIO_ctrl_wpending(BIO *b); + + int BIO_get_info_callback(BIO *b,bio_info_cb **cbp); + int BIO_set_info_callback(BIO *b,bio_info_cb *cb); + + typedef void bio_info_cb(BIO *b, int oper, const char *ptr, int arg1, long arg2, long arg3); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_ctrl(), BIO_callback_ctrl(), BIO_ptr_ctrl() and BIO_int_ctrl() +are BIO "control" operations taking arguments of various types. +These functions are not normally called directly, various macros +are used instead. The standard macros are described below, macros +specific to a particular type of BIO are described in the specific +BIOs manual page as well as any special features of the standard +calls. + +BIO_reset() typically resets a BIO to some initial state, in the case +of file related BIOs for example it rewinds the file pointer to the +start of the file. + +BIO_seek() resets a file related BIO's (that is file descriptor and +FILE BIOs) file position pointer to B bytes from start of file. + +BIO_tell() returns the current file position of a file related BIO. + +BIO_flush() normally writes out any internally buffered data, in some +cases it is used to signal EOF and that no more data will be written. + +BIO_eof() returns 1 if the BIO has read EOF, the precise meaning of +"EOF" varies according to the BIO type. + +BIO_set_close() sets the BIO B close flag to B. B can +take the value BIO_CLOSE or BIO_NOCLOSE. Typically BIO_CLOSE is used +in a source/sink BIO to indicate that the underlying I/O stream should +be closed when the BIO is freed. + +BIO_get_close() returns the BIOs close flag. + +BIO_pending(), BIO_ctrl_pending(), BIO_wpending() and BIO_ctrl_wpending() +return the number of pending characters in the BIOs read and write buffers. +Not all BIOs support these calls. BIO_ctrl_pending() and BIO_ctrl_wpending() +return a size_t type and are functions, BIO_pending() and BIO_wpending() are +macros which call BIO_ctrl(). + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_reset() normally returns 1 for success and 0 or -1 for failure. File +BIOs are an exception, they return 0 for success and -1 for failure. + +BIO_seek() and BIO_tell() both return the current file position on success +and -1 for failure, except file BIOs which for BIO_seek() always return 0 +for success and -1 for failure. + +BIO_flush() returns 1 for success and 0 or -1 for failure. + +BIO_eof() returns 1 if EOF has been reached 0 otherwise. + +BIO_set_close() always returns 1. + +BIO_get_close() returns the close flag value: BIO_CLOSE or BIO_NOCLOSE. + +BIO_pending(), BIO_ctrl_pending(), BIO_wpending() and BIO_ctrl_wpending() +return the amount of pending data. + +=head1 NOTES + +BIO_flush(), because it can write data may return 0 or -1 indicating +that the call should be retried later in a similar manner to BIO_write(). +The BIO_should_retry() call should be used and appropriate action taken +is the call fails. + +The return values of BIO_pending() and BIO_wpending() may not reliably +determine the amount of pending data in all cases. For example in the +case of a file BIO some data may be available in the FILE structures +internal buffers but it is not possible to determine this in a +portably way. For other types of BIO they may not be supported. + +Filter BIOs if they do not internally handle a particular BIO_ctrl() +operation usually pass the operation to the next BIO in the chain. +This often means there is no need to locate the required BIO for +a particular operation, it can be called on a chain and it will +be automatically passed to the relevant BIO. However this can cause +unexpected results: for example no current filter BIOs implement +BIO_seek(), but this may still succeed if the chain ends in a FILE +or file descriptor BIO. + +Source/sink BIOs return an 0 if they do not recognize the BIO_ctrl() +operation. + +=head1 BUGS + +Some of the return values are ambiguous and care should be taken. In +particular a return value of 0 can be returned if an operation is not +supported, if an error occurred, if EOF has not been reached and in +the case of BIO_seek() on a file BIO for a successful operation. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_base64.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_base64.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..438af3b6b --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_base64.pod @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_f_base64 - base64 BIO filter + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_f_base64(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_f_base64() returns the base64 BIO method. This is a filter +BIO that base64 encodes any data written through it and decodes +any data read through it. + +Base64 BIOs do not support BIO_gets() or BIO_puts(). + +BIO_flush() on a base64 BIO that is being written through is +used to signal that no more data is to be encoded: this is used +to flush the final block through the BIO. + +The flag BIO_FLAGS_BASE64_NO_NL can be set with BIO_set_flags() +to encode the data all on one line or expect the data to be all +on one line. + +=head1 NOTES + +Because of the format of base64 encoding the end of the encoded +block cannot always be reliably determined. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_f_base64() returns the base64 BIO method. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Base64 encode the string "Hello World\n" and write the result +to standard output: + + BIO *bio, *b64; + char message[] = "Hello World \n"; + + b64 = BIO_new(BIO_f_base64()); + bio = BIO_new_fp(stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE); + bio = BIO_push(b64, bio); + BIO_write(bio, message, strlen(message)); + BIO_flush(bio); + + BIO_free_all(bio); + +Read Base64 encoded data from standard input and write the decoded +data to standard output: + + BIO *bio, *b64, *bio_out; + char inbuf[512]; + int inlen; + + b64 = BIO_new(BIO_f_base64()); + bio = BIO_new_fp(stdin, BIO_NOCLOSE); + bio_out = BIO_new_fp(stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE); + bio = BIO_push(b64, bio); + while((inlen = BIO_read(bio, inbuf, 512)) > 0) + BIO_write(bio_out, inbuf, inlen); + + BIO_free_all(bio); + +=head1 BUGS + +The ambiguity of EOF in base64 encoded data can cause additional +data following the base64 encoded block to be misinterpreted. + +There should be some way of specifying a test that the BIO can perform +to reliably determine EOF (for example a MIME boundary). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_buffer.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_buffer.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..c9093c6a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_buffer.pod @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_f_buffer - buffering BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_f_buffer(void); + + #define BIO_get_buffer_num_lines(b) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_GET_BUFF_NUM_LINES,0,NULL) + #define BIO_set_read_buffer_size(b,size) BIO_int_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_BUFF_SIZE,size,0) + #define BIO_set_write_buffer_size(b,size) BIO_int_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_BUFF_SIZE,size,1) + #define BIO_set_buffer_size(b,size) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_BUFF_SIZE,size,NULL) + #define BIO_set_buffer_read_data(b,buf,num) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_BUFF_READ_DATA,num,buf) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_f_buffer() returns the buffering BIO method. + +Data written to a buffering BIO is buffered and periodically written +to the next BIO in the chain. Data read from a buffering BIO comes from +an internal buffer which is filled from the next BIO in the chain. +Both BIO_gets() and BIO_puts() are supported. + +Calling BIO_reset() on a buffering BIO clears any buffered data. + +BIO_get_buffer_num_lines() returns the number of lines currently buffered. + +BIO_set_read_buffer_size(), BIO_set_write_buffer_size() and BIO_set_buffer_size() +set the read, write or both read and write buffer sizes to B. The initial +buffer size is DEFAULT_BUFFER_SIZE, currently 1024. Any attempt to reduce the +buffer size below DEFAULT_BUFFER_SIZE is ignored. Any buffered data is cleared +when the buffer is resized. + +BIO_set_buffer_read_data() clears the read buffer and fills it with B +bytes of B. If B is larger than the current buffer size the buffer +is expanded. + +=head1 NOTES + +Buffering BIOs implement BIO_gets() by using BIO_read() operations on the +next BIO in the chain. By prepending a buffering BIO to a chain it is therefore +possible to provide BIO_gets() functionality if the following BIOs do not +support it (for example SSL BIOs). + +Data is only written to the next BIO in the chain when the write buffer fills +or when BIO_flush() is called. It is therefore important to call BIO_flush() +whenever any pending data should be written such as when removing a buffering +BIO using BIO_pop(). BIO_flush() may need to be retried if the ultimate +source/sink BIO is non blocking. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_f_buffer() returns the buffering BIO method. + +BIO_get_buffer_num_lines() returns the number of lines buffered (may be 0). + +BIO_set_read_buffer_size(), BIO_set_write_buffer_size() and BIO_set_buffer_size() +return 1 if the buffer was successfully resized or 0 for failure. + +BIO_set_buffer_read_data() returns 1 if the data was set correctly or 0 if +there was an error. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_cipher.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_cipher.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..02439cea9 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_cipher.pod @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_f_cipher, BIO_set_cipher, BIO_get_cipher_status, BIO_get_cipher_ctx - cipher BIO filter + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_f_cipher(void); + void BIO_set_cipher(BIO *b,const EVP_CIPHER *cipher, + unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv, int enc); + int BIO_get_cipher_status(BIO *b) + int BIO_get_cipher_ctx(BIO *b, EVP_CIPHER_CTX **pctx) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_f_cipher() returns the cipher BIO method. This is a filter +BIO that encrypts any data written through it, and decrypts any data +read from it. It is a BIO wrapper for the cipher routines +EVP_CipherInit(), EVP_CipherUpdate() and EVP_CipherFinal(). + +Cipher BIOs do not support BIO_gets() or BIO_puts(). + +BIO_flush() on an encryption BIO that is being written through is +used to signal that no more data is to be encrypted: this is used +to flush and possibly pad the final block through the BIO. + +BIO_set_cipher() sets the cipher of BIO B to B using key B +and IV B. B should be set to 1 for encryption and zero for +decryption. + +When reading from an encryption BIO the final block is automatically +decrypted and checked when EOF is detected. BIO_get_cipher_status() +is a BIO_ctrl() macro which can be called to determine whether the +decryption operation was successful. + +BIO_get_cipher_ctx() is a BIO_ctrl() macro which retrieves the internal +BIO cipher context. The retrieved context can be used in conjunction +with the standard cipher routines to set it up. This is useful when +BIO_set_cipher() is not flexible enough for the applications needs. + +=head1 NOTES + +When encrypting BIO_flush() B be called to flush the final block +through the BIO. If it is not then the final block will fail a subsequent +decrypt. + +When decrypting an error on the final block is signalled by a zero +return value from the read operation. A successful decrypt followed +by EOF will also return zero for the final read. BIO_get_cipher_status() +should be called to determine if the decrypt was successful. + +As always, if BIO_gets() or BIO_puts() support is needed then it can +be achieved by preceding the cipher BIO with a buffering BIO. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_f_cipher() returns the cipher BIO method. + +BIO_set_cipher() does not return a value. + +BIO_get_cipher_status() returns 1 for a successful decrypt and 0 +for failure. + +BIO_get_cipher_ctx() currently always returns 1. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +TBA + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_md.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_md.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..0d24083e6 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_md.pod @@ -0,0 +1,138 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_f_md, BIO_set_md, BIO_get_md, BIO_get_md_ctx - message digest BIO filter + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_f_md(void); + int BIO_set_md(BIO *b,EVP_MD *md); + int BIO_get_md(BIO *b,EVP_MD **mdp); + int BIO_get_md_ctx(BIO *b,EVP_MD_CTX **mdcp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_f_md() returns the message digest BIO method. This is a filter +BIO that digests any data passed through it, it is a BIO wrapper +for the digest routines EVP_DigestInit(), EVP_DigestUpdate() +and EVP_DigestFinal(). + +Any data written or read through a digest BIO using BIO_read() and +BIO_write() is digested. + +BIO_gets(), if its B parameter is large enough finishes the +digest calculation and returns the digest value. BIO_puts() is +not supported. + +BIO_reset() reinitialises a digest BIO. + +BIO_set_md() sets the message digest of BIO B to B: this +must be called to initialize a digest BIO before any data is +passed through it. It is a BIO_ctrl() macro. + +BIO_get_md() places the a pointer to the digest BIOs digest method +in B, it is a BIO_ctrl() macro. + +BIO_get_md_ctx() returns the digest BIOs context into B. + +=head1 NOTES + +The context returned by BIO_get_md_ctx() can be used in calls +to EVP_DigestFinal() and also the signature routines EVP_SignFinal() +and EVP_VerifyFinal(). + +The context returned by BIO_get_md_ctx() is an internal context +structure. Changes made to this context will affect the digest +BIO itself and the context pointer will become invalid when the digest +BIO is freed. + +After the digest has been retrieved from a digest BIO it must be +reinitialized by calling BIO_reset(), or BIO_set_md() before any more +data is passed through it. + +If an application needs to call BIO_gets() or BIO_puts() through +a chain containing digest BIOs then this can be done by prepending +a buffering BIO. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_f_md() returns the digest BIO method. + +BIO_set_md(), BIO_get_md() and BIO_md_ctx() return 1 for success and +0 for failure. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +The following example creates a BIO chain containing an SHA1 and MD5 +digest BIO and passes the string "Hello World" through it. Error +checking has been omitted for clarity. + + BIO *bio, *mdtmp; + char message[] = "Hello World"; + bio = BIO_new(BIO_s_null()); + mdtmp = BIO_new(BIO_f_md()); + BIO_set_md(mdtmp, EVP_sha1()); + /* For BIO_push() we want to append the sink BIO and keep a note of + * the start of the chain. + */ + bio = BIO_push(mdtmp, bio); + mdtmp = BIO_new(BIO_f_md()); + BIO_set_md(mdtmp, EVP_md5()); + bio = BIO_push(mdtmp, bio); + /* Note: mdtmp can now be discarded */ + BIO_write(bio, message, strlen(message)); + +The next example digests data by reading through a chain instead: + + BIO *bio, *mdtmp; + char buf[1024]; + int rdlen; + bio = BIO_new_file(file, "rb"); + mdtmp = BIO_new(BIO_f_md()); + BIO_set_md(mdtmp, EVP_sha1()); + bio = BIO_push(mdtmp, bio); + mdtmp = BIO_new(BIO_f_md()); + BIO_set_md(mdtmp, EVP_md5()); + bio = BIO_push(mdtmp, bio); + do { + rdlen = BIO_read(bio, buf, sizeof(buf)); + /* Might want to do something with the data here */ + } while(rdlen > 0); + +This next example retrieves the message digests from a BIO chain and +outputs them. This could be used with the examples above. + + BIO *mdtmp; + unsigned char mdbuf[EVP_MAX_MD_SIZE]; + int mdlen; + int i; + mdtmp = bio; /* Assume bio has previously been set up */ + do { + EVP_MD *md; + mdtmp = BIO_find_type(mdtmp, BIO_TYPE_MD); + if(!mdtmp) break; + BIO_get_md(mdtmp, &md); + printf("%s digest", OBJ_nid2sn(EVP_MD_type(md))); + mdlen = BIO_gets(mdtmp, mdbuf, EVP_MAX_MD_SIZE); + for(i = 0; i < mdlen; i++) printf(":%02X", mdbuf[i]); + printf("\n"); + mdtmp = BIO_next(mdtmp); + } while(mdtmp); + + BIO_free_all(bio); + +=head1 BUGS + +The lack of support for BIO_puts() and the non standard behaviour of +BIO_gets() could be regarded as anomalous. It could be argued that BIO_gets() +and BIO_puts() should be passed to the next BIO in the chain and digest +the data passed through and that digests should be retrieved using a +separate BIO_ctrl() call. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_null.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_null.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b057c1840 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_null.pod @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_f_null - null filter + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_f_null(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_f_null() returns the null filter BIO method. This is a filter BIO +that does nothing. + +All requests to a null filter BIO are passed through to the next BIO in +the chain: this means that a BIO chain containing a null filter BIO +behaves just as though the BIO was not there. + +=head1 NOTES + +As may be apparent a null filter BIO is not particularly useful. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_f_null() returns the null filter BIO method. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_ssl.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_ssl.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..f0b731731 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_f_ssl.pod @@ -0,0 +1,313 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_f_ssl, BIO_set_ssl, BIO_get_ssl, BIO_set_ssl_mode, BIO_set_ssl_renegotiate_bytes, +BIO_get_num_renegotiates, BIO_set_ssl_renegotiate_timeout, BIO_new_ssl, +BIO_new_ssl_connect, BIO_new_buffer_ssl_connect, BIO_ssl_copy_session_id, +BIO_ssl_shutdown - SSL BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + BIO_METHOD *BIO_f_ssl(void); + + #define BIO_set_ssl(b,ssl,c) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_SSL,c,(char *)ssl) + #define BIO_get_ssl(b,sslp) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_GET_SSL,0,(char *)sslp) + #define BIO_set_ssl_mode(b,client) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SSL_MODE,client,NULL) + #define BIO_set_ssl_renegotiate_bytes(b,num) \ + BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_SSL_RENEGOTIATE_BYTES,num,NULL); + #define BIO_set_ssl_renegotiate_timeout(b,seconds) \ + BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_SSL_RENEGOTIATE_TIMEOUT,seconds,NULL); + #define BIO_get_num_renegotiates(b) \ + BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_SSL_NUM_RENEGOTIATES,0,NULL); + + BIO *BIO_new_ssl(SSL_CTX *ctx,int client); + BIO *BIO_new_ssl_connect(SSL_CTX *ctx); + BIO *BIO_new_buffer_ssl_connect(SSL_CTX *ctx); + int BIO_ssl_copy_session_id(BIO *to,BIO *from); + void BIO_ssl_shutdown(BIO *bio); + + #define BIO_do_handshake(b) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_DO_STATE_MACHINE,0,NULL) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_f_ssl() returns the SSL BIO method. This is a filter BIO which +is a wrapper round the OpenSSL SSL routines adding a BIO "flavour" to +SSL I/O. + +I/O performed on an SSL BIO communicates using the SSL protocol with +the SSLs read and write BIOs. If an SSL connection is not established +then an attempt is made to establish one on the first I/O call. + +If a BIO is appended to an SSL BIO using BIO_push() it is automatically +used as the SSL BIOs read and write BIOs. + +Calling BIO_reset() on an SSL BIO closes down any current SSL connection +by calling SSL_shutdown(). BIO_reset() is then sent to the next BIO in +the chain: this will typically disconnect the underlying transport. +The SSL BIO is then reset to the initial accept or connect state. + +If the close flag is set when an SSL BIO is freed then the internal +SSL structure is also freed using SSL_free(). + +BIO_set_ssl() sets the internal SSL pointer of BIO B to B using +the close flag B. + +BIO_get_ssl() retrieves the SSL pointer of BIO B, it can then be +manipulated using the standard SSL library functions. + +BIO_set_ssl_mode() sets the SSL BIO mode to B. If B +is 1 client mode is set. If B is 0 server mode is set. + +BIO_set_ssl_renegotiate_bytes() sets the renegotiate byte count +to B. When set after every B bytes of I/O (read and write) +the SSL session is automatically renegotiated. B must be at +least 512 bytes. + +BIO_set_ssl_renegotiate_timeout() sets the renegotiate timeout to +B. When the renegotiate timeout elapses the session is +automatically renegotiated. + +BIO_get_num_renegotiates() returns the total number of session +renegotiations due to I/O or timeout. + +BIO_new_ssl() allocates an SSL BIO using SSL_CTX B and using +client mode if B is non zero. + +BIO_new_ssl_connect() creates a new BIO chain consisting of an +SSL BIO (using B) followed by a connect BIO. + +BIO_new_buffer_ssl_connect() creates a new BIO chain consisting +of a buffering BIO, an SSL BIO (using B) and a connect +BIO. + +BIO_ssl_copy_session_id() copies an SSL session id between +BIO chains B and B. It does this by locating the +SSL BIOs in each chain and calling SSL_copy_session_id() on +the internal SSL pointer. + +BIO_ssl_shutdown() closes down an SSL connection on BIO +chain B. It does this by locating the SSL BIO in the +chain and calling SSL_shutdown() on its internal SSL +pointer. + +BIO_do_handshake() attempts to complete an SSL handshake on the +supplied BIO and establish the SSL connection. It returns 1 +if the connection was established successfully. A zero or negative +value is returned if the connection could not be established, the +call BIO_should_retry() should be used for non blocking connect BIOs +to determine if the call should be retried. If an SSL connection has +already been established this call has no effect. + +=head1 NOTES + +SSL BIOs are exceptional in that if the underlying transport +is non blocking they can still request a retry in exceptional +circumstances. Specifically this will happen if a session +renegotiation takes place during a BIO_read() operation, one +case where this happens is when SGC or step up occurs. + +In OpenSSL 0.9.6 and later the SSL flag SSL_AUTO_RETRY can be +set to disable this behaviour. That is when this flag is set +an SSL BIO using a blocking transport will never request a +retry. + +Since unknown BIO_ctrl() operations are sent through filter +BIOs the servers name and port can be set using BIO_set_host() +on the BIO returned by BIO_new_ssl_connect() without having +to locate the connect BIO first. + +Applications do not have to call BIO_do_handshake() but may wish +to do so to separate the handshake process from other I/O +processing. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +TBA + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +This SSL/TLS client example, attempts to retrieve a page from an +SSL/TLS web server. The I/O routines are identical to those of the +unencrypted example in L. + + BIO *sbio, *out; + int len; + char tmpbuf[1024]; + SSL_CTX *ctx; + SSL *ssl; + + ERR_load_crypto_strings(); + ERR_load_SSL_strings(); + OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms(); + + /* We would seed the PRNG here if the platform didn't + * do it automatically + */ + + ctx = SSL_CTX_new(SSLv23_client_method()); + + /* We'd normally set some stuff like the verify paths and + * mode here because as things stand this will connect to + * any server whose certificate is signed by any CA. + */ + + sbio = BIO_new_ssl_connect(ctx); + + BIO_get_ssl(sbio, &ssl); + + if(!ssl) { + fprintf(stderr, "Can't locate SSL pointer\n"); + /* whatever ... */ + } + + /* Don't want any retries */ + SSL_set_mode(ssl, SSL_MODE_AUTO_RETRY); + + /* We might want to do other things with ssl here */ + + BIO_set_conn_hostname(sbio, "localhost:https"); + + out = BIO_new_fp(stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE); + if(BIO_do_connect(sbio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error connecting to server\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + /* whatever ... */ + } + + if(BIO_do_handshake(sbio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error establishing SSL connection\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + /* whatever ... */ + } + + /* Could examine ssl here to get connection info */ + + BIO_puts(sbio, "GET / HTTP/1.0\n\n"); + for(;;) { + len = BIO_read(sbio, tmpbuf, 1024); + if(len <= 0) break; + BIO_write(out, tmpbuf, len); + } + BIO_free_all(sbio); + BIO_free(out); + +Here is a simple server example. It makes use of a buffering +BIO to allow lines to be read from the SSL BIO using BIO_gets. +It creates a pseudo web page containing the actual request from +a client and also echoes the request to standard output. + + BIO *sbio, *bbio, *acpt, *out; + int len; + char tmpbuf[1024]; + SSL_CTX *ctx; + SSL *ssl; + + ERR_load_crypto_strings(); + ERR_load_SSL_strings(); + OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms(); + + /* Might seed PRNG here */ + + ctx = SSL_CTX_new(SSLv23_server_method()); + + if (!SSL_CTX_use_certificate_file(ctx,"server.pem",SSL_FILETYPE_PEM) + || !SSL_CTX_use_PrivateKey_file(ctx,"server.pem",SSL_FILETYPE_PEM) + || !SSL_CTX_check_private_key(ctx)) { + + fprintf(stderr, "Error setting up SSL_CTX\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + return 0; + } + + /* Might do other things here like setting verify locations and + * DH and/or RSA temporary key callbacks + */ + + /* New SSL BIO setup as server */ + sbio=BIO_new_ssl(ctx,0); + + BIO_get_ssl(sbio, &ssl); + + if(!ssl) { + fprintf(stderr, "Can't locate SSL pointer\n"); + /* whatever ... */ + } + + /* Don't want any retries */ + SSL_set_mode(ssl, SSL_MODE_AUTO_RETRY); + + /* Create the buffering BIO */ + + bbio = BIO_new(BIO_f_buffer()); + + /* Add to chain */ + sbio = BIO_push(bbio, sbio); + + acpt=BIO_new_accept("4433"); + + /* By doing this when a new connection is established + * we automatically have sbio inserted into it. The + * BIO chain is now 'swallowed' by the accept BIO and + * will be freed when the accept BIO is freed. + */ + + BIO_set_accept_bios(acpt,sbio); + + out = BIO_new_fp(stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE); + + /* Setup accept BIO */ + if(BIO_do_accept(acpt) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error setting up accept BIO\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + return 0; + } + + /* Now wait for incoming connection */ + if(BIO_do_accept(acpt) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error in connection\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + return 0; + } + + /* We only want one connection so remove and free + * accept BIO + */ + + sbio = BIO_pop(acpt); + + BIO_free_all(acpt); + + if(BIO_do_handshake(sbio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error in SSL handshake\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + return 0; + } + + BIO_puts(sbio, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\nContent-type: text/plain\r\n\r\n"); + BIO_puts(sbio, "\r\nConnection Established\r\nRequest headers:\r\n"); + BIO_puts(sbio, "--------------------------------------------------\r\n"); + + for(;;) { + len = BIO_gets(sbio, tmpbuf, 1024); + if(len <= 0) break; + BIO_write(sbio, tmpbuf, len); + BIO_write(out, tmpbuf, len); + /* Look for blank line signifying end of headers*/ + if((tmpbuf[0] == '\r') || (tmpbuf[0] == '\n')) break; + } + + BIO_puts(sbio, "--------------------------------------------------\r\n"); + BIO_puts(sbio, "\r\n"); + + /* Since there is a buffering BIO present we had better flush it */ + BIO_flush(sbio); + + BIO_free_all(sbio); + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_find_type.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_find_type.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..bd3b25619 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_find_type.pod @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_find_type, BIO_next - BIO chain traversal + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO * BIO_find_type(BIO *b,int bio_type); + BIO * BIO_next(BIO *b); + + #define BIO_method_type(b) ((b)->method->type) + + #define BIO_TYPE_NONE 0 + #define BIO_TYPE_MEM (1|0x0400) + #define BIO_TYPE_FILE (2|0x0400) + + #define BIO_TYPE_FD (4|0x0400|0x0100) + #define BIO_TYPE_SOCKET (5|0x0400|0x0100) + #define BIO_TYPE_NULL (6|0x0400) + #define BIO_TYPE_SSL (7|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_MD (8|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_BUFFER (9|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_CIPHER (10|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_BASE64 (11|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_CONNECT (12|0x0400|0x0100) + #define BIO_TYPE_ACCEPT (13|0x0400|0x0100) + #define BIO_TYPE_PROXY_CLIENT (14|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_PROXY_SERVER (15|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_NBIO_TEST (16|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_NULL_FILTER (17|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_BER (18|0x0200) + #define BIO_TYPE_BIO (19|0x0400) + + #define BIO_TYPE_DESCRIPTOR 0x0100 + #define BIO_TYPE_FILTER 0x0200 + #define BIO_TYPE_SOURCE_SINK 0x0400 + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The BIO_find_type() searches for a BIO of a given type in a chain, starting +at BIO B. If B is a specific type (such as BIO_TYPE_MEM) then a search +is made for a BIO of that type. If B is a general type (such as +B) then the next matching BIO of the given general type is +searched for. BIO_find_type() returns the next matching BIO or NULL if none is +found. + +Note: not all the B types above have corresponding BIO implementations. + +BIO_next() returns the next BIO in a chain. It can be used to traverse all BIOs +in a chain or used in conjunction with BIO_find_type() to find all BIOs of a +certain type. + +BIO_method_type() returns the type of a BIO. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_find_type() returns a matching BIO or NULL for no match. + +BIO_next() returns the next BIO in a chain. + +BIO_method_type() returns the type of the BIO B. + +=head1 NOTES + +BIO_next() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.6 to provide a 'clean' way to traverse a BIO +chain or find multiple matches using BIO_find_type(). Previous versions had to +use: + + next = bio->next_bio; + +=head1 BUGS + +BIO_find_type() in OpenSSL 0.9.5a and earlier could not be safely passed a +NULL pointer for the B argument. + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +Traverse a chain looking for digest BIOs: + + BIO *btmp; + btmp = in_bio; /* in_bio is chain to search through */ + + do { + btmp = BIO_find_type(btmp, BIO_TYPE_MD); + if(btmp == NULL) break; /* Not found */ + /* btmp is a digest BIO, do something with it ...*/ + ... + + btmp = BIO_next(btmp); + } while(btmp); + + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2a245fc8d --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_new, BIO_set, BIO_free, BIO_vfree, BIO_free_all - BIO allocation and freeing functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO * BIO_new(BIO_METHOD *type); + int BIO_set(BIO *a,BIO_METHOD *type); + int BIO_free(BIO *a); + void BIO_vfree(BIO *a); + void BIO_free_all(BIO *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The BIO_new() function returns a new BIO using method B. + +BIO_set() sets the method of an already existing BIO. + +BIO_free() frees up a single BIO, BIO_vfree() also frees up a single BIO +but it does not return a value. Calling BIO_free() may also have some effect +on the underlying I/O structure, for example it may close the file being +referred to under certain circumstances. For more details see the individual +BIO_METHOD descriptions. + +BIO_free_all() frees up an entire BIO chain, it does not halt if an error +occurs freeing up an individual BIO in the chain. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_new() returns a newly created BIO or NULL if the call fails. + +BIO_set(), BIO_free() return 1 for success and 0 for failure. + +BIO_free_all() and BIO_vfree() do not return values. + +=head1 NOTES + +Some BIOs (such as memory BIOs) can be used immediately after calling +BIO_new(). Others (such as file BIOs) need some additional initialization, +and frequently a utility function exists to create and initialize such BIOs. + +If BIO_free() is called on a BIO chain it will only free one BIO resulting +in a memory leak. + +Calling BIO_free_all() a single BIO has the same effect as calling BIO_free() +on it other than the discarded return value. + +Normally the B argument is supplied by a function which returns a +pointer to a BIO_METHOD. There is a naming convention for such functions: +a source/sink BIO is normally called BIO_s_*() and a filter BIO +BIO_f_*(); + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +Create a memory BIO: + + BIO *mem = BIO_new(BIO_s_mem()); + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_push.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_push.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..8af1d3c09 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_push.pod @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_push, BIO_pop - add and remove BIOs from a chain. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO * BIO_push(BIO *b,BIO *append); + BIO * BIO_pop(BIO *b); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The BIO_push() function appends the BIO B to B, it returns +B. + +BIO_pop() removes the BIO B from a chain and returns the next BIO +in the chain, or NULL if there is no next BIO. The removed BIO then +becomes a single BIO with no association with the original chain, +it can thus be freed or attached to a different chain. + +=head1 NOTES + +The names of these functions are perhaps a little misleading. BIO_push() +joins two BIO chains whereas BIO_pop() deletes a single BIO from a chain, +the deleted BIO does not need to be at the end of a chain. + +The process of calling BIO_push() and BIO_pop() on a BIO may have additional +consequences (a control call is made to the affected BIOs) any effects will +be noted in the descriptions of individual BIOs. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +For these examples suppose B and B are digest BIOs, B is +a base64 BIO and B is a file BIO. + +If the call: + + BIO_push(b64, f); + +is made then the new chain will be B. After making the calls + + BIO_push(md2, b64); + BIO_push(md1, md2); + +the new chain is B. Data written to B will be digested +by B and B, B encoded and written to B. + +It should be noted that reading causes data to pass in the reverse +direction, that is data is read from B, base64 B and digested +by B and B. If the call: + + BIO_pop(md2); + +The call will return B and the new chain will be B data can +be written to B as before. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_push() returns the end of the chain, B. + +BIO_pop() returns the next BIO in the chain, or NULL if there is no next +BIO. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_read.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_read.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b34528104 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_read.pod @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_read, BIO_write, BIO_gets, BIO_puts - BIO I/O functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BIO_read(BIO *b, void *buf, int len); + int BIO_gets(BIO *b,char *buf, int size); + int BIO_write(BIO *b, const void *buf, int len); + int BIO_puts(BIO *b,const char *buf); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_read() attempts to read B bytes from BIO B and places +the data in B. + +BIO_gets() performs the BIOs "gets" operation and places the data +in B. Usually this operation will attempt to read a line of data +from the BIO of maximum length B. There are exceptions to this +however, for example BIO_gets() on a digest BIO will calculate and +return the digest and other BIOs may not support BIO_gets() at all. + +BIO_write() attempts to write B bytes from B to BIO B. + +BIO_puts() attempts to write a null terminated string B to BIO B + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +All these functions return either the amount of data successfully read or +written (if the return value is positive) or that no data was successfully +read or written if the result is 0 or -1. If the return value is -2 then +the operation is not implemented in the specific BIO type. + +=head1 NOTES + +A 0 or -1 return is not necessarily an indication of an error. In +particular when the source/sink is non-blocking or of a certain type +it may merely be an indication that no data is currently available and that +the application should retry the operation later. + +One technique sometimes used with blocking sockets is to use a system call +(such as select(), poll() or equivalent) to determine when data is available +and then call read() to read the data. The equivalent with BIOs (that is call +select() on the underlying I/O structure and then call BIO_read() to +read the data) should B be used because a single call to BIO_read() +can cause several reads (and writes in the case of SSL BIOs) on the underlying +I/O structure and may block as a result. Instead select() (or equivalent) +should be combined with non blocking I/O so successive reads will request +a retry instead of blocking. + +See L for details of how to +determine the cause of a retry and other I/O issues. + +If the BIO_gets() function is not supported by a BIO then it possible to +work around this by adding a buffering BIO L +to the chain. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_accept.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_accept.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7b63e4621 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_accept.pod @@ -0,0 +1,195 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_accept, BIO_set_accept_port, BIO_get_accept_port, +BIO_set_nbio_accept, BIO_set_accept_bios, BIO_set_bind_mode, +BIO_get_bind_mode, BIO_do_accept - accept BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD *BIO_s_accept(void); + + long BIO_set_accept_port(BIO *b, char *name); + char *BIO_get_accept_port(BIO *b); + + BIO *BIO_new_accept(char *host_port); + + long BIO_set_nbio_accept(BIO *b, int n); + long BIO_set_accept_bios(BIO *b, char *bio); + + long BIO_set_bind_mode(BIO *b, long mode); + long BIO_get_bind_mode(BIO *b, long dummy); + + #define BIO_BIND_NORMAL 0 + #define BIO_BIND_REUSEADDR_IF_UNUSED 1 + #define BIO_BIND_REUSEADDR 2 + + int BIO_do_accept(BIO *b); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_accept() returns the accept BIO method. This is a wrapper +round the platform's TCP/IP socket accept routines. + +Using accept BIOs, TCP/IP connections can be accepted and data +transferred using only BIO routines. In this way any platform +specific operations are hidden by the BIO abstraction. + +Read and write operations on an accept BIO will perform I/O +on the underlying connection. If no connection is established +and the port (see below) is set up properly then the BIO +waits for an incoming connection. + +Accept BIOs support BIO_puts() but not BIO_gets(). + +If the close flag is set on an accept BIO then any active +connection on that chain is shutdown and the socket closed when +the BIO is freed. + +Calling BIO_reset() on a accept BIO will close any active +connection and reset the BIO into a state where it awaits another +incoming connection. + +BIO_get_fd() and BIO_set_fd() can be called to retrieve or set +the accept socket. See L + +BIO_set_accept_port() uses the string B to set the accept +port. The port is represented as a string of the form "host:port", +where "host" is the interface to use and "port" is the port. +Either or both values can be "*" which is interpreted as meaning +any interface or port respectively. "port" has the same syntax +as the port specified in BIO_set_conn_port() for connect BIOs, +that is it can be a numerical port string or a string to lookup +using getservbyname() and a string table. + +BIO_new_accept() combines BIO_new() and BIO_set_accept_port() into +a single call: that is it creates a new accept BIO with port +B. + +BIO_set_nbio_accept() sets the accept socket to blocking mode +(the default) if B is 0 or non blocking mode if B is 1. + +BIO_set_accept_bios() can be used to set a chain of BIOs which +will be duplicated and prepended to the chain when an incoming +connection is received. This is useful if, for example, a +buffering or SSL BIO is required for each connection. The +chain of BIOs must not be freed after this call, they will +be automatically freed when the accept BIO is freed. + +BIO_set_bind_mode() and BIO_get_bind_mode() set and retrieve +the current bind mode. If BIO_BIND_NORMAL (the default) is set +then another socket cannot be bound to the same port. If +BIO_BIND_REUSEADDR is set then other sockets can bind to the +same port. If BIO_BIND_REUSEADDR_IF_UNUSED is set then and +attempt is first made to use BIO_BIN_NORMAL, if this fails +and the port is not in use then a second attempt is made +using BIO_BIND_REUSEADDR. + +BIO_do_accept() serves two functions. When it is first +called, after the accept BIO has been setup, it will attempt +to create the accept socket and bind an address to it. Second +and subsequent calls to BIO_do_accept() will await an incoming +connection, or request a retry in non blocking mode. + +=head1 NOTES + +When an accept BIO is at the end of a chain it will await an +incoming connection before processing I/O calls. When an accept +BIO is not at then end of a chain it passes I/O calls to the next +BIO in the chain. + +When a connection is established a new socket BIO is created for +the connection and appended to the chain. That is the chain is now +accept->socket. This effectively means that attempting I/O on +an initial accept socket will await an incoming connection then +perform I/O on it. + +If any additional BIOs have been set using BIO_set_accept_bios() +then they are placed between the socket and the accept BIO, +that is the chain will be accept->otherbios->socket. + +If a server wishes to process multiple connections (as is normally +the case) then the accept BIO must be made available for further +incoming connections. This can be done by waiting for a connection and +then calling: + + connection = BIO_pop(accept); + +After this call B will contain a BIO for the recently +established connection and B will now be a single BIO +again which can be used to await further incoming connections. +If no further connections will be accepted the B can +be freed using BIO_free(). + +If only a single connection will be processed it is possible to +perform I/O using the accept BIO itself. This is often undesirable +however because the accept BIO will still accept additional incoming +connections. This can be resolved by using BIO_pop() (see above) +and freeing up the accept BIO after the initial connection. + +If the underlying accept socket is non-blocking and BIO_do_accept() is +called to await an incoming connection it is possible for +BIO_should_io_special() with the reason BIO_RR_ACCEPT. If this happens +then it is an indication that an accept attempt would block: the application +should take appropriate action to wait until the underlying socket has +accepted a connection and retry the call. + +BIO_set_accept_port(), BIO_get_accept_port(), BIO_set_nbio_accept(), +BIO_set_accept_bios(), BIO_set_bind_mode(), BIO_get_bind_mode() and +BIO_do_accept() are macros. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +TBA + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +This example accepts two connections on port 4444, sends messages +down each and finally closes both down. + + BIO *abio, *cbio, *cbio2; + ERR_load_crypto_strings(); + abio = BIO_new_accept("4444"); + + /* First call to BIO_accept() sets up accept BIO */ + if(BIO_do_accept(abio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error setting up accept\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + exit(0); + } + + /* Wait for incoming connection */ + if(BIO_do_accept(abio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error accepting connection\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + exit(0); + } + fprintf(stderr, "Connection 1 established\n"); + /* Retrieve BIO for connection */ + cbio = BIO_pop(abio); + BIO_puts(cbio, "Connection 1: Sending out Data on initial connection\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "Sent out data on connection 1\n"); + /* Wait for another connection */ + if(BIO_do_accept(abio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error accepting connection\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + exit(0); + } + fprintf(stderr, "Connection 2 established\n"); + /* Close accept BIO to refuse further connections */ + cbio2 = BIO_pop(abio); + BIO_free(abio); + BIO_puts(cbio2, "Connection 2: Sending out Data on second\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "Sent out data on connection 2\n"); + + BIO_puts(cbio, "Connection 1: Second connection established\n"); + /* Close the two established connections */ + BIO_free(cbio); + BIO_free(cbio2); + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_bio.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_bio.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..8d0a55a02 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_bio.pod @@ -0,0 +1,182 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_bio, BIO_make_bio_pair, BIO_destroy_bio_pair, BIO_shutdown_wr, +BIO_set_write_buf_size, BIO_get_write_buf_size, BIO_new_bio_pair, +BIO_get_write_guarantee, BIO_ctrl_get_write_guarantee, BIO_get_read_request, +BIO_ctrl_get_read_request, BIO_ctrl_reset_read_request - BIO pair BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD *BIO_s_bio(void); + + #define BIO_make_bio_pair(b1,b2) (int)BIO_ctrl(b1,BIO_C_MAKE_BIO_PAIR,0,b2) + #define BIO_destroy_bio_pair(b) (int)BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_DESTROY_BIO_PAIR,0,NULL) + + #define BIO_shutdown_wr(b) (int)BIO_ctrl(b, BIO_C_SHUTDOWN_WR, 0, NULL) + + #define BIO_set_write_buf_size(b,size) (int)BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_WRITE_BUF_SIZE,size,NULL) + #define BIO_get_write_buf_size(b,size) (size_t)BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_GET_WRITE_BUF_SIZE,size,NULL) + + int BIO_new_bio_pair(BIO **bio1, size_t writebuf1, BIO **bio2, size_t writebuf2); + + #define BIO_get_write_guarantee(b) (int)BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_GET_WRITE_GUARANTEE,0,NULL) + size_t BIO_ctrl_get_write_guarantee(BIO *b); + + #define BIO_get_read_request(b) (int)BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_GET_READ_REQUEST,0,NULL) + size_t BIO_ctrl_get_read_request(BIO *b); + + int BIO_ctrl_reset_read_request(BIO *b); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_bio() returns the method for a BIO pair. A BIO pair is a pair of source/sink +BIOs where data written to either half of the pair is buffered and can be read from +the other half. Both halves must usually by handled by the same application thread +since no locking is done on the internal data structures. + +Since BIO chains typically end in a source/sink BIO it is possible to make this +one half of a BIO pair and have all the data processed by the chain under application +control. + +One typical use of BIO pairs is to place TLS/SSL I/O under application control, this +can be used when the application wishes to use a non standard transport for +TLS/SSL or the normal socket routines are inappropriate. + +Calls to BIO_read() will read data from the buffer or request a retry if no +data is available. + +Calls to BIO_write() will place data in the buffer or request a retry if the +buffer is full. + +The standard calls BIO_ctrl_pending() and BIO_ctrl_wpending() can be used to +determine the amount of pending data in the read or write buffer. + +BIO_reset() clears any data in the write buffer. + +BIO_make_bio_pair() joins two separate BIOs into a connected pair. + +BIO_destroy_pair() destroys the association between two connected BIOs. Freeing +up any half of the pair will automatically destroy the association. + +BIO_shutdown_wr() is used to close down a BIO B. After this call no further +writes on BIO B are allowed (they will return an error). Reads on the other +half of the pair will return any pending data or EOF when all pending data has +been read. + +BIO_set_write_buf_size() sets the write buffer size of BIO B to B. +If the size is not initialized a default value is used. This is currently +17K, sufficient for a maximum size TLS record. + +BIO_get_write_buf_size() returns the size of the write buffer. + +BIO_new_bio_pair() combines the calls to BIO_new(), BIO_make_bio_pair() and +BIO_set_write_buf_size() to create a connected pair of BIOs B, B +with write buffer sizes B and B. If either size is +zero then the default size is used. BIO_new_bio_pair() does not check whether +B or B do point to some other BIO, the values are overwritten, +BIO_free() is not called. + +BIO_get_write_guarantee() and BIO_ctrl_get_write_guarantee() return the maximum +length of data that can be currently written to the BIO. Writes larger than this +value will return a value from BIO_write() less than the amount requested or if the +buffer is full request a retry. BIO_ctrl_get_write_guarantee() is a function +whereas BIO_get_write_guarantee() is a macro. + +BIO_get_read_request() and BIO_ctrl_get_read_request() return the +amount of data requested, or the buffer size if it is less, if the +last read attempt at the other half of the BIO pair failed due to an +empty buffer. This can be used to determine how much data should be +written to the BIO so the next read will succeed: this is most useful +in TLS/SSL applications where the amount of data read is usually +meaningful rather than just a buffer size. After a successful read +this call will return zero. It also will return zero once new data +has been written satisfying the read request or part of it. +Note that BIO_get_read_request() never returns an amount larger +than that returned by BIO_get_write_guarantee(). + +BIO_ctrl_reset_read_request() can also be used to reset the value returned by +BIO_get_read_request() to zero. + +=head1 NOTES + +Both halves of a BIO pair should be freed. That is even if one half is implicit +freed due to a BIO_free_all() or SSL_free() call the other half needs to be freed. + +When used in bidirectional applications (such as TLS/SSL) care should be taken to +flush any data in the write buffer. This can be done by calling BIO_pending() +on the other half of the pair and, if any data is pending, reading it and sending +it to the underlying transport. This must be done before any normal processing +(such as calling select() ) due to a request and BIO_should_read() being true. + +To see why this is important consider a case where a request is sent using +BIO_write() and a response read with BIO_read(), this can occur during an +TLS/SSL handshake for example. BIO_write() will succeed and place data in the write +buffer. BIO_read() will initially fail and BIO_should_read() will be true. If +the application then waits for data to be available on the underlying transport +before flushing the write buffer it will never succeed because the request was +never sent! + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_new_bio_pair() returns 1 on success, with the new BIOs available in +B and B, or 0 on failure, with NULL pointers stored into the +locations for B and B. Check the error stack for more information. + +[XXXXX: More return values need to be added here] + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +The BIO pair can be used to have full control over the network access of an +application. The application can call select() on the socket as required +without having to go through the SSL-interface. + + BIO *internal_bio, *network_bio; + ... + BIO_new_bio_pair(internal_bio, 0, network_bio, 0); + SSL_set_bio(ssl, internal_bio, internal_bio); + SSL_operations(); + ... + + application | TLS-engine + | | + +----------> SSL_operations() + | /\ || + | || \/ + | BIO-pair (internal_bio) + +----------< BIO-pair (network_bio) + | | + socket | + + ... + SSL_free(ssl); /* implicitly frees internal_bio */ + BIO_free(network_bio); + ... + +As the BIO pair will only buffer the data and never directly access the +connection, it behaves non-blocking and will return as soon as the write +buffer is full or the read buffer is drained. Then the application has to +flush the write buffer and/or fill the read buffer. + +Use the BIO_ctrl_pending(), to find out whether data is buffered in the BIO +and must be transfered to the network. Use BIO_ctrl_get_read_request() to +find out, how many bytes must be written into the buffer before the +SSL_operation() can successfully be continued. + +=head1 WARNING + +As the data is buffered, SSL_operation() may return with a ERROR_SSL_WANT_READ +condition, but there is still data in the write buffer. An application must +not rely on the error value of SSL_operation() but must assure that the +write buffer is always flushed first. Otherwise a deadlock may occur as +the peer might be waiting for the data before being able to continue. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L, L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_connect.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_connect.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..bcf7d8dca --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_connect.pod @@ -0,0 +1,192 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_connect, BIO_set_conn_hostname, BIO_set_conn_port, +BIO_set_conn_ip, BIO_set_conn_int_port, BIO_get_conn_hostname, +BIO_get_conn_port, BIO_get_conn_ip, BIO_get_conn_int_port, +BIO_set_nbio, BIO_do_connect - connect BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_s_connect(void); + + BIO *BIO_new_connect(char *name); + + long BIO_set_conn_hostname(BIO *b, char *name); + long BIO_set_conn_port(BIO *b, char *port); + long BIO_set_conn_ip(BIO *b, char *ip); + long BIO_set_conn_int_port(BIO *b, char *port); + char *BIO_get_conn_hostname(BIO *b); + char *BIO_get_conn_port(BIO *b); + char *BIO_get_conn_ip(BIO *b, dummy); + long BIO_get_conn_int_port(BIO *b, int port); + + long BIO_set_nbio(BIO *b, long n); + + int BIO_do_connect(BIO *b); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_connect() returns the connect BIO method. This is a wrapper +round the platform's TCP/IP socket connection routines. + +Using connect BIOs, TCP/IP connections can be made and data +transferred using only BIO routines. In this way any platform +specific operations are hidden by the BIO abstraction. + +Read and write operations on a connect BIO will perform I/O +on the underlying connection. If no connection is established +and the port and hostname (see below) is set up properly then +a connection is established first. + +Connect BIOs support BIO_puts() but not BIO_gets(). + +If the close flag is set on a connect BIO then any active +connection is shutdown and the socket closed when the BIO +is freed. + +Calling BIO_reset() on a connect BIO will close any active +connection and reset the BIO into a state where it can connect +to the same host again. + +BIO_get_fd() places the underlying socket in B if it is not NULL, +it also returns the socket . If B is not NULL it should be of +type (int *). + +BIO_set_conn_hostname() uses the string B to set the hostname. +The hostname can be an IP address. The hostname can also include the +port in the form hostname:port . It is also acceptable to use the +form "hostname/any/other/path" or "hostname:port/any/other/path". + +BIO_set_conn_port() sets the port to B. B can be the +numerical form or a string such as "http". A string will be looked +up first using getservbyname() on the host platform but if that +fails a standard table of port names will be used. Currently the +list is http, telnet, socks, https, ssl, ftp, gopher and wais. + +BIO_set_conn_ip() sets the IP address to B using binary form, +that is four bytes specifying the IP address in big-endian form. + +BIO_set_conn_int_port() sets the port using B. B should +be of type (int *). + +BIO_get_conn_hostname() returns the hostname of the connect BIO or +NULL if the BIO is initialized but no hostname is set. +This return value is an internal pointer which should not be modified. + +BIO_get_conn_port() returns the port as a string. + +BIO_get_conn_ip() returns the IP address in binary form. + +BIO_get_conn_int_port() returns the port as an int. + +BIO_set_nbio() sets the non blocking I/O flag to B. If B is +zero then blocking I/O is set. If B is 1 then non blocking I/O +is set. Blocking I/O is the default. The call to BIO_set_nbio() +should be made before the connection is established because +non blocking I/O is set during the connect process. + +BIO_new_connect() combines BIO_new() and BIO_set_conn_hostname() into +a single call: that is it creates a new connect BIO with B. + +BIO_do_connect() attempts to connect the supplied BIO. It returns 1 +if the connection was established successfully. A zero or negative +value is returned if the connection could not be established, the +call BIO_should_retry() should be used for non blocking connect BIOs +to determine if the call should be retried. + +=head1 NOTES + +If blocking I/O is set then a non positive return value from any +I/O call is caused by an error condition, although a zero return +will normally mean that the connection was closed. + +If the port name is supplied as part of the host name then this will +override any value set with BIO_set_conn_port(). This may be undesirable +if the application does not wish to allow connection to arbitrary +ports. This can be avoided by checking for the presence of the ':' +character in the passed hostname and either indicating an error or +truncating the string at that point. + +The values returned by BIO_get_conn_hostname(), BIO_get_conn_port(), +BIO_get_conn_ip() and BIO_get_conn_int_port() are updated when a +connection attempt is made. Before any connection attempt the values +returned are those set by the application itself. + +Applications do not have to call BIO_do_connect() but may wish to do +so to separate the connection process from other I/O processing. + +If non blocking I/O is set then retries will be requested as appropriate. + +It addition to BIO_should_read() and BIO_should_write() it is also +possible for BIO_should_io_special() to be true during the initial +connection process with the reason BIO_RR_CONNECT. If this is returned +then this is an indication that a connection attempt would block, +the application should then take appropriate action to wait until +the underlying socket has connected and retry the call. + +BIO_set_conn_hostname(), BIO_set_conn_port(), BIO_set_conn_ip(), +BIO_set_conn_int_port(), BIO_get_conn_hostname(), BIO_get_conn_port(), +BIO_get_conn_ip(), BIO_get_conn_int_port(), BIO_set_nbio() and +BIO_do_connect() are macros. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_s_connect() returns the connect BIO method. + +BIO_get_fd() returns the socket or -1 if the BIO has not +been initialized. + +BIO_set_conn_hostname(), BIO_set_conn_port(), BIO_set_conn_ip() and +BIO_set_conn_int_port() always return 1. + +BIO_get_conn_hostname() returns the connected hostname or NULL is +none was set. + +BIO_get_conn_port() returns a string representing the connected +port or NULL if not set. + +BIO_get_conn_ip() returns a pointer to the connected IP address in +binary form or all zeros if not set. + +BIO_get_conn_int_port() returns the connected port or 0 if none was +set. + +BIO_set_nbio() always returns 1. + +BIO_do_connect() returns 1 if the connection was successfully +established and 0 or -1 if the connection failed. + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +This is example connects to a webserver on the local host and attempts +to retrieve a page and copy the result to standard output. + + + BIO *cbio, *out; + int len; + char tmpbuf[1024]; + ERR_load_crypto_strings(); + cbio = BIO_new_connect("localhost:http"); + out = BIO_new_fp(stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE); + if(BIO_do_connect(cbio) <= 0) { + fprintf(stderr, "Error connecting to server\n"); + ERR_print_errors_fp(stderr); + /* whatever ... */ + } + BIO_puts(cbio, "GET / HTTP/1.0\n\n"); + for(;;) { + len = BIO_read(cbio, tmpbuf, 1024); + if(len <= 0) break; + BIO_write(out, tmpbuf, len); + } + BIO_free(cbio); + BIO_free(out); + + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_fd.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_fd.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b1de1d101 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_fd.pod @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_fd, BIO_set_fd, BIO_get_fd, BIO_new_fd - file descriptor BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_s_fd(void); + + #define BIO_set_fd(b,fd,c) BIO_int_ctrl(b,BIO_C_SET_FD,c,fd) + #define BIO_get_fd(b,c) BIO_ctrl(b,BIO_C_GET_FD,0,(char *)c) + + BIO *BIO_new_fd(int fd, int close_flag); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_fd() returns the file descriptor BIO method. This is a wrapper +round the platforms file descriptor routines such as read() and write(). + +BIO_read() and BIO_write() read or write the underlying descriptor. +BIO_puts() is supported but BIO_gets() is not. + +If the close flag is set then then close() is called on the underlying +file descriptor when the BIO is freed. + +BIO_reset() attempts to change the file pointer to the start of file +using lseek(fd, 0, 0). + +BIO_seek() sets the file pointer to position B from start of file +using lseek(fd, ofs, 0). + +BIO_tell() returns the current file position by calling lseek(fd, 0, 1). + +BIO_set_fd() sets the file descriptor of BIO B to B and the close +flag to B. + +BIO_get_fd() places the file descriptor in B if it is not NULL, it also +returns the file descriptor. If B is not NULL it should be of type +(int *). + +BIO_new_fd() returns a file descriptor BIO using B and B. + +=head1 NOTES + +The behaviour of BIO_read() and BIO_write() depends on the behavior of the +platforms read() and write() calls on the descriptor. If the underlying +file descriptor is in a non blocking mode then the BIO will behave in the +manner described in the L and L +manual pages. + +File descriptor BIOs should not be used for socket I/O. Use socket BIOs +instead. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_s_fd() returns the file descriptor BIO method. + +BIO_reset() returns zero for success and -1 if an error occurred. +BIO_seek() and BIO_tell() return the current file position or -1 +is an error occurred. These values reflect the underlying lseek() +behaviour. + +BIO_set_fd() always returns 1. + +BIO_get_fd() returns the file descriptor or -1 if the BIO has not +been initialized. + +BIO_new_fd() returns the newly allocated BIO or NULL is an error +occurred. + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +This is a file descriptor BIO version of "Hello World": + + BIO *out; + out = BIO_new_fd(fileno(stdout), BIO_NOCLOSE); + BIO_printf(out, "Hello World\n"); + BIO_free(out); + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_file.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_file.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b2a29263f --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_file.pod @@ -0,0 +1,144 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_file, BIO_new_file, BIO_new_fp, BIO_set_fp, BIO_get_fp, +BIO_read_filename, BIO_write_filename, BIO_append_filename, +BIO_rw_filename - FILE bio + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_s_file(void); + BIO *BIO_new_file(const char *filename, const char *mode); + BIO *BIO_new_fp(FILE *stream, int flags); + + BIO_set_fp(BIO *b,FILE *fp, int flags); + BIO_get_fp(BIO *b,FILE **fpp); + + int BIO_read_filename(BIO *b, char *name) + int BIO_write_filename(BIO *b, char *name) + int BIO_append_filename(BIO *b, char *name) + int BIO_rw_filename(BIO *b, char *name) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_file() returns the BIO file method. As its name implies it +is a wrapper round the stdio FILE structure and it is a +source/sink BIO. + +Calls to BIO_read() and BIO_write() read and write data to the +underlying stream. BIO_gets() and BIO_puts() are supported on file BIOs. + +BIO_flush() on a file BIO calls the fflush() function on the wrapped +stream. + +BIO_reset() attempts to change the file pointer to the start of file +using fseek(stream, 0, 0). + +BIO_seek() sets the file pointer to position B from start of file +using fseek(stream, ofs, 0). + +BIO_eof() calls feof(). + +Setting the BIO_CLOSE flag calls fclose() on the stream when the BIO +is freed. + +BIO_new_file() creates a new file BIO with mode B the meaning +of B is the same as the stdio function fopen(). The BIO_CLOSE +flag is set on the returned BIO. + +BIO_new_fp() creates a file BIO wrapping B. Flags can be: +BIO_CLOSE, BIO_NOCLOSE (the close flag) BIO_FP_TEXT (sets the underlying +stream to text mode, default is binary: this only has any effect under +Win32). + +BIO_set_fp() set the fp of a file BIO to B. B has the same +meaning as in BIO_new_fp(), it is a macro. + +BIO_get_fp() retrieves the fp of a file BIO, it is a macro. + +BIO_seek() is a macro that sets the position pointer to B bytes +from the start of file. + +BIO_tell() returns the value of the position pointer. + +BIO_read_filename(), BIO_write_filename(), BIO_append_filename() and +BIO_rw_filename() set the file BIO B to use file B for +reading, writing, append or read write respectively. + +=head1 NOTES + +When wrapping stdout, stdin or stderr the underlying stream should not +normally be closed so the BIO_NOCLOSE flag should be set. + +Because the file BIO calls the underlying stdio functions any quirks +in stdio behaviour will be mirrored by the corresponding BIO. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +File BIO "hello world": + + BIO *bio_out; + bio_out = BIO_new_fp(stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE); + BIO_printf(bio_out, "Hello World\n"); + +Alternative technique: + + BIO *bio_out; + bio_out = BIO_new(BIO_s_file()); + if(bio_out == NULL) /* Error ... */ + if(!BIO_set_fp(bio_out, stdout, BIO_NOCLOSE)) /* Error ... */ + BIO_printf(bio_out, "Hello World\n"); + +Write to a file: + + BIO *out; + out = BIO_new_file("filename.txt", "w"); + if(!out) /* Error occurred */ + BIO_printf(out, "Hello World\n"); + BIO_free(out); + +Alternative technique: + + BIO *out; + out = BIO_new(BIO_s_file()); + if(out == NULL) /* Error ... */ + if(!BIO_write_filename(out, "filename.txt")) /* Error ... */ + BIO_printf(out, "Hello World\n"); + BIO_free(out); + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_s_file() returns the file BIO method. + +BIO_new_file() and BIO_new_fp() return a file BIO or NULL if an error +occurred. + +BIO_set_fp() and BIO_get_fp() return 1 for success or 0 for failure +(although the current implementation never return 0). + +BIO_seek() returns the same value as the underlying fseek() function: +0 for success or -1 for failure. + +BIO_tell() returns the current file position. + +BIO_read_filename(), BIO_write_filename(), BIO_append_filename() and +BIO_rw_filename() return 1 for success or 0 for failure. + +=head1 BUGS + +BIO_reset() and BIO_seek() are implemented using fseek() on the underlying +stream. The return value for fseek() is 0 for success or -1 if an error +occurred this differs from other types of BIO which will typically return +1 for success and a non positive value if an error occurred. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L, +L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_mem.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_mem.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..19648acfa --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_mem.pod @@ -0,0 +1,115 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_mem, BIO_set_mem_eof_return, BIO_get_mem_data, BIO_set_mem_buf, +BIO_get_mem_ptr, BIO_new_mem_buf - memory BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_s_mem(void); + + BIO_set_mem_eof_return(BIO *b,int v) + long BIO_get_mem_data(BIO *b, char **pp) + BIO_set_mem_buf(BIO *b,BUF_MEM *bm,int c) + BIO_get_mem_ptr(BIO *b,BUF_MEM **pp) + + BIO *BIO_new_mem_buf(void *buf, int len); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_mem() return the memory BIO method function. + +A memory BIO is a source/sink BIO which uses memory for its I/O. Data +written to a memory BIO is stored in a BUF_MEM structure which is extended +as appropriate to accommodate the stored data. + +Any data written to a memory BIO can be recalled by reading from it. +Unless the memory BIO is read only any data read from it is deleted from +the BIO. + +Memory BIOs support BIO_gets() and BIO_puts(). + +If the BIO_CLOSE flag is set when a memory BIO is freed then the underlying +BUF_MEM structure is also freed. + +Calling BIO_reset() on a read write memory BIO clears any data in it. On a +read only BIO it restores the BIO to its original state and the read only +data can be read again. + +BIO_eof() is true if no data is in the BIO. + +BIO_ctrl_pending() returns the number of bytes currently stored. + +BIO_set_mem_eof_return() sets the behaviour of memory BIO B when it is +empty. If the B is zero then an empty memory BIO will return EOF (that is +it will return zero and BIO_should_retry(b) will be false. If B is non +zero then it will return B when it is empty and it will set the read retry +flag (that is BIO_read_retry(b) is true). To avoid ambiguity with a normal +positive return value B should be set to a negative value, typically -1. + +BIO_get_mem_data() sets B to a pointer to the start of the memory BIOs data +and returns the total amount of data available. It is implemented as a macro. + +BIO_set_mem_buf() sets the internal BUF_MEM structure to B and sets the +close flag to B, that is B should be either BIO_CLOSE or BIO_NOCLOSE. +It is a macro. + +BIO_get_mem_ptr() places the underlying BUF_MEM structure in B. It is +a macro. + +BIO_new_mem_buf() creates a memory BIO using B bytes of data at B, +if B is -1 then the B is assumed to be null terminated and its +length is determined by B. The BIO is set to a read only state and +as a result cannot be written to. This is useful when some data needs to be +made available from a static area of memory in the form of a BIO. The +supplied data is read directly from the supplied buffer: it is B copied +first, so the supplied area of memory must be unchanged until the BIO is freed. + +=head1 NOTES + +Writes to memory BIOs will always succeed if memory is available: that is +their size can grow indefinitely. + +Every read from a read write memory BIO will remove the data just read with +an internal copy operation, if a BIO contains a lots of data and it is +read in small chunks the operation can be very slow. The use of a read only +memory BIO avoids this problem. If the BIO must be read write then adding +a buffering BIO to the chain will speed up the process. + +=head1 BUGS + +There should be an option to set the maximum size of a memory BIO. + +There should be a way to "rewind" a read write BIO without destroying +its contents. + +The copying operation should not occur after every small read of a large BIO +to improve efficiency. + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +Create a memory BIO and write some data to it: + + BIO *mem = BIO_new(BIO_s_mem()); + BIO_puts(mem, "Hello World\n"); + +Create a read only memory BIO: + + char data[] = "Hello World"; + BIO *mem; + mem = BIO_new_mem_buf(data, -1); + +Extract the BUF_MEM structure from a memory BIO and then free up the BIO: + + BUF_MEM *bptr; + BIO_get_mem_ptr(mem, &bptr); + BIO_set_close(mem, BIO_NOCLOSE); /* So BIO_free() leaves BUF_MEM alone */ + BIO_free(mem); + + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_null.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_null.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e5514f723 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_null.pod @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_null - null data sink + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD * BIO_s_null(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_null() returns the null sink BIO method. Data written to +the null sink is discarded, reads return EOF. + +=head1 NOTES + +A null sink BIO behaves in a similar manner to the Unix /dev/null +device. + +A null bio can be placed on the end of a chain to discard any data +passed through it. + +A null sink is useful if, for example, an application wishes to digest some +data by writing through a digest bio but not send the digested data anywhere. +Since a BIO chain must normally include a source/sink BIO this can be achieved +by adding a null sink BIO to the end of the chain + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_s_null() returns the null sink BIO method. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_socket.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_socket.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1c8d3a911 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_s_socket.pod @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_s_socket, BIO_new_socket - socket BIO + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIO_METHOD *BIO_s_socket(void); + + long BIO_set_fd(BIO *b, int fd, long close_flag); + long BIO_get_fd(BIO *b, int *c); + + BIO *BIO_new_socket(int sock, int close_flag); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_s_socket() returns the socket BIO method. This is a wrapper +round the platform's socket routines. + +BIO_read() and BIO_write() read or write the underlying socket. +BIO_puts() is supported but BIO_gets() is not. + +If the close flag is set then the socket is shut down and closed +when the BIO is freed. + +BIO_set_fd() sets the socket of BIO B to B and the close +flag to B. + +BIO_get_fd() places the socket in B if it is not NULL, it also +returns the socket. If B is not NULL it should be of type (int *). + +BIO_new_socket() returns a socket BIO using B and B. + +=head1 NOTES + +Socket BIOs also support any relevant functionality of file descriptor +BIOs. + +The reason for having separate file descriptor and socket BIOs is that on some +platforms sockets are not file descriptors and use distinct I/O routines, +Windows is one such platform. Any code mixing the two will not work on +all platforms. + +BIO_set_fd() and BIO_get_fd() are macros. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BIO_s_socket() returns the socket BIO method. + +BIO_set_fd() always returns 1. + +BIO_get_fd() returns the socket or -1 if the BIO has not been +initialized. + +BIO_new_socket() returns the newly allocated BIO or NULL is an error +occurred. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_set_callback.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_set_callback.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..475955624 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_set_callback.pod @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_set_callback, BIO_get_callback, BIO_set_callback_arg, BIO_get_callback_arg, +BIO_debug_callback - BIO callback functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + #define BIO_set_callback(b,cb) ((b)->callback=(cb)) + #define BIO_get_callback(b) ((b)->callback) + #define BIO_set_callback_arg(b,arg) ((b)->cb_arg=(char *)(arg)) + #define BIO_get_callback_arg(b) ((b)->cb_arg) + + long BIO_debug_callback(BIO *bio,int cmd,const char *argp,int argi, + long argl,long ret); + + typedef long (*callback)(BIO *b, int oper, const char *argp, + int argi, long argl, long retvalue); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BIO_set_callback() and BIO_get_callback() set and retrieve the BIO callback, +they are both macros. The callback is called during most high level BIO +operations. It can be used for debugging purposes to trace operations on +a BIO or to modify its operation. + +BIO_set_callback_arg() and BIO_get_callback_arg() are macros which can be +used to set and retrieve an argument for use in the callback. + +BIO_debug_callback() is a standard debugging callback which prints +out information relating to each BIO operation. If the callback +argument is set if is interpreted as a BIO to send the information +to, otherwise stderr is used. + +callback() is the callback function itself. The meaning of each +argument is described below. + +The BIO the callback is attached to is passed in B. + +B is set to the operation being performed. For some operations +the callback is called twice, once before and once after the actual +operation, the latter case has B or'ed with BIO_CB_RETURN. + +The meaning of the arguments B, B and B depends on +the value of B, that is the operation being performed. + +B is the return value that would be returned to the +application if no callback were present. The actual value returned +is the return value of the callback itself. In the case of callbacks +called before the actual BIO operation 1 is placed in retvalue, if +the return value is not positive it will be immediately returned to +the application and the BIO operation will not be performed. + +The callback should normally simply return B when it has +finished processing, unless if specifically wishes to modify the +value returned to the application. + +=head1 CALLBACK OPERATIONS + +=over 4 + +=item B + +callback(b, BIO_CB_FREE, NULL, 0L, 0L, 1L) is called before the +free operation. + +=item B + +callback(b, BIO_CB_READ, out, outl, 0L, 1L) is called before +the read and callback(b, BIO_CB_READ|BIO_CB_RETURN, out, outl, 0L, retvalue) +after. + +=item B + +callback(b, BIO_CB_WRITE, in, inl, 0L, 1L) is called before +the write and callback(b, BIO_CB_WRITE|BIO_CB_RETURN, in, inl, 0L, retvalue) +after. + +=item B + +callback(b, BIO_CB_GETS, out, outl, 0L, 1L) is called before +the operation and callback(b, BIO_CB_GETS|BIO_CB_RETURN, out, outl, 0L, retvalue) +after. + +=item B + +callback(b, BIO_CB_WRITE, in, 0, 0L, 1L) is called before +the operation and callback(b, BIO_CB_WRITE|BIO_CB_RETURN, in, 0, 0L, retvalue) +after. + +=item B + +callback(b,BIO_CB_CTRL,parg,cmd,larg,1L) is called before the call and +callback(b,BIO_CB_CTRL|BIO_CB_RETURN,parg,cmd, larg,ret) after. + +=back + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +The BIO_debug_callback() function is a good example, its source is +in crypto/bio/bio_cb.c + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_should_retry.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_should_retry.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..539c39127 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BIO_should_retry.pod @@ -0,0 +1,114 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BIO_should_retry, BIO_should_read, BIO_should_write, +BIO_should_io_special, BIO_retry_type, BIO_should_retry, +BIO_get_retry_BIO, BIO_get_retry_reason - BIO retry functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + #define BIO_should_read(a) ((a)->flags & BIO_FLAGS_READ) + #define BIO_should_write(a) ((a)->flags & BIO_FLAGS_WRITE) + #define BIO_should_io_special(a) ((a)->flags & BIO_FLAGS_IO_SPECIAL) + #define BIO_retry_type(a) ((a)->flags & BIO_FLAGS_RWS) + #define BIO_should_retry(a) ((a)->flags & BIO_FLAGS_SHOULD_RETRY) + + #define BIO_FLAGS_READ 0x01 + #define BIO_FLAGS_WRITE 0x02 + #define BIO_FLAGS_IO_SPECIAL 0x04 + #define BIO_FLAGS_RWS (BIO_FLAGS_READ|BIO_FLAGS_WRITE|BIO_FLAGS_IO_SPECIAL) + #define BIO_FLAGS_SHOULD_RETRY 0x08 + + BIO * BIO_get_retry_BIO(BIO *bio, int *reason); + int BIO_get_retry_reason(BIO *bio); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions determine why a BIO is not able to read or write data. +They will typically be called after a failed BIO_read() or BIO_write() +call. + +BIO_should_retry() is true if the call that produced this condition +should then be retried at a later time. + +If BIO_should_retry() is false then the cause is an error condition. + +BIO_should_read() is true if the cause of the condition is that a BIO +needs to read data. + +BIO_should_write() is true if the cause of the condition is that a BIO +needs to read data. + +BIO_should_io_special() is true if some "special" condition, that is a +reason other than reading or writing is the cause of the condition. + +BIO_get_retry_reason() returns a mask of the cause of a retry condition +consisting of the values B, B, +B though current BIO types will only set one of +these. + +BIO_get_retry_BIO() determines the precise reason for the special +condition, it returns the BIO that caused this condition and if +B is not NULL it contains the reason code. The meaning of +the reason code and the action that should be taken depends on +the type of BIO that resulted in this condition. + +BIO_get_retry_reason() returns the reason for a special condition if +passed the relevant BIO, for example as returned by BIO_get_retry_BIO(). + +=head1 NOTES + +If BIO_should_retry() returns false then the precise "error condition" +depends on the BIO type that caused it and the return code of the BIO +operation. For example if a call to BIO_read() on a socket BIO returns +0 and BIO_should_retry() is false then the cause will be that the +connection closed. A similar condition on a file BIO will mean that it +has reached EOF. Some BIO types may place additional information on +the error queue. For more details see the individual BIO type manual +pages. + +If the underlying I/O structure is in a blocking mode almost all current +BIO types will not request a retry, because the underlying I/O +calls will not. If the application knows that the BIO type will never +signal a retry then it need not call BIO_should_retry() after a failed +BIO I/O call. This is typically done with file BIOs. + +SSL BIOs are the only current exception to this rule: they can request a +retry even if the underlying I/O structure is blocking, if a handshake +occurs during a call to BIO_read(). An application can retry the failed +call immediately or avoid this situation by setting SSL_MODE_AUTO_RETRY +on the underlying SSL structure. + +While an application may retry a failed non blocking call immediately +this is likely to be very inefficient because the call will fail +repeatedly until data can be processed or is available. An application +will normally wait until the necessary condition is satisfied. How +this is done depends on the underlying I/O structure. + +For example if the cause is ultimately a socket and BIO_should_read() +is true then a call to select() may be made to wait until data is +available and then retry the BIO operation. By combining the retry +conditions of several non blocking BIOs in a single select() call +it is possible to service several BIOs in a single thread, though +the performance may be poor if SSL BIOs are present because long delays +can occur during the initial handshake process. + +It is possible for a BIO to block indefinitely if the underlying I/O +structure cannot process or return any data. This depends on the behaviour of +the platforms I/O functions. This is often not desirable: one solution +is to use non blocking I/O and use a timeout on the select() (or +equivalent) call. + +=head1 BUGS + +The OpenSSL ASN1 functions cannot gracefully deal with non blocking I/O: +that is they cannot retry after a partial read or write. This is usually +worked around by only passing the relevant data to ASN1 functions when +the entire structure can be read or written. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +TBA diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_BLINDING_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_BLINDING_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7b087f728 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_BLINDING_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_BLINDING_new, BN_BLINDING_free, BN_BLINDING_update, BN_BLINDING_convert, +BN_BLINDING_invert, BN_BLINDING_convert_ex, BN_BLINDING_invert_ex, +BN_BLINDING_get_thread_id, BN_BLINDING_set_thread_id, BN_BLINDING_get_flags, +BN_BLINDING_set_flags, BN_BLINDING_create_param - blinding related BIGNUM +functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BN_BLINDING *BN_BLINDING_new(const BIGNUM *A, const BIGNUM *Ai, + BIGNUM *mod); + void BN_BLINDING_free(BN_BLINDING *b); + int BN_BLINDING_update(BN_BLINDING *b,BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_convert(BIGNUM *n, BN_BLINDING *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_invert(BIGNUM *n, BN_BLINDING *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_convert_ex(BIGNUM *n, BIGNUM *r, BN_BLINDING *b, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_invert_ex(BIGNUM *n, const BIGNUM *r, BN_BLINDING *b, + BN_CTX *ctx); + unsigned long BN_BLINDING_get_thread_id(const BN_BLINDING *); + void BN_BLINDING_set_thread_id(BN_BLINDING *, unsigned long); + unsigned long BN_BLINDING_get_flags(const BN_BLINDING *); + void BN_BLINDING_set_flags(BN_BLINDING *, unsigned long); + BN_BLINDING *BN_BLINDING_create_param(BN_BLINDING *b, + const BIGNUM *e, BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx, + int (*bn_mod_exp)(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *p, + const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx, BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx), + BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_BLINDING_new() allocates a new B structure and copies +the B and B values into the newly created B object. + +BN_BLINDING_free() frees the B structure. + +BN_BLINDING_update() updates the B parameters by squaring +the B and B or, after specific number of uses and if the +necessary parameters are set, by re-creating the blinding parameters. + +BN_BLINDING_convert_ex() multiplies B with the blinding factor B. +If B is not NULL a copy the inverse blinding factor B will be +returned in B (this is useful if a B object is shared amoung +several threads). BN_BLINDING_invert_ex() multiplies B with the +inverse blinding factor B. If B is not NULL it will be used as +the inverse blinding. + +BN_BLINDING_convert() and BN_BLINDING_invert() are wrapper +functions for BN_BLINDING_convert_ex() and BN_BLINDING_invert_ex() +with B set to NULL. + +BN_BLINDING_set_thread_id() and BN_BLINDING_get_thread_id() +set and get the "thread id" value of the B structure, +a field provided to users of B structure to help them +provide proper locking if needed for multi-threaded use. The +"thread id" of a newly allocated B structure is zero. + +BN_BLINDING_get_flags() returns the BN_BLINDING flags. Currently +there are two supported flags: B and +B. B inhibits the +automatic update of the B parameters after each use +and B inhibits the automatic re-creation +of the B parameters after a fixed number of uses (currently +32). In newly allocated B objects no flags are set. +BN_BLINDING_set_flags() sets the B parameters flags. + +BN_BLINDING_create_param() creates new B parameters +using the exponent B and the modulus B. B and +B can be used to pass special functions for exponentiation +(normally BN_mod_exp_mont() and B). + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_BLINDING_new() returns the newly allocated B structure +or NULL in case of an error. + +BN_BLINDING_update(), BN_BLINDING_convert(), BN_BLINDING_invert(), +BN_BLINDING_convert_ex() and BN_BLINDING_invert_ex() return 1 on +success and 0 if an error occured. + +BN_BLINDING_get_thread_id() returns the thread id (a B +value) or 0 if not set. + +BN_BLINDING_get_flags() returns the currently set B flags +(a B value). + +BN_BLINDING_create_param() returns the newly created B +parameters or NULL on error. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_BLINDING_convert_ex, BN_BLINDIND_invert_ex, BN_BLINDING_get_thread_id, +BN_BLINDING_set_thread_id, BN_BLINDING_set_flags, BN_BLINDING_get_flags +and BN_BLINDING_create_param were first introduced in OpenSSL 0.9.8 + +=head1 AUTHOR + +Nils Larsch for the OpenSSL project (http://www.openssl.org). + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ad8d07db8 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_CTX_new, BN_CTX_init, BN_CTX_free - allocate and free BN_CTX structures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BN_CTX *BN_CTX_new(void); + + void BN_CTX_init(BN_CTX *c); + + void BN_CTX_free(BN_CTX *c); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A B is a structure that holds B temporary variables used by +library functions. Since dynamic memory allocation to create Bs +is rather expensive when used in conjunction with repeated subroutine +calls, the B structure is used. + +BN_CTX_new() allocates and initializes a B +structure. BN_CTX_init() initializes an existing uninitialized +B. + +BN_CTX_free() frees the components of the B, and if it was +created by BN_CTX_new(), also the structure itself. +If L has been used on the B, +L must be called before the B +may be freed by BN_CTX_free(). + + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_CTX_new() returns a pointer to the B. If the allocation fails, +it returns B and sets an error code that can be obtained by +L. + +BN_CTX_init() and BN_CTX_free() have no return values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_CTX_new() and BN_CTX_free() are available in all versions on SSLeay +and OpenSSL. BN_CTX_init() was added in SSLeay 0.9.1b. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_start.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_start.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..dfcefe1a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_CTX_start.pod @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_CTX_start, BN_CTX_get, BN_CTX_end - use temporary BIGNUM variables + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void BN_CTX_start(BN_CTX *ctx); + + BIGNUM *BN_CTX_get(BN_CTX *ctx); + + void BN_CTX_end(BN_CTX *ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions are used to obtain temporary B variables from +a B (which can been created by using L) +in order to save the overhead of repeatedly creating and +freeing Bs in functions that are called from inside a loop. + +A function must call BN_CTX_start() first. Then, BN_CTX_get() may be +called repeatedly to obtain temporary Bs. All BN_CTX_get() +calls must be made before calling any other functions that use the +B as an argument. + +Finally, BN_CTX_end() must be called before returning from the function. +When BN_CTX_end() is called, the B pointers obtained from +BN_CTX_get() become invalid. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_CTX_start() and BN_CTX_end() return no values. + +BN_CTX_get() returns a pointer to the B, or B on error. +Once BN_CTX_get() has failed, the subsequent calls will return B +as well, so it is sufficient to check the return value of the last +BN_CTX_get() call. In case of an error, an error code is set, which +can be obtained by L. + + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_CTX_start(), BN_CTX_get() and BN_CTX_end() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..88c7a799e --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add.pod @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_add, BN_sub, BN_mul, BN_sqr, BN_div, BN_mod, BN_nnmod, BN_mod_add, +BN_mod_sub, BN_mod_mul, BN_mod_sqr, BN_exp, BN_mod_exp, BN_gcd - +arithmetic operations on BIGNUMs + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_add(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *b); + + int BN_sub(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *b); + + int BN_mul(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_sqr(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_div(BIGNUM *dv, BIGNUM *rem, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *d, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod(BIGNUM *rem, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_nnmod(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod_add(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod_sub(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod_mul(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod_sqr(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_exp(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *p, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod_exp(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *p, + const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_gcd(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_add() adds I and I and places the result in I (C). +I may be the same B as I or I. + +BN_sub() subtracts I from I and places the result in I (C). + +BN_mul() multiplies I and I and places the result in I (C). +I may be the same B as I or I. +For multiplication by powers of 2, use L. + +BN_sqr() takes the square of I and places the result in I +(C). I and I may be the same B. +This function is faster than BN_mul(r,a,a). + +BN_div() divides I by I and places the result in I and the +remainder in I (C). Either of I and I may +be B, in which case the respective value is not returned. +The result is rounded towards zero; thus if I is negative, the +remainder will be zero or negative. +For division by powers of 2, use BN_rshift(3). + +BN_mod() corresponds to BN_div() with I set to B. + +BN_nnmod() reduces I modulo I and places the non-negative +remainder in I. + +BN_mod_add() adds I to I modulo I and places the non-negative +result in I. + +BN_mod_sub() subtracts I from I modulo I and places the +non-negative result in I. + +BN_mod_mul() multiplies I by I and finds the non-negative +remainder respective to modulus I (C). I may be +the same B as I or I. For more efficient algorithms for +repeated computations using the same modulus, see +L and +L. + +BN_mod_sqr() takes the square of I modulo B and places the +result in I. + +BN_exp() raises I to the I

-th power and places the result in I +(C). This function is faster than repeated applications of +BN_mul(). + +BN_mod_exp() computes I to the I

-th power modulo I (C). This function uses less time and space than BN_exp(). + +BN_gcd() computes the greatest common divisor of I and I and +places the result in I. I may be the same B as I or +I. + +For all functions, I is a previously allocated B used for +temporary variables; see L. + +Unless noted otherwise, the result B must be different from +the arguments. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +For all functions, 1 is returned for success, 0 on error. The return +value should always be checked (e.g., C). +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_add(), BN_sub(), BN_sqr(), BN_div(), BN_mod(), BN_mod_mul(), +BN_mod_exp() and BN_gcd() are available in all versions of SSLeay and +OpenSSL. The I argument to BN_mul() was added in SSLeay +0.9.1b. BN_exp() appeared in SSLeay 0.9.0. +BN_nnmod(), BN_mod_add(), BN_mod_sub(), and BN_mod_sqr() were added in +OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add_word.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add_word.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..70667d289 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_add_word.pod @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_add_word, BN_sub_word, BN_mul_word, BN_div_word, BN_mod_word - arithmetic +functions on BIGNUMs with integers + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_add_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + + int BN_sub_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + + int BN_mul_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + + BN_ULONG BN_div_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + + BN_ULONG BN_mod_word(const BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions perform arithmetic operations on BIGNUMs with unsigned +integers. They are much more efficient than the normal BIGNUM +arithmetic operations. + +BN_add_word() adds B to B (C). + +BN_sub_word() subtracts B from B (C). + +BN_mul_word() multiplies B and B (C). + +BN_div_word() divides B by B (C) and returns the remainder. + +BN_mod_word() returns the remainder of B divided by B (C). + +For BN_div_word() and BN_mod_word(), B must not be 0. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_add_word(), BN_sub_word() and BN_mul_word() return 1 for success, 0 +on error. The error codes can be obtained by L. + +BN_mod_word() and BN_div_word() return B%B on success and +B<(BN_ULONG)-1> if an error occurred. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_add_word() and BN_mod_word() are available in all versions of +SSLeay and OpenSSL. BN_div_word() was added in SSLeay 0.8, and +BN_sub_word() and BN_mul_word() in SSLeay 0.9.0. + +Before 0.9.8a the return value for BN_div_word() and BN_mod_word() +in case of an error was 0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_bn2bin.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_bn2bin.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..a4b17ca60 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_bn2bin.pod @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_bn2bin, BN_bin2bn, BN_bn2hex, BN_bn2dec, BN_hex2bn, BN_dec2bn, +BN_print, BN_print_fp, BN_bn2mpi, BN_mpi2bn - format conversions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_bn2bin(const BIGNUM *a, unsigned char *to); + BIGNUM *BN_bin2bn(const unsigned char *s, int len, BIGNUM *ret); + + char *BN_bn2hex(const BIGNUM *a); + char *BN_bn2dec(const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_hex2bn(BIGNUM **a, const char *str); + int BN_dec2bn(BIGNUM **a, const char *str); + + int BN_print(BIO *fp, const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_print_fp(FILE *fp, const BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_bn2mpi(const BIGNUM *a, unsigned char *to); + BIGNUM *BN_mpi2bn(unsigned char *s, int len, BIGNUM *ret); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_bn2bin() converts the absolute value of B into big-endian form +and stores it at B. B must point to BN_num_bytes(B) bytes of +memory. + +BN_bin2bn() converts the positive integer in big-endian form of length +B at B into a B and places it in B. If B is +NULL, a new B is created. + +BN_bn2hex() and BN_bn2dec() return printable strings containing the +hexadecimal and decimal encoding of B respectively. For negative +numbers, the string is prefaced with a leading '-'. The string must be +freed later using OPENSSL_free(). + +BN_hex2bn() converts the string B containing a hexadecimal number +to a B and stores it in **B. If *B is NULL, a new +B is created. If B is NULL, it only computes the number's +length in hexadecimal digits. If the string starts with '-', the +number is negative. BN_dec2bn() is the same using the decimal system. + +BN_print() and BN_print_fp() write the hexadecimal encoding of B, +with a leading '-' for negative numbers, to the B or B +B. + +BN_bn2mpi() and BN_mpi2bn() convert Bs from and to a format +that consists of the number's length in bytes represented as a 4-byte +big-endian number, and the number itself in big-endian format, where +the most significant bit signals a negative number (the representation +of numbers with the MSB set is prefixed with null byte). + +BN_bn2mpi() stores the representation of B at B, where B +must be large enough to hold the result. The size can be determined by +calling BN_bn2mpi(B, NULL). + +BN_mpi2bn() converts the B bytes long representation at B to +a B and stores it at B, or in a newly allocated B +if B is NULL. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_bn2bin() returns the length of the big-endian number placed at B. +BN_bin2bn() returns the B, NULL on error. + +BN_bn2hex() and BN_bn2dec() return a null-terminated string, or NULL +on error. BN_hex2bn() and BN_dec2bn() return the number's length in +hexadecimal or decimal digits, and 0 on error. + +BN_print_fp() and BN_print() return 1 on success, 0 on write errors. + +BN_bn2mpi() returns the length of the representation. BN_mpi2bn() +returns the B, and NULL on error. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_bn2bin(), BN_bin2bn(), BN_print_fp() and BN_print() are available +in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +BN_bn2hex(), BN_bn2dec(), BN_hex2bn(), BN_dec2bn(), BN_bn2mpi() and +BN_mpi2bn() were added in SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_cmp.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_cmp.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..23e9ed0b4 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_cmp.pod @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_cmp, BN_ucmp, BN_is_zero, BN_is_one, BN_is_word, BN_is_odd - BIGNUM comparison and test functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_cmp(BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b); + int BN_ucmp(BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b); + + int BN_is_zero(BIGNUM *a); + int BN_is_one(BIGNUM *a); + int BN_is_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + int BN_is_odd(BIGNUM *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_cmp() compares the numbers B and B. BN_ucmp() compares their +absolute values. + +BN_is_zero(), BN_is_one() and BN_is_word() test if B equals 0, 1, +or B respectively. BN_is_odd() tests if a is odd. + +BN_is_zero(), BN_is_one(), BN_is_word() and BN_is_odd() are macros. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_cmp() returns -1 if B E B, 0 if B == B and 1 if +B E B. BN_ucmp() is the same using the absolute values +of B and B. + +BN_is_zero(), BN_is_one() BN_is_word() and BN_is_odd() return 1 if +the condition is true, 0 otherwise. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_cmp(), BN_ucmp(), BN_is_zero(), BN_is_one() and BN_is_word() are +available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +BN_is_odd() was added in SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_copy.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_copy.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..388dd7df2 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_copy.pod @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_copy, BN_dup - copy BIGNUMs + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIGNUM *BN_copy(BIGNUM *to, const BIGNUM *from); + + BIGNUM *BN_dup(const BIGNUM *from); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_copy() copies B to B. BN_dup() creates a new B +containing the value B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_copy() returns B on success, NULL on error. BN_dup() returns +the new B, and NULL on error. The error codes can be obtained +by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_copy() and BN_dup() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_generate_prime.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_generate_prime.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7dccacbc1 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_generate_prime.pod @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_generate_prime, BN_is_prime, BN_is_prime_fasttest - generate primes and test for primality + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIGNUM *BN_generate_prime(BIGNUM *ret, int num, int safe, BIGNUM *add, + BIGNUM *rem, void (*callback)(int, int, void *), void *cb_arg); + + int BN_is_prime(const BIGNUM *a, int checks, void (*callback)(int, int, + void *), BN_CTX *ctx, void *cb_arg); + + int BN_is_prime_fasttest(const BIGNUM *a, int checks, + void (*callback)(int, int, void *), BN_CTX *ctx, void *cb_arg, + int do_trial_division); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_generate_prime() generates a pseudo-random prime number of B +bits. +If B is not B, it will be used to store the number. + +If B is not B, it is called as follows: + +=over 4 + +=item * + +B is called after generating the i-th +potential prime number. + +=item * + +While the number is being tested for primality, B is called as described below. + +=item * + +When a prime has been found, B is called. + +=back + +The prime may have to fulfill additional requirements for use in +Diffie-Hellman key exchange: + +If B is not B, the prime will fulfill the condition p % B +== B (p % B == 1 if B == B) in order to suit a given +generator. + +If B is true, it will be a safe prime (i.e. a prime p so +that (p-1)/2 is also prime). + +The PRNG must be seeded prior to calling BN_generate_prime(). +The prime number generation has a negligible error probability. + +BN_is_prime() and BN_is_prime_fasttest() test if the number B is +prime. The following tests are performed until one of them shows that +B is composite; if B passes all these tests, it is considered +prime. + +BN_is_prime_fasttest(), when called with B, +first attempts trial division by a number of small primes; +if no divisors are found by this test and B is not B, +B is called. +If B, this test is skipped. + +Both BN_is_prime() and BN_is_prime_fasttest() perform a Miller-Rabin +probabilistic primality test with B iterations. If +B, a number of iterations is used that +yields a false positive rate of at most 2^-80 for random input. + +If B is not B, B is called +after the j-th iteration (j = 0, 1, ...). B is a +pre-allocated B (to save the overhead of allocating and +freeing the structure in a loop), or B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_generate_prime() returns the prime number on success, B otherwise. + +BN_is_prime() returns 0 if the number is composite, 1 if it is +prime with an error probability of less than 0.25^B, and +-1 on error. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The B arguments to BN_generate_prime() and to BN_is_prime() +were added in SSLeay 0.9.0. The B argument to BN_generate_prime() +was added in SSLeay 0.9.1. +BN_is_prime_fasttest() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_inverse.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_inverse.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3ea3975c7 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_inverse.pod @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_mod_inverse - compute inverse modulo n + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIGNUM *BN_mod_inverse(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *n, + BN_CTX *ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_mod_inverse() computes the inverse of B modulo B +places the result in B (C<(a*r)%n==1>). If B is NULL, +a new B is created. + +B is a previously allocated B used for temporary +variables. B may be the same B as B or B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_mod_inverse() returns the B containing the inverse, and +NULL on error. The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_mod_inverse() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_montgomery.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_montgomery.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..6b16351b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_montgomery.pod @@ -0,0 +1,101 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_mod_mul_montgomery, BN_MONT_CTX_new, BN_MONT_CTX_init, +BN_MONT_CTX_free, BN_MONT_CTX_set, BN_MONT_CTX_copy, +BN_from_montgomery, BN_to_montgomery - Montgomery multiplication + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BN_MONT_CTX *BN_MONT_CTX_new(void); + void BN_MONT_CTX_init(BN_MONT_CTX *ctx); + void BN_MONT_CTX_free(BN_MONT_CTX *mont); + + int BN_MONT_CTX_set(BN_MONT_CTX *mont, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + BN_MONT_CTX *BN_MONT_CTX_copy(BN_MONT_CTX *to, BN_MONT_CTX *from); + + int BN_mod_mul_montgomery(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, + BN_MONT_CTX *mont, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_from_montgomery(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BN_MONT_CTX *mont, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_to_montgomery(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BN_MONT_CTX *mont, + BN_CTX *ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions implement Montgomery multiplication. They are used +automatically when L is called with suitable input, +but they may be useful when several operations are to be performed +using the same modulus. + +BN_MONT_CTX_new() allocates and initializes a B structure. +BN_MONT_CTX_init() initializes an existing uninitialized B. + +BN_MONT_CTX_set() sets up the I structure from the modulus I +by precomputing its inverse and a value R. + +BN_MONT_CTX_copy() copies the B I to I. + +BN_MONT_CTX_free() frees the components of the B, and, if +it was created by BN_MONT_CTX_new(), also the structure itself. + +BN_mod_mul_montgomery() computes Mont(I,I):=I*I*R^-1 and places +the result in I. + +BN_from_montgomery() performs the Montgomery reduction I = I*R^-1. + +BN_to_montgomery() computes Mont(I,R^2), i.e. I*R. +Note that I must be non-negative and smaller than the modulus. + +For all functions, I is a previously allocated B used for +temporary variables. + +The B structure is defined as follows: + + typedef struct bn_mont_ctx_st + { + int ri; /* number of bits in R */ + BIGNUM RR; /* R^2 (used to convert to Montgomery form) */ + BIGNUM N; /* The modulus */ + BIGNUM Ni; /* R*(1/R mod N) - N*Ni = 1 + * (Ni is only stored for bignum algorithm) */ + BN_ULONG n0; /* least significant word of Ni */ + int flags; + } BN_MONT_CTX; + +BN_to_montgomery() is a macro. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_MONT_CTX_new() returns the newly allocated B, and NULL +on error. + +BN_MONT_CTX_init() and BN_MONT_CTX_free() have no return values. + +For the other functions, 1 is returned for success, 0 on error. +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 WARNING + +The inputs must be reduced modulo B, otherwise the result will be +outside the expected range. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_MONT_CTX_new(), BN_MONT_CTX_free(), BN_MONT_CTX_set(), +BN_mod_mul_montgomery(), BN_from_montgomery() and BN_to_montgomery() +are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +BN_MONT_CTX_init() and BN_MONT_CTX_copy() were added in SSLeay 0.9.1b. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_reciprocal.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_reciprocal.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..74a216ddc --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_mod_mul_reciprocal.pod @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_mod_mul_reciprocal, BN_div_recp, BN_RECP_CTX_new, BN_RECP_CTX_init, +BN_RECP_CTX_free, BN_RECP_CTX_set - modular multiplication using +reciprocal + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BN_RECP_CTX *BN_RECP_CTX_new(void); + void BN_RECP_CTX_init(BN_RECP_CTX *recp); + void BN_RECP_CTX_free(BN_RECP_CTX *recp); + + int BN_RECP_CTX_set(BN_RECP_CTX *recp, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_div_recp(BIGNUM *dv, BIGNUM *rem, BIGNUM *a, BN_RECP_CTX *recp, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_mod_mul_reciprocal(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, + BN_RECP_CTX *recp, BN_CTX *ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_mod_mul_reciprocal() can be used to perform an efficient +L operation when the operation will be performed +repeatedly with the same modulus. It computes B=(B*B)%B +using B=1/B, which is set as described below. B is a +previously allocated B used for temporary variables. + +BN_RECP_CTX_new() allocates and initializes a B structure. +BN_RECP_CTX_init() initializes an existing uninitialized B. + +BN_RECP_CTX_free() frees the components of the B, and, if it +was created by BN_RECP_CTX_new(), also the structure itself. + +BN_RECP_CTX_set() stores B in B and sets it up for computing +1/B and shifting it left by BN_num_bits(B)+1 to make it an +integer. The result and the number of bits it was shifted left will +later be stored in B. + +BN_div_recp() divides B by B using B. It places the quotient +in B and the remainder in B. + +The B structure is defined as follows: + + typedef struct bn_recp_ctx_st + { + BIGNUM N; /* the divisor */ + BIGNUM Nr; /* the reciprocal */ + int num_bits; + int shift; + int flags; + } BN_RECP_CTX; + +It cannot be shared between threads. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_RECP_CTX_new() returns the newly allocated B, and NULL +on error. + +BN_RECP_CTX_init() and BN_RECP_CTX_free() have no return values. + +For the other functions, 1 is returned for success, 0 on error. +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +B was added in SSLeay 0.9.0. Before that, the function +BN_reciprocal() was used instead, and the BN_mod_mul_reciprocal() +arguments were different. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ab7a105e3 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_new, BN_init, BN_clear, BN_free, BN_clear_free - allocate and free BIGNUMs + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIGNUM *BN_new(void); + + void BN_init(BIGNUM *); + + void BN_clear(BIGNUM *a); + + void BN_free(BIGNUM *a); + + void BN_clear_free(BIGNUM *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_new() allocates and initializes a B structure. BN_init() +initializes an existing uninitialized B. + +BN_clear() is used to destroy sensitive data such as keys when they +are no longer needed. It erases the memory used by B and sets it +to the value 0. + +BN_free() frees the components of the B, and if it was created +by BN_new(), also the structure itself. BN_clear_free() additionally +overwrites the data before the memory is returned to the system. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_new() returns a pointer to the B. If the allocation fails, +it returns B and sets an error code that can be obtained +by L. + +BN_init(), BN_clear(), BN_free() and BN_clear_free() have no return +values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_new(), BN_clear(), BN_free() and BN_clear_free() are available in +all versions on SSLeay and OpenSSL. BN_init() was added in SSLeay +0.9.1b. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_num_bytes.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_num_bytes.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..a6a2e3f81 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_num_bytes.pod @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_num_bits, BN_num_bytes, BN_num_bits_word - get BIGNUM size + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_num_bytes(const BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_num_bits(const BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_num_bits_word(BN_ULONG w); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_num_bytes() returns the size of a B in bytes. + +BN_num_bits_word() returns the number of significant bits in a word. +If we take 0x00000432 as an example, it returns 11, not 16, not 32. +Basically, except for a zero, it returns I. + +BN_num_bits() returns the number of significant bits in a B, +following the same principle as BN_num_bits_word(). + +BN_num_bytes() is a macro. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +The size. + +=head1 NOTES + +Some have tried using BN_num_bits() on individual numbers in RSA keys, +DH keys and DSA keys, and found that they don't always come up with +the number of bits they expected (something like 512, 1024, 2048, +...). This is because generating a number with some specific number +of bits doesn't always set the highest bits, thereby making the number +of I bits a little lower. If you want to know the "key +size" of such a key, either use functions like RSA_size(), DH_size() +and DSA_size(), or use BN_num_bytes() and multiply with 8 (although +there's no real guarantee that will match the "key size", just a lot +more probability). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_num_bytes(), BN_num_bits() and BN_num_bits_word() are available in +all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_rand.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_rand.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..81f93c2eb --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_rand.pod @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_rand, BN_pseudo_rand - generate pseudo-random number + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_rand(BIGNUM *rnd, int bits, int top, int bottom); + + int BN_pseudo_rand(BIGNUM *rnd, int bits, int top, int bottom); + + int BN_rand_range(BIGNUM *rnd, BIGNUM *range); + + int BN_pseudo_rand_range(BIGNUM *rnd, BIGNUM *range); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_rand() generates a cryptographically strong pseudo-random number of +B bits in length and stores it in B. If B is -1, the +most significant bit of the random number can be zero. If B is 0, +it is set to 1, and if B is 1, the two most significant bits of +the number will be set to 1, so that the product of two such random +numbers will always have 2*B length. If B is true, the +number will be odd. + +BN_pseudo_rand() does the same, but pseudo-random numbers generated by +this function are not necessarily unpredictable. They can be used for +non-cryptographic purposes and for certain purposes in cryptographic +protocols, but usually not for key generation etc. + +BN_rand_range() generates a cryptographically strong pseudo-random +number B in the range 0 = B E B. +BN_pseudo_rand_range() does the same, but is based on BN_pseudo_rand(), +and hence numbers generated by it are not necessarily unpredictable. + +The PRNG must be seeded prior to calling BN_rand() or BN_rand_range(). + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +The functions return 1 on success, 0 on error. +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_rand() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +BN_pseudo_rand() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.5. The B == -1 case +and the function BN_rand_range() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.6a. +BN_pseudo_rand_range() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.6c. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_set_bit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_set_bit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b7c47b9b0 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_set_bit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_set_bit, BN_clear_bit, BN_is_bit_set, BN_mask_bits, BN_lshift, +BN_lshift1, BN_rshift, BN_rshift1 - bit operations on BIGNUMs + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_set_bit(BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_clear_bit(BIGNUM *a, int n); + + int BN_is_bit_set(const BIGNUM *a, int n); + + int BN_mask_bits(BIGNUM *a, int n); + + int BN_lshift(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_lshift1(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_rshift(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_rshift1(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_set_bit() sets bit B in B to 1 (CEn)>). The +number is expanded if necessary. + +BN_clear_bit() sets bit B in B to 0 (CEn)>). An +error occurs if B is shorter than B bits. + +BN_is_bit_set() tests if bit B in B is set. + +BN_mask_bits() truncates B to an B bit number +(CEn)>). An error occurs if B already is +shorter than B bits. + +BN_lshift() shifts B left by B bits and places the result in +B (C). BN_lshift1() shifts B left by one and places +the result in B (C). + +BN_rshift() shifts B right by B bits and places the result in +B (C). BN_rshift1() shifts B right by one and places +the result in B (C). + +For the shift functions, B and B may be the same variable. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_is_bit_set() returns 1 if the bit is set, 0 otherwise. + +All other functions return 1 for success, 0 on error. The error codes +can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_set_bit(), BN_clear_bit(), BN_is_bit_set(), BN_mask_bits(), +BN_lshift(), BN_lshift1(), BN_rshift(), and BN_rshift1() are available +in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_swap.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_swap.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..79efaa144 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_swap.pod @@ -0,0 +1,23 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_swap - exchange BIGNUMs + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void BN_swap(BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_swap() exchanges the values of I and I. + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_swap was added in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_zero.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_zero.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b555ec398 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/BN_zero.pod @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BN_zero, BN_one, BN_value_one, BN_set_word, BN_get_word - BIGNUM assignment +operations + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int BN_zero(BIGNUM *a); + int BN_one(BIGNUM *a); + + const BIGNUM *BN_value_one(void); + + int BN_set_word(BIGNUM *a, unsigned long w); + unsigned long BN_get_word(BIGNUM *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +BN_zero(), BN_one() and BN_set_word() set B to the values 0, 1 and +B respectively. BN_zero() and BN_one() are macros. + +BN_value_one() returns a B constant of value 1. This constant +is useful for use in comparisons and assignment. + +BN_get_word() returns B, if it can be represented as an unsigned +long. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BN_get_word() returns the value B, and 0xffffffffL if B cannot +be represented as an unsigned long. + +BN_zero(), BN_one() and BN_set_word() return 1 on success, 0 otherwise. +BN_value_one() returns the constant. + +=head1 BUGS + +Someone might change the constant. + +If a B is equal to 0xffffffffL it can be represented as an +unsigned long but this value is also returned on error. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BN_zero(), BN_one() and BN_set_word() are available in all versions of +SSLeay and OpenSSL. BN_value_one() and BN_get_word() were added in +SSLeay 0.8. + +BN_value_one() was changed to return a true const BIGNUM * in OpenSSL +0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_free.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_free.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..87bc7b783 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_free.pod @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + + CONF_modules_free, CONF_modules_finish, CONF_modules_unload - + OpenSSL configuration cleanup functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void CONF_modules_free(void); + void CONF_modules_finish(void); + void CONF_modules_unload(int all); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +CONF_modules_free() closes down and frees up all memory allocated by all +configuration modules. + +CONF_modules_finish() calls each configuration modules B handler +to free up any configuration that module may have performed. + +CONF_modules_unload() finishes and unloads configuration modules. If +B is set to B<0> only modules loaded from DSOs will be unloads. If +B is B<1> all modules, including builtin modules will be unloaded. + +=head1 NOTES + +Normally applications will only call CONF_modules_free() at application to +tidy up any configuration performed. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +None of the functions return a value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +CONF_modules_free(), CONF_modules_unload(), and CONF_modules_finish() +first appeared in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_load_file.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_load_file.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9965d69bf --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/CONF_modules_load_file.pod @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + + CONF_modules_load_file, CONF_modules_load - OpenSSL configuration functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int CONF_modules_load_file(const char *filename, const char *appname, + unsigned long flags); + int CONF_modules_load(const CONF *cnf, const char *appname, + unsigned long flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The function CONF_modules_load_file() configures OpenSSL using file +B and application name B. If B is NULL +the standard OpenSSL configuration file is used. If B is +NULL the standard OpenSSL application name B is used. +The behaviour can be cutomized using B. + +CONF_modules_load() is idential to CONF_modules_load_file() except it +read configuration information from B. + +=head1 NOTES + +The following B are currently recognized: + +B if set errors returned by individual +configuration modules are ignored. If not set the first module error is +considered fatal and no further modules are loads. + +Normally any modules errors will add error information to the error queue. If +B is set no error information is added. + +If B is set configuration module loading from DSOs is +disabled. + +B if set will make CONF_load_modules_file() +ignore missing configuration files. Normally a missing configuration file +return an error. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +These functions return 1 for success and a zero or negative value for +failure. If module errors are not ignored the return code will reflect the +return value of the failing module (this will always be zero or negative). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +CONF_modules_load_file and CONF_modules_load first appeared in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/CRYPTO_set_ex_data.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/CRYPTO_set_ex_data.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1bd5bed67 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/CRYPTO_set_ex_data.pod @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +CRYPTO_set_ex_data, CRYPTO_get_ex_data - internal application specific data functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + int CRYPTO_set_ex_data(CRYPTO_EX_DATA *r, int idx, void *arg); + + void *CRYPTO_get_ex_data(CRYPTO_EX_DATA *r, int idx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +Several OpenSSL structures can have application specific data attached to them. +These functions are used internally by OpenSSL to manipulate application +specific data attached to a specific structure. + +These functions should only be used by applications to manipulate +B structures passed to the B, B and +B callbacks: as passed to B for example. + +B is used to set application specific data, the data is +supplied in the B parameter and its precise meaning is up to the +application. + +B is used to retrieve application specific data. The data +is returned to the application, this will be the same value as supplied to +a previous B call. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +B returns 1 on success or 0 on failure. + +B returns the application data or 0 on failure. 0 may also +be valid application data but currently it can only fail if given an invalid B +parameter. + +On failure an error code can be obtained from L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +CRYPTO_set_ex_data() and CRYPTO_get_ex_data() have been available since SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_key.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_key.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..81f09fdf4 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_key.pod @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DH_generate_key, DH_compute_key - perform Diffie-Hellman key exchange + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DH_generate_key(DH *dh); + + int DH_compute_key(unsigned char *key, BIGNUM *pub_key, DH *dh); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DH_generate_key() performs the first step of a Diffie-Hellman key +exchange by generating private and public DH values. By calling +DH_compute_key(), these are combined with the other party's public +value to compute the shared key. + +DH_generate_key() expects B to contain the shared parameters +Bp> and Bg>. It generates a random private DH value +unless Bpriv_key> is already set, and computes the +corresponding public value Bpub_key>, which can then be +published. + +DH_compute_key() computes the shared secret from the private DH value +in B and the other party's public value in B and stores +it in B. B must point to B bytes of memory. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +DH_generate_key() returns 1 on success, 0 otherwise. + +DH_compute_key() returns the size of the shared secret on success, -1 +on error. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DH_generate_key() and DH_compute_key() are available in all versions +of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_parameters.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_parameters.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9081e9ea7 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_generate_parameters.pod @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DH_generate_parameters, DH_check - generate and check Diffie-Hellman parameters + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DH *DH_generate_parameters(int prime_len, int generator, + void (*callback)(int, int, void *), void *cb_arg); + + int DH_check(DH *dh, int *codes); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DH_generate_parameters() generates Diffie-Hellman parameters that can +be shared among a group of users, and returns them in a newly +allocated B structure. The pseudo-random number generator must be +seeded prior to calling DH_generate_parameters(). + +B is the length in bits of the safe prime to be generated. +B is a small number E 1, typically 2 or 5. + +A callback function may be used to provide feedback about the progress +of the key generation. If B is not B, it will be +called as described in L while a random prime +number is generated, and when a prime has been found, B is called. + +DH_check() validates Diffie-Hellman parameters. It checks that B

is +a safe prime, and that B is a suitable generator. In the case of an +error, the bit flags DH_CHECK_P_NOT_SAFE_PRIME or +DH_NOT_SUITABLE_GENERATOR are set in B<*codes>. +DH_UNABLE_TO_CHECK_GENERATOR is set if the generator cannot be +checked, i.e. it does not equal 2 or 5. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +DH_generate_parameters() returns a pointer to the DH structure, or +NULL if the parameter generation fails. The error codes can be +obtained by L. + +DH_check() returns 1 if the check could be performed, 0 otherwise. + +=head1 NOTES + +DH_generate_parameters() may run for several hours before finding a +suitable prime. + +The parameters generated by DH_generate_parameters() are not to be +used in signature schemes. + +=head1 BUGS + +If B is not 2 or 5, Bg>=B is not +a usable generator. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DH_check() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +The B argument to DH_generate_parameters() was added in SSLeay 0.9.0. + +In versions before OpenSSL 0.9.5, DH_CHECK_P_NOT_STRONG_PRIME is used +instead of DH_CHECK_P_NOT_SAFE_PRIME. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_get_ex_new_index.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_get_ex_new_index.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..fa5eab265 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_get_ex_new_index.pod @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DH_get_ex_new_index, DH_set_ex_data, DH_get_ex_data - add application specific data to DH structures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DH_get_ex_new_index(long argl, void *argp, + CRYPTO_EX_new *new_func, + CRYPTO_EX_dup *dup_func, + CRYPTO_EX_free *free_func); + + int DH_set_ex_data(DH *d, int idx, void *arg); + + char *DH_get_ex_data(DH *d, int idx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions handle application specific data in DH +structures. Their usage is identical to that of +RSA_get_ex_new_index(), RSA_set_ex_data() and RSA_get_ex_data() +as described in L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DH_get_ex_new_index(), DH_set_ex_data() and DH_get_ex_data() are +available since OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..60c930093 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DH_new, DH_free - allocate and free DH objects + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DH* DH_new(void); + + void DH_free(DH *dh); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DH_new() allocates and initializes a B structure. + +DH_free() frees the B structure and its components. The values are +erased before the memory is returned to the system. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +If the allocation fails, DH_new() returns B and sets an error +code that can be obtained by L. Otherwise it returns +a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +DH_free() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DH_new() and DH_free() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_set_method.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_set_method.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..d5cdc3be0 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_set_method.pod @@ -0,0 +1,129 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DH_set_default_method, DH_get_default_method, +DH_set_method, DH_new_method, DH_OpenSSL - select DH method + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + void DH_set_default_method(const DH_METHOD *meth); + + const DH_METHOD *DH_get_default_method(void); + + int DH_set_method(DH *dh, const DH_METHOD *meth); + + DH *DH_new_method(ENGINE *engine); + + const DH_METHOD *DH_OpenSSL(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A B specifies the functions that OpenSSL uses for Diffie-Hellman +operations. By modifying the method, alternative implementations +such as hardware accelerators may be used. IMPORTANT: See the NOTES section for +important information about how these DH API functions are affected by the use +of B API calls. + +Initially, the default DH_METHOD is the OpenSSL internal implementation, as +returned by DH_OpenSSL(). + +DH_set_default_method() makes B the default method for all DH +structures created later. B: This is true only whilst no ENGINE has been set +as a default for DH, so this function is no longer recommended. + +DH_get_default_method() returns a pointer to the current default DH_METHOD. +However, the meaningfulness of this result is dependent on whether the ENGINE +API is being used, so this function is no longer recommended. + +DH_set_method() selects B to perform all operations using the key B. +This will replace the DH_METHOD used by the DH key and if the previous method +was supplied by an ENGINE, the handle to that ENGINE will be released during the +change. It is possible to have DH keys that only work with certain DH_METHOD +implementations (eg. from an ENGINE module that supports embedded +hardware-protected keys), and in such cases attempting to change the DH_METHOD +for the key can have unexpected results. + +DH_new_method() allocates and initializes a DH structure so that B will +be used for the DH operations. If B is NULL, the default ENGINE for DH +operations is used, and if no default ENGINE is set, the DH_METHOD controlled by +DH_set_default_method() is used. + +=head1 THE DH_METHOD STRUCTURE + + typedef struct dh_meth_st + { + /* name of the implementation */ + const char *name; + + /* generate private and public DH values for key agreement */ + int (*generate_key)(DH *dh); + + /* compute shared secret */ + int (*compute_key)(unsigned char *key, BIGNUM *pub_key, DH *dh); + + /* compute r = a ^ p mod m (May be NULL for some implementations) */ + int (*bn_mod_exp)(DH *dh, BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *p, + const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx, + BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx); + + /* called at DH_new */ + int (*init)(DH *dh); + + /* called at DH_free */ + int (*finish)(DH *dh); + + int flags; + + char *app_data; /* ?? */ + + } DH_METHOD; + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +DH_OpenSSL() and DH_get_default_method() return pointers to the respective +Bs. + +DH_set_default_method() returns no value. + +DH_set_method() returns non-zero if the provided B was successfully set as +the method for B (including unloading the ENGINE handle if the previous +method was supplied by an ENGINE). + +DH_new_method() returns NULL and sets an error code that can be obtained by +L if the allocation fails. Otherwise it +returns a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +=head1 NOTES + +As of version 0.9.7, DH_METHOD implementations are grouped together with other +algorithmic APIs (eg. RSA_METHOD, EVP_CIPHER, etc) in B modules. If a +default ENGINE is specified for DH functionality using an ENGINE API function, +that will override any DH defaults set using the DH API (ie. +DH_set_default_method()). For this reason, the ENGINE API is the recommended way +to control default implementations for use in DH and other cryptographic +algorithms. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DH_set_default_method(), DH_get_default_method(), DH_set_method(), +DH_new_method() and DH_OpenSSL() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.4. + +DH_set_default_openssl_method() and DH_get_default_openssl_method() replaced +DH_set_default_method() and DH_get_default_method() respectively, and +DH_set_method() and DH_new_method() were altered to use Bs rather than +Bs during development of the engine version of OpenSSL 0.9.6. For +0.9.7, the handling of defaults in the ENGINE API was restructured so that this +change was reversed, and behaviour of the other functions resembled more closely +the previous behaviour. The behaviour of defaults in the ENGINE API now +transparently overrides the behaviour of defaults in the DH API without +requiring changing these function prototypes. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_size.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_size.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..97f26fda7 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DH_size.pod @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DH_size - get Diffie-Hellman prime size + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DH_size(DH *dh); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This function returns the Diffie-Hellman size in bytes. It can be used +to determine how much memory must be allocated for the shared secret +computed by DH_compute_key(). + +Bp> must not be B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +The size in bytes. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DH_size() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_SIG_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_SIG_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3ac614003 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_SIG_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_SIG_new, DSA_SIG_free - allocate and free DSA signature objects + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DSA_SIG *DSA_SIG_new(void); + + void DSA_SIG_free(DSA_SIG *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_SIG_new() allocates and initializes a B structure. + +DSA_SIG_free() frees the B structure and its components. The +values are erased before the memory is returned to the system. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +If the allocation fails, DSA_SIG_new() returns B and sets an +error code that can be obtained by +L. Otherwise it returns a pointer +to the newly allocated structure. + +DSA_SIG_free() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_SIG_new() and DSA_SIG_free() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.3. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_do_sign.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_do_sign.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..5dfc733b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_do_sign.pod @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_do_sign, DSA_do_verify - raw DSA signature operations + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DSA_SIG *DSA_do_sign(const unsigned char *dgst, int dlen, DSA *dsa); + + int DSA_do_verify(const unsigned char *dgst, int dgst_len, + DSA_SIG *sig, DSA *dsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_do_sign() computes a digital signature on the B byte message +digest B using the private key B and returns it in a +newly allocated B structure. + +L may be used to precompute part +of the signing operation in case signature generation is +time-critical. + +DSA_do_verify() verifies that the signature B matches a given +message digest B of size B. B is the signer's public +key. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +DSA_do_sign() returns the signature, NULL on error. DSA_do_verify() +returns 1 for a valid signature, 0 for an incorrect signature and -1 +on error. The error codes can be obtained by +L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_do_sign() and DSA_do_verify() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.3. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_dup_DH.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_dup_DH.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7f6f0d111 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_dup_DH.pod @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_dup_DH - create a DH structure out of DSA structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DH * DSA_dup_DH(const DSA *r); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_dup_DH() duplicates DSA parameters/keys as DH parameters/keys. q +is lost during that conversion, but the resulting DH parameters +contain its length. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +DSA_dup_DH() returns the new B structure, and NULL on error. The +error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 NOTE + +Be careful to avoid small subgroup attacks when using this. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_dup_DH() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.4. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_key.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_key.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..af83ccfaa --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_key.pod @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_generate_key - generate DSA key pair + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DSA_generate_key(DSA *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_generate_key() expects B to contain DSA parameters. It generates +a new key pair and stores it in Bpub_key> and Bpriv_key>. + +The PRNG must be seeded prior to calling DSA_generate_key(). + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +DSA_generate_key() returns 1 on success, 0 otherwise. +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_generate_key() is available since SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_parameters.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_parameters.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..be7c924ff --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_generate_parameters.pod @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_generate_parameters - generate DSA parameters + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DSA *DSA_generate_parameters(int bits, unsigned char *seed, + int seed_len, int *counter_ret, unsigned long *h_ret, + void (*callback)(int, int, void *), void *cb_arg); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_generate_parameters() generates primes p and q and a generator g +for use in the DSA. + +B is the length of the prime to be generated; the DSS allows a +maximum of 1024 bits. + +If B is B or B E 20, the primes will be +generated at random. Otherwise, the seed is used to generate +them. If the given seed does not yield a prime q, a new random +seed is chosen and placed at B. + +DSA_generate_parameters() places the iteration count in +*B and a counter used for finding a generator in +*B, unless these are B. + +A callback function may be used to provide feedback about the progress +of the key generation. If B is not B, it will be +called as follows: + +=over 4 + +=item * + +When a candidate for q is generated, B is called +(m is 0 for the first candidate). + +=item * + +When a candidate for q has passed a test by trial division, +B is called. +While a candidate for q is tested by Miller-Rabin primality tests, +B is called in the outer loop +(once for each witness that confirms that the candidate may be prime); +i is the loop counter (starting at 0). + +=item * + +When a prime q has been found, B and +B are called. + +=item * + +Before a candidate for p (other than the first) is generated and tested, +B is called. + +=item * + +When a candidate for p has passed the test by trial division, +B is called. +While it is tested by the Miller-Rabin primality test, +B is called in the outer loop +(once for each witness that confirms that the candidate may be prime). +i is the loop counter (starting at 0). + +=item * + +When p has been found, B is called. + +=item * + +When the generator has been found, B is called. + +=back + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +DSA_generate_parameters() returns a pointer to the DSA structure, or +B if the parameter generation fails. The error codes can be +obtained by L. + +=head1 BUGS + +Seed lengths E 20 are not supported. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_generate_parameters() appeared in SSLeay 0.8. The B +argument was added in SSLeay 0.9.0. +In versions up to OpenSSL 0.9.4, B was called +in the inner loop of the Miller-Rabin test whenever it reached the +squaring step (the parameters to B did not reveal how many +witnesses had been tested); since OpenSSL 0.9.5, B +is called as in BN_is_prime(3), i.e. once for each witness. +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_get_ex_new_index.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_get_ex_new_index.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..4612e708e --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_get_ex_new_index.pod @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_get_ex_new_index, DSA_set_ex_data, DSA_get_ex_data - add application specific data to DSA structures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DSA_get_ex_new_index(long argl, void *argp, + CRYPTO_EX_new *new_func, + CRYPTO_EX_dup *dup_func, + CRYPTO_EX_free *free_func); + + int DSA_set_ex_data(DSA *d, int idx, void *arg); + + char *DSA_get_ex_data(DSA *d, int idx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions handle application specific data in DSA +structures. Their usage is identical to that of +RSA_get_ex_new_index(), RSA_set_ex_data() and RSA_get_ex_data() +as described in L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_get_ex_new_index(), DSA_set_ex_data() and DSA_get_ex_data() are +available since OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..48e9b82a0 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_new, DSA_free - allocate and free DSA objects + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DSA* DSA_new(void); + + void DSA_free(DSA *dsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_new() allocates and initializes a B structure. It is equivalent to +calling DSA_new_method(NULL). + +DSA_free() frees the B structure and its components. The values are +erased before the memory is returned to the system. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +If the allocation fails, DSA_new() returns B and sets an error +code that can be obtained by +L. Otherwise it returns a pointer +to the newly allocated structure. + +DSA_free() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_new() and DSA_free() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_set_method.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_set_method.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9c1434bd8 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_set_method.pod @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_set_default_method, DSA_get_default_method, +DSA_set_method, DSA_new_method, DSA_OpenSSL - select DSA method + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + void DSA_set_default_method(const DSA_METHOD *meth); + + const DSA_METHOD *DSA_get_default_method(void); + + int DSA_set_method(DSA *dsa, const DSA_METHOD *meth); + + DSA *DSA_new_method(ENGINE *engine); + + DSA_METHOD *DSA_OpenSSL(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A B specifies the functions that OpenSSL uses for DSA +operations. By modifying the method, alternative implementations +such as hardware accelerators may be used. IMPORTANT: See the NOTES section for +important information about how these DSA API functions are affected by the use +of B API calls. + +Initially, the default DSA_METHOD is the OpenSSL internal implementation, +as returned by DSA_OpenSSL(). + +DSA_set_default_method() makes B the default method for all DSA +structures created later. B: This is true only whilst no ENGINE has +been set as a default for DSA, so this function is no longer recommended. + +DSA_get_default_method() returns a pointer to the current default +DSA_METHOD. However, the meaningfulness of this result is dependent on +whether the ENGINE API is being used, so this function is no longer +recommended. + +DSA_set_method() selects B to perform all operations using the key +B. This will replace the DSA_METHOD used by the DSA key and if the +previous method was supplied by an ENGINE, the handle to that ENGINE will +be released during the change. It is possible to have DSA keys that only +work with certain DSA_METHOD implementations (eg. from an ENGINE module +that supports embedded hardware-protected keys), and in such cases +attempting to change the DSA_METHOD for the key can have unexpected +results. + +DSA_new_method() allocates and initializes a DSA structure so that B +will be used for the DSA operations. If B is NULL, the default engine +for DSA operations is used, and if no default ENGINE is set, the DSA_METHOD +controlled by DSA_set_default_method() is used. + +=head1 THE DSA_METHOD STRUCTURE + +struct + { + /* name of the implementation */ + const char *name; + + /* sign */ + DSA_SIG *(*dsa_do_sign)(const unsigned char *dgst, int dlen, + DSA *dsa); + + /* pre-compute k^-1 and r */ + int (*dsa_sign_setup)(DSA *dsa, BN_CTX *ctx_in, BIGNUM **kinvp, + BIGNUM **rp); + + /* verify */ + int (*dsa_do_verify)(const unsigned char *dgst, int dgst_len, + DSA_SIG *sig, DSA *dsa); + + /* compute rr = a1^p1 * a2^p2 mod m (May be NULL for some + implementations) */ + int (*dsa_mod_exp)(DSA *dsa, BIGNUM *rr, BIGNUM *a1, BIGNUM *p1, + BIGNUM *a2, BIGNUM *p2, BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx, BN_MONT_CTX *in_mont); + + /* compute r = a ^ p mod m (May be NULL for some implementations) */ + int (*bn_mod_exp)(DSA *dsa, BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, + const BIGNUM *p, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx, BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx); + + /* called at DSA_new */ + int (*init)(DSA *DSA); + + /* called at DSA_free */ + int (*finish)(DSA *DSA); + + int flags; + + char *app_data; /* ?? */ + + } DSA_METHOD; + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +DSA_OpenSSL() and DSA_get_default_method() return pointers to the respective +Bs. + +DSA_set_default_method() returns no value. + +DSA_set_method() returns non-zero if the provided B was successfully set as +the method for B (including unloading the ENGINE handle if the previous +method was supplied by an ENGINE). + +DSA_new_method() returns NULL and sets an error code that can be +obtained by L if the allocation +fails. Otherwise it returns a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +=head1 NOTES + +As of version 0.9.7, DSA_METHOD implementations are grouped together with other +algorithmic APIs (eg. RSA_METHOD, EVP_CIPHER, etc) in B modules. If a +default ENGINE is specified for DSA functionality using an ENGINE API function, +that will override any DSA defaults set using the DSA API (ie. +DSA_set_default_method()). For this reason, the ENGINE API is the recommended way +to control default implementations for use in DSA and other cryptographic +algorithms. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_set_default_method(), DSA_get_default_method(), DSA_set_method(), +DSA_new_method() and DSA_OpenSSL() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.4. + +DSA_set_default_openssl_method() and DSA_get_default_openssl_method() replaced +DSA_set_default_method() and DSA_get_default_method() respectively, and +DSA_set_method() and DSA_new_method() were altered to use Bs rather than +Bs during development of the engine version of OpenSSL 0.9.6. For +0.9.7, the handling of defaults in the ENGINE API was restructured so that this +change was reversed, and behaviour of the other functions resembled more closely +the previous behaviour. The behaviour of defaults in the ENGINE API now +transparently overrides the behaviour of defaults in the DSA API without +requiring changing these function prototypes. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_sign.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_sign.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..97389e8ec --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_sign.pod @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_sign, DSA_sign_setup, DSA_verify - DSA signatures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DSA_sign(int type, const unsigned char *dgst, int len, + unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, DSA *dsa); + + int DSA_sign_setup(DSA *dsa, BN_CTX *ctx, BIGNUM **kinvp, + BIGNUM **rp); + + int DSA_verify(int type, const unsigned char *dgst, int len, + unsigned char *sigbuf, int siglen, DSA *dsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +DSA_sign() computes a digital signature on the B byte message +digest B using the private key B and places its ASN.1 DER +encoding at B. The length of the signature is places in +*B. B must point to DSA_size(B) bytes of memory. + +DSA_sign_setup() may be used to precompute part of the signing +operation in case signature generation is time-critical. It expects +B to contain DSA parameters. It places the precomputed values +in newly allocated Bs at *B and *B, after freeing +the old ones unless *B and *B are NULL. These values may +be passed to DSA_sign() in Bkinv> and Br>. +B is a pre-allocated B or NULL. + +DSA_verify() verifies that the signature B of size B +matches a given message digest B of size B. +B is the signer's public key. + +The B parameter is ignored. + +The PRNG must be seeded before DSA_sign() (or DSA_sign_setup()) +is called. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +DSA_sign() and DSA_sign_setup() return 1 on success, 0 on error. +DSA_verify() returns 1 for a valid signature, 0 for an incorrect +signature and -1 on error. The error codes can be obtained by +L. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +US Federal Information Processing Standard FIPS 186 (Digital Signature +Standard, DSS), ANSI X9.30 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_sign() and DSA_verify() are available in all versions of SSLeay. +DSA_sign_setup() was added in SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_size.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_size.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ba4f65036 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/DSA_size.pod @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DSA_size - get DSA signature size + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int DSA_size(const DSA *dsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This function returns the size of an ASN.1 encoded DSA signature in +bytes. It can be used to determine how much memory must be allocated +for a DSA signature. + +Bq> must not be B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +The size in bytes. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +DSA_size() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_GET_LIB.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_GET_LIB.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2a129da03 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_GET_LIB.pod @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_GET_LIB, ERR_GET_FUNC, ERR_GET_REASON - get library, function and +reason code + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int ERR_GET_LIB(unsigned long e); + + int ERR_GET_FUNC(unsigned long e); + + int ERR_GET_REASON(unsigned long e); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The error code returned by ERR_get_error() consists of a library +number, function code and reason code. ERR_GET_LIB(), ERR_GET_FUNC() +and ERR_GET_REASON() can be used to extract these. + +The library number and function code describe where the error +occurred, the reason code is the information about what went wrong. + +Each sub-library of OpenSSL has a unique library number; function and +reason codes are unique within each sub-library. Note that different +libraries may use the same value to signal different functions and +reasons. + +B reason codes such as B are globally +unique. However, when checking for sub-library specific reason codes, +be sure to also compare the library number. + +ERR_GET_LIB(), ERR_GET_FUNC() and ERR_GET_REASON() are macros. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +The library number, function code and reason code respectively. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_GET_LIB(), ERR_GET_FUNC() and ERR_GET_REASON() are available in +all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_clear_error.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_clear_error.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..566e1f4e3 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_clear_error.pod @@ -0,0 +1,29 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_clear_error - clear the error queue + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void ERR_clear_error(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_clear_error() empties the current thread's error queue. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ERR_clear_error() has no return value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_clear_error() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_error_string.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_error_string.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..cdfa7fe1f --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_error_string.pod @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_error_string, ERR_error_string_n, ERR_lib_error_string, +ERR_func_error_string, ERR_reason_error_string - obtain human-readable +error message + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + char *ERR_error_string(unsigned long e, char *buf); + void ERR_error_string_n(unsigned long e, char *buf, size_t len); + + const char *ERR_lib_error_string(unsigned long e); + const char *ERR_func_error_string(unsigned long e); + const char *ERR_reason_error_string(unsigned long e); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_error_string() generates a human-readable string representing the +error code I, and places it at I. I must be at least 120 +bytes long. If I is B, the error string is placed in a +static buffer. +ERR_error_string_n() is a variant of ERR_error_string() that writes +at most I characters (including the terminating 0) +and truncates the string if necessary. +For ERR_error_string_n(), I may not be B. + +The string will have the following format: + + error:[error code]:[library name]:[function name]:[reason string] + +I is an 8 digit hexadecimal number, I, +I and I are ASCII text. + +ERR_lib_error_string(), ERR_func_error_string() and +ERR_reason_error_string() return the library name, function +name and reason string respectively. + +The OpenSSL error strings should be loaded by calling +L or, for SSL +applications, L +first. +If there is no text string registered for the given error code, +the error string will contain the numeric code. + +L can be used to print +all error codes currently in the queue. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ERR_error_string() returns a pointer to a static buffer containing the +string if I B<== NULL>, I otherwise. + +ERR_lib_error_string(), ERR_func_error_string() and +ERR_reason_error_string() return the strings, and B if +none is registered for the error code. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_error_string() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +ERR_error_string_n() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.6. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_get_error.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_get_error.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..34443045f --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_get_error.pod @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_get_error, ERR_peek_error, ERR_peek_last_error, +ERR_get_error_line, ERR_peek_error_line, ERR_peek_last_error_line, +ERR_get_error_line_data, ERR_peek_error_line_data, +ERR_peek_last_error_line_data - obtain error code and data + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned long ERR_get_error(void); + unsigned long ERR_peek_error(void); + unsigned long ERR_peek_last_error(void); + + unsigned long ERR_get_error_line(const char **file, int *line); + unsigned long ERR_peek_error_line(const char **file, int *line); + unsigned long ERR_peek_last_error_line(const char **file, int *line); + + unsigned long ERR_get_error_line_data(const char **file, int *line, + const char **data, int *flags); + unsigned long ERR_peek_error_line_data(const char **file, int *line, + const char **data, int *flags); + unsigned long ERR_peek_last_error_line_data(const char **file, int *line, + const char **data, int *flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_get_error() returns the earliest error code from the thread's error +queue and removes the entry. This function can be called repeatedly +until there are no more error codes to return. + +ERR_peek_error() returns the earliest error code from the thread's +error queue without modifying it. + +ERR_peek_last_error() returns the latest error code from the thread's +error queue without modifying it. + +See L for obtaining information about +location and reason of the error, and +L for human-readable error +messages. + +ERR_get_error_line(), ERR_peek_error_line() and +ERR_peek_last_error_line() are the same as the above, but they +additionally store the file name and line number where +the error occurred in *B and *B, unless these are B. + +ERR_get_error_line_data(), ERR_peek_error_line_data() and +ERR_get_last_error_line_data() store additional data and flags +associated with the error code in *B +and *B, unless these are B. *B contains a string +if *B&B. If it has been allocated by OPENSSL_malloc(), +*B&B is true. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +The error code, or 0 if there is no error in the queue. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_get_error(), ERR_peek_error(), ERR_get_error_line() and +ERR_peek_error_line() are available in all versions of SSLeay and +OpenSSL. ERR_get_error_line_data() and ERR_peek_error_line_data() +were added in SSLeay 0.9.0. +ERR_peek_last_error(), ERR_peek_last_error_line() and +ERR_peek_last_error_line_data() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_crypto_strings.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_crypto_strings.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9bdec75a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_crypto_strings.pod @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_load_crypto_strings, SSL_load_error_strings, ERR_free_strings - +load and free error strings + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void ERR_load_crypto_strings(void); + void ERR_free_strings(void); + + #include + + void SSL_load_error_strings(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_load_crypto_strings() registers the error strings for all +B functions. SSL_load_error_strings() does the same, +but also registers the B error strings. + +One of these functions should be called before generating +textual error messages. However, this is not required when memory +usage is an issue. + +ERR_free_strings() frees all previously loaded error strings. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ERR_load_crypto_strings(), SSL_load_error_strings() and +ERR_free_strings() return no values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_load_error_strings(), SSL_load_error_strings() and +ERR_free_strings() are available in all versions of SSLeay and +OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_strings.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_strings.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..5acdd0edb --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_load_strings.pod @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_load_strings, ERR_PACK, ERR_get_next_error_library - load +arbitrary error strings + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void ERR_load_strings(int lib, ERR_STRING_DATA str[]); + + int ERR_get_next_error_library(void); + + unsigned long ERR_PACK(int lib, int func, int reason); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_load_strings() registers error strings for library number B. + +B is an array of error string data: + + typedef struct ERR_string_data_st + { + unsigned long error; + char *string; + } ERR_STRING_DATA; + +The error code is generated from the library number and a function and +reason code: B = ERR_PACK(B, B, B). +ERR_PACK() is a macro. + +The last entry in the array is {0,0}. + +ERR_get_next_error_library() can be used to assign library numbers +to user libraries at runtime. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +ERR_load_strings() returns no value. ERR_PACK() return the error code. +ERR_get_next_error_library() returns a new library number. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_load_error_strings() and ERR_PACK() are available in all versions +of SSLeay and OpenSSL. ERR_get_next_error_library() was added in +SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_print_errors.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_print_errors.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b100a5fa2 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_print_errors.pod @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_print_errors, ERR_print_errors_fp - print error messages + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void ERR_print_errors(BIO *bp); + void ERR_print_errors_fp(FILE *fp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_print_errors() is a convenience function that prints the error +strings for all errors that OpenSSL has recorded to B, thus +emptying the error queue. + +ERR_print_errors_fp() is the same, except that the output goes to a +B. + + +The error strings will have the following format: + + [pid]:error:[error code]:[library name]:[function name]:[reason string]:[file name]:[line]:[optional text message] + +I is an 8 digit hexadecimal number. I, +I and I are ASCII text, as is I if one was set for the respective error code. + +If there is no text string registered for the given error code, +the error string will contain the numeric code. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ERR_print_errors() and ERR_print_errors_fp() return no values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_print_errors() and ERR_print_errors_fp() +are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_put_error.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_put_error.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..acd241fbe --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_put_error.pod @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_put_error, ERR_add_error_data - record an error + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void ERR_put_error(int lib, int func, int reason, const char *file, + int line); + + void ERR_add_error_data(int num, ...); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_put_error() adds an error code to the thread's error queue. It +signals that the error of reason code B occurred in function +B of library B, in line number B of B. +This function is usually called by a macro. + +ERR_add_error_data() associates the concatenation of its B string +arguments with the error code added last. + +L can be used to register +error strings so that the application can a generate human-readable +error messages for the error code. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ERR_put_error() and ERR_add_error_data() return +no values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_put_error() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +ERR_add_error_data() was added in SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_remove_state.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_remove_state.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..72925fb9f --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_remove_state.pod @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_remove_state - free a thread's error queue + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void ERR_remove_state(unsigned long pid); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_remove_state() frees the error queue associated with thread B. +If B == 0, the current thread will have its error queue removed. + +Since error queue data structures are allocated automatically for new +threads, they must be freed when threads are terminated in order to +avoid memory leaks. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +ERR_remove_state() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_remove_state() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_set_mark.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_set_mark.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..d3ca4f2e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ERR_set_mark.pod @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ERR_set_mark, ERR_pop_to_mark - set marks and pop errors until mark + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int ERR_set_mark(void); + + int ERR_pop_to_mark(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +ERR_set_mark() sets a mark on the current topmost error record if there +is one. + +ERR_pop_to_mark() will pop the top of the error stack until a mark is found. +The mark is then removed. If there is no mark, the whole stack is removed. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ERR_set_mark() returns 0 if the error stack is empty, otherwise 1. + +ERR_pop_to_mark() returns 0 if there was no mark in the error stack, which +implies that the stack became empty, otherwise 1. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +ERR_set_mark() and ERR_pop_to_mark() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_BytesToKey.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_BytesToKey.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..d375c46e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_BytesToKey.pod @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_BytesToKey - password based encryption routine + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int EVP_BytesToKey(const EVP_CIPHER *type,const EVP_MD *md, + const unsigned char *salt, + const unsigned char *data, int datal, int count, + unsigned char *key,unsigned char *iv); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +EVP_BytesToKey() derives a key and IV from various parameters. B is +the cipher to derive the key and IV for. B is the message digest to use. +The B paramter is used as a salt in the derivation: it should point to +an 8 byte buffer or NULL if no salt is used. B is a buffer containing +B bytes which is used to derive the keying data. B is the +iteration count to use. The derived key and IV will be written to B +and B respectively. + +=head1 NOTES + +A typical application of this function is to derive keying material for an +encryption algorithm from a password in the B parameter. + +Increasing the B parameter slows down the algorithm which makes it +harder for an attacker to peform a brute force attack using a large number +of candidate passwords. + +If the total key and IV length is less than the digest length and +B is used then the derivation algorithm is compatible with PKCS#5 v1.5 +otherwise a non standard extension is used to derive the extra data. + +Newer applications should use more standard algorithms such as PKCS#5 +v2.0 for key derivation. + +=head1 KEY DERIVATION ALGORITHM + +The key and IV is derived by concatenating D_1, D_2, etc until +enough data is available for the key and IV. D_i is defined as: + + D_i = HASH^count(D_(i-1) || data || salt) + +where || denotes concatentaion, D_0 is empty, HASH is the digest +algorithm in use, HASH^1(data) is simply HASH(data), HASH^2(data) +is HASH(HASH(data)) and so on. + +The initial bytes are used for the key and the subsequent bytes for +the IV. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_BytesToKey() returns the size of the derived key in bytes. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_DigestInit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_DigestInit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..130cd7f60 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_DigestInit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,256 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_MD_CTX_init, EVP_MD_CTX_create, EVP_DigestInit_ex, EVP_DigestUpdate, +EVP_DigestFinal_ex, EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup, EVP_MD_CTX_destroy, EVP_MAX_MD_SIZE, +EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex, EVP_MD_CTX_copy, EVP_MD_type, EVP_MD_pkey_type, EVP_MD_size, +EVP_MD_block_size, EVP_MD_CTX_md, EVP_MD_CTX_size, EVP_MD_CTX_block_size, EVP_MD_CTX_type, +EVP_md_null, EVP_md2, EVP_md5, EVP_sha, EVP_sha1, EVP_dss, EVP_dss1, EVP_mdc2, +EVP_ripemd160, EVP_get_digestbyname, EVP_get_digestbynid, EVP_get_digestbyobj - +EVP digest routines + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void EVP_MD_CTX_init(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx); + EVP_MD_CTX *EVP_MD_CTX_create(void); + + int EVP_DigestInit_ex(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const EVP_MD *type, ENGINE *impl); + int EVP_DigestUpdate(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const void *d, size_t cnt); + int EVP_DigestFinal_ex(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *md, + unsigned int *s); + + int EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx); + void EVP_MD_CTX_destroy(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx); + + int EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex(EVP_MD_CTX *out,const EVP_MD_CTX *in); + + int EVP_DigestInit(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const EVP_MD *type); + int EVP_DigestFinal(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *md, + unsigned int *s); + + int EVP_MD_CTX_copy(EVP_MD_CTX *out,EVP_MD_CTX *in); + + #define EVP_MAX_MD_SIZE (16+20) /* The SSLv3 md5+sha1 type */ + + + #define EVP_MD_type(e) ((e)->type) + #define EVP_MD_pkey_type(e) ((e)->pkey_type) + #define EVP_MD_size(e) ((e)->md_size) + #define EVP_MD_block_size(e) ((e)->block_size) + + #define EVP_MD_CTX_md(e) (e)->digest) + #define EVP_MD_CTX_size(e) EVP_MD_size((e)->digest) + #define EVP_MD_CTX_block_size(e) EVP_MD_block_size((e)->digest) + #define EVP_MD_CTX_type(e) EVP_MD_type((e)->digest) + + const EVP_MD *EVP_md_null(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_md2(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_md5(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_sha(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_sha1(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_dss(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_dss1(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_mdc2(void); + const EVP_MD *EVP_ripemd160(void); + + const EVP_MD *EVP_get_digestbyname(const char *name); + #define EVP_get_digestbynid(a) EVP_get_digestbyname(OBJ_nid2sn(a)) + #define EVP_get_digestbyobj(a) EVP_get_digestbynid(OBJ_obj2nid(a)) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP digest routines are a high level interface to message digests. + +EVP_MD_CTX_init() initializes digest contet B. + +EVP_MD_CTX_create() allocates, initializes and returns a digest contet. + +EVP_DigestInit_ex() sets up digest context B to use a digest +B from ENGINE B. B must be initialized before calling this +function. B will typically be supplied by a functionsuch as EVP_sha1(). +If B is NULL then the default implementation of digest B is used. + +EVP_DigestUpdate() hashes B bytes of data at B into the +digest context B. This function can be called several times on the +same B to hash additional data. + +EVP_DigestFinal_ex() retrieves the digest value from B and places +it in B. If the B parameter is not NULL then the number of +bytes of data written (i.e. the length of the digest) will be written +to the integer at B, at most B bytes will be written. +After calling EVP_DigestFinal_ex() no additional calls to EVP_DigestUpdate() +can be made, but EVP_DigestInit_ex() can be called to initialize a new +digest operation. + +EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup() cleans up digest context B, it should be called +after a digest context is no longer needed. + +EVP_MD_CTX_destroy() cleans up digest context B and frees up the +space allocated to it, it should be called only on a context created +using EVP_MD_CTX_create(). + +EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex() can be used to copy the message digest state from +B to B. This is useful if large amounts of data are to be +hashed which only differ in the last few bytes. B must be initialized +before calling this function. + +EVP_DigestInit() behaves in the same way as EVP_DigestInit_ex() except +the passed context B does not have to be initialized, and it always +uses the default digest implementation. + +EVP_DigestFinal() is similar to EVP_DigestFinal_ex() except the digest +contet B is automatically cleaned up. + +EVP_MD_CTX_copy() is similar to EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex() except the destination +B does not have to be initialized. + +EVP_MD_size() and EVP_MD_CTX_size() return the size of the message digest +when passed an B or an B structure, i.e. the size of the +hash. + +EVP_MD_block_size() and EVP_MD_CTX_block_size() return the block size of the +message digest when passed an B or an B structure. + +EVP_MD_type() and EVP_MD_CTX_type() return the NID of the OBJECT IDENTIFIER +representing the given message digest when passed an B structure. +For example EVP_MD_type(EVP_sha1()) returns B. This function is +normally used when setting ASN1 OIDs. + +EVP_MD_CTX_md() returns the B structure corresponding to the passed +B. + +EVP_MD_pkey_type() returns the NID of the public key signing algorithm associated +with this digest. For example EVP_sha1() is associated with RSA so this will +return B. This "link" between digests and signature +algorithms may not be retained in future versions of OpenSSL. + +EVP_md2(), EVP_md5(), EVP_sha(), EVP_sha1(), EVP_mdc2() and EVP_ripemd160() +return B structures for the MD2, MD5, SHA, SHA1, MDC2 and RIPEMD160 digest +algorithms respectively. The associated signature algorithm is RSA in each case. + +EVP_dss() and EVP_dss1() return B structures for SHA and SHA1 digest +algorithms but using DSS (DSA) for the signature algorithm. + +EVP_md_null() is a "null" message digest that does nothing: i.e. the hash it +returns is of zero length. + +EVP_get_digestbyname(), EVP_get_digestbynid() and EVP_get_digestbyobj() +return an B structure when passed a digest name, a digest NID or +an ASN1_OBJECT structure respectively. The digest table must be initialized +using, for example, OpenSSL_add_all_digests() for these functions to work. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_DigestInit_ex(), EVP_DigestUpdate() and EVP_DigestFinal_ex() return 1 for +success and 0 for failure. + +EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex() returns 1 if successful or 0 for failure. + +EVP_MD_type(), EVP_MD_pkey_type() and EVP_MD_type() return the NID of the +corresponding OBJECT IDENTIFIER or NID_undef if none exists. + +EVP_MD_size(), EVP_MD_block_size(), EVP_MD_CTX_size(e), EVP_MD_size(), +EVP_MD_CTX_block_size() and EVP_MD_block_size() return the digest or block +size in bytes. + +EVP_md_null(), EVP_md2(), EVP_md5(), EVP_sha(), EVP_sha1(), EVP_dss(), +EVP_dss1(), EVP_mdc2() and EVP_ripemd160() return pointers to the +corresponding EVP_MD structures. + +EVP_get_digestbyname(), EVP_get_digestbynid() and EVP_get_digestbyobj() +return either an B structure or NULL if an error occurs. + +=head1 NOTES + +The B interface to message digests should almost always be used in +preference to the low level interfaces. This is because the code then becomes +transparent to the digest used and much more flexible. + +SHA1 is the digest of choice for new applications. The other digest algorithms +are still in common use. + +For most applications the B parameter to EVP_DigestInit_ex() will be +set to NULL to use the default digest implementation. + +The functions EVP_DigestInit(), EVP_DigestFinal() and EVP_MD_CTX_copy() are +obsolete but are retained to maintain compatibility with existing code. New +applications should use EVP_DigestInit_ex(), EVP_DigestFinal_ex() and +EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex() because they can efficiently reuse a digest context +instead of initializing and cleaning it up on each call and allow non default +implementations of digests to be specified. + +In OpenSSL 0.9.7 and later if digest contexts are not cleaned up after use +memory leaks will occur. + +=head1 EXAMPLE + +This example digests the data "Test Message\n" and "Hello World\n", using the +digest name passed on the command line. + + #include + #include + + main(int argc, char *argv[]) + { + EVP_MD_CTX mdctx; + const EVP_MD *md; + char mess1[] = "Test Message\n"; + char mess2[] = "Hello World\n"; + unsigned char md_value[EVP_MAX_MD_SIZE]; + int md_len, i; + + OpenSSL_add_all_digests(); + + if(!argv[1]) { + printf("Usage: mdtest digestname\n"); + exit(1); + } + + md = EVP_get_digestbyname(argv[1]); + + if(!md) { + printf("Unknown message digest %s\n", argv[1]); + exit(1); + } + + EVP_MD_CTX_init(&mdctx); + EVP_DigestInit_ex(&mdctx, md, NULL); + EVP_DigestUpdate(&mdctx, mess1, strlen(mess1)); + EVP_DigestUpdate(&mdctx, mess2, strlen(mess2)); + EVP_DigestFinal_ex(&mdctx, md_value, &md_len); + EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup(&mdctx); + + printf("Digest is: "); + for(i = 0; i < md_len; i++) printf("%02x", md_value[i]); + printf("\n"); + } + +=head1 BUGS + +The link between digests and signing algorithms results in a situation where +EVP_sha1() must be used with RSA and EVP_dss1() must be used with DSS +even though they are identical digests. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +EVP_DigestInit(), EVP_DigestUpdate() and EVP_DigestFinal() are +available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +EVP_MD_CTX_init(), EVP_MD_CTX_create(), EVP_MD_CTX_copy_ex(), +EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup(), EVP_MD_CTX_destroy(), EVP_DigestInit_ex() +and EVP_DigestFinal_ex() were added in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +EVP_md_null(), EVP_md2(), EVP_md5(), EVP_sha(), EVP_sha1(), +EVP_dss(), EVP_dss1(), EVP_mdc2() and EVP_ripemd160() were +changed to return truely const EVP_MD * in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_EncryptInit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_EncryptInit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..8271d3dfc --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_EncryptInit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,511 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_init, EVP_EncryptInit_ex, EVP_EncryptUpdate, +EVP_EncryptFinal_ex, EVP_DecryptInit_ex, EVP_DecryptUpdate, +EVP_DecryptFinal_ex, EVP_CipherInit_ex, EVP_CipherUpdate, +EVP_CipherFinal_ex, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_key_length, +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup, EVP_EncryptInit, +EVP_EncryptFinal, EVP_DecryptInit, EVP_DecryptFinal, +EVP_CipherInit, EVP_CipherFinal, EVP_get_cipherbyname, +EVP_get_cipherbynid, EVP_get_cipherbyobj, EVP_CIPHER_nid, +EVP_CIPHER_block_size, EVP_CIPHER_key_length, EVP_CIPHER_iv_length, +EVP_CIPHER_flags, EVP_CIPHER_mode, EVP_CIPHER_type, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cipher, +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_nid, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_block_size, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_key_length, +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_iv_length, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_get_app_data, +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_app_data, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_type, EVP_CIPHER_CTX_flags, +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_mode, EVP_CIPHER_param_to_asn1, EVP_CIPHER_asn1_to_param, +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_padding - EVP cipher routines + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void EVP_CIPHER_CTX_init(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *a); + + int EVP_EncryptInit_ex(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + ENGINE *impl, unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv); + int EVP_EncryptUpdate(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl, unsigned char *in, int inl); + int EVP_EncryptFinal_ex(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl); + + int EVP_DecryptInit_ex(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + ENGINE *impl, unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv); + int EVP_DecryptUpdate(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl, unsigned char *in, int inl); + int EVP_DecryptFinal_ex(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *outm, + int *outl); + + int EVP_CipherInit_ex(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + ENGINE *impl, unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv, int enc); + int EVP_CipherUpdate(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl, unsigned char *in, int inl); + int EVP_CipherFinal_ex(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *outm, + int *outl); + + int EVP_EncryptInit(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv); + int EVP_EncryptFinal(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl); + + int EVP_DecryptInit(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv); + int EVP_DecryptFinal(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *outm, + int *outl); + + int EVP_CipherInit(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + unsigned char *key, unsigned char *iv, int enc); + int EVP_CipherFinal(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *outm, + int *outl); + + int EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_padding(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *x, int padding); + int EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_key_length(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *x, int keylen); + int EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, int type, int arg, void *ptr); + int EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *a); + + const EVP_CIPHER *EVP_get_cipherbyname(const char *name); + #define EVP_get_cipherbynid(a) EVP_get_cipherbyname(OBJ_nid2sn(a)) + #define EVP_get_cipherbyobj(a) EVP_get_cipherbynid(OBJ_obj2nid(a)) + + #define EVP_CIPHER_nid(e) ((e)->nid) + #define EVP_CIPHER_block_size(e) ((e)->block_size) + #define EVP_CIPHER_key_length(e) ((e)->key_len) + #define EVP_CIPHER_iv_length(e) ((e)->iv_len) + #define EVP_CIPHER_flags(e) ((e)->flags) + #define EVP_CIPHER_mode(e) ((e)->flags) & EVP_CIPH_MODE) + int EVP_CIPHER_type(const EVP_CIPHER *ctx); + + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cipher(e) ((e)->cipher) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_nid(e) ((e)->cipher->nid) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_block_size(e) ((e)->cipher->block_size) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_key_length(e) ((e)->key_len) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_iv_length(e) ((e)->cipher->iv_len) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_get_app_data(e) ((e)->app_data) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_app_data(e,d) ((e)->app_data=(char *)(d)) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_type(c) EVP_CIPHER_type(EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cipher(c)) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_flags(e) ((e)->cipher->flags) + #define EVP_CIPHER_CTX_mode(e) ((e)->cipher->flags & EVP_CIPH_MODE) + + int EVP_CIPHER_param_to_asn1(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *c, ASN1_TYPE *type); + int EVP_CIPHER_asn1_to_param(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *c, ASN1_TYPE *type); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP cipher routines are a high level interface to certain +symmetric ciphers. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_init() initializes cipher contex B. + +EVP_EncryptInit_ex() sets up cipher context B for encryption +with cipher B from ENGINE B. B must be initialized +before calling this function. B is normally supplied +by a function such as EVP_des_cbc(). If B is NULL then the +default implementation is used. B is the symmetric key to use +and B is the IV to use (if necessary), the actual number of bytes +used for the key and IV depends on the cipher. It is possible to set +all parameters to NULL except B in an initial call and supply +the remaining parameters in subsequent calls, all of which have B +set to NULL. This is done when the default cipher parameters are not +appropriate. + +EVP_EncryptUpdate() encrypts B bytes from the buffer B and +writes the encrypted version to B. This function can be called +multiple times to encrypt successive blocks of data. The amount +of data written depends on the block alignment of the encrypted data: +as a result the amount of data written may be anything from zero bytes +to (inl + cipher_block_size - 1) so B should contain sufficient +room. The actual number of bytes written is placed in B. + +If padding is enabled (the default) then EVP_EncryptFinal_ex() encrypts +the "final" data, that is any data that remains in a partial block. +It uses L (aka PKCS padding). The encrypted +final data is written to B which should have sufficient space for +one cipher block. The number of bytes written is placed in B. After +this function is called the encryption operation is finished and no further +calls to EVP_EncryptUpdate() should be made. + +If padding is disabled then EVP_EncryptFinal_ex() will not encrypt any more +data and it will return an error if any data remains in a partial block: +that is if the total data length is not a multiple of the block size. + +EVP_DecryptInit_ex(), EVP_DecryptUpdate() and EVP_DecryptFinal_ex() are the +corresponding decryption operations. EVP_DecryptFinal() will return an +error code if padding is enabled and the final block is not correctly +formatted. The parameters and restrictions are identical to the encryption +operations except that if padding is enabled the decrypted data buffer B +passed to EVP_DecryptUpdate() should have sufficient room for +(B + cipher_block_size) bytes unless the cipher block size is 1 in +which case B bytes is sufficient. + +EVP_CipherInit_ex(), EVP_CipherUpdate() and EVP_CipherFinal_ex() are +functions that can be used for decryption or encryption. The operation +performed depends on the value of the B parameter. It should be set +to 1 for encryption, 0 for decryption and -1 to leave the value unchanged +(the actual value of 'enc' being supplied in a previous call). + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup() clears all information from a cipher context +and free up any allocated memory associate with it. It should be called +after all operations using a cipher are complete so sensitive information +does not remain in memory. + +EVP_EncryptInit(), EVP_DecryptInit() and EVP_CipherInit() behave in a +similar way to EVP_EncryptInit_ex(), EVP_DecryptInit_ex and +EVP_CipherInit_ex() except the B paramter does not need to be +initialized and they always use the default cipher implementation. + +EVP_EncryptFinal(), EVP_DecryptFinal() and EVP_CipherFinal() behave in a +similar way to EVP_EncryptFinal_ex(), EVP_DecryptFinal_ex() and +EVP_CipherFinal_ex() except B is automatically cleaned up +after the call. + +EVP_get_cipherbyname(), EVP_get_cipherbynid() and EVP_get_cipherbyobj() +return an EVP_CIPHER structure when passed a cipher name, a NID or an +ASN1_OBJECT structure. + +EVP_CIPHER_nid() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_nid() return the NID of a cipher when +passed an B or B structure. The actual NID +value is an internal value which may not have a corresponding OBJECT +IDENTIFIER. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_padding() enables or disables padding. By default +encryption operations are padded using standard block padding and the +padding is checked and removed when decrypting. If the B parameter +is zero then no padding is performed, the total amount of data encrypted +or decrypted must then be a multiple of the block size or an error will +occur. + +EVP_CIPHER_key_length() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_key_length() return the key +length of a cipher when passed an B or B +structure. The constant B is the maximum key length +for all ciphers. Note: although EVP_CIPHER_key_length() is fixed for a +given cipher, the value of EVP_CIPHER_CTX_key_length() may be different +for variable key length ciphers. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_key_length() sets the key length of the cipher ctx. +If the cipher is a fixed length cipher then attempting to set the key +length to any value other than the fixed value is an error. + +EVP_CIPHER_iv_length() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_iv_length() return the IV +length of a cipher when passed an B or B. +It will return zero if the cipher does not use an IV. The constant +B is the maximum IV length for all ciphers. + +EVP_CIPHER_block_size() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_block_size() return the block +size of a cipher when passed an B or B +structure. The constant B is also the maximum block +length for all ciphers. + +EVP_CIPHER_type() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_type() return the type of the passed +cipher or context. This "type" is the actual NID of the cipher OBJECT +IDENTIFIER as such it ignores the cipher parameters and 40 bit RC2 and +128 bit RC2 have the same NID. If the cipher does not have an object +identifier or does not have ASN1 support this function will return +B. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cipher() returns the B structure when passed +an B structure. + +EVP_CIPHER_mode() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_mode() return the block cipher mode: +EVP_CIPH_ECB_MODE, EVP_CIPH_CBC_MODE, EVP_CIPH_CFB_MODE or +EVP_CIPH_OFB_MODE. If the cipher is a stream cipher then +EVP_CIPH_STREAM_CIPHER is returned. + +EVP_CIPHER_param_to_asn1() sets the AlgorithmIdentifier "parameter" based +on the passed cipher. This will typically include any parameters and an +IV. The cipher IV (if any) must be set when this call is made. This call +should be made before the cipher is actually "used" (before any +EVP_EncryptUpdate(), EVP_DecryptUpdate() calls for example). This function +may fail if the cipher does not have any ASN1 support. + +EVP_CIPHER_asn1_to_param() sets the cipher parameters based on an ASN1 +AlgorithmIdentifier "parameter". The precise effect depends on the cipher +In the case of RC2, for example, it will set the IV and effective key length. +This function should be called after the base cipher type is set but before +the key is set. For example EVP_CipherInit() will be called with the IV and +key set to NULL, EVP_CIPHER_asn1_to_param() will be called and finally +EVP_CipherInit() again with all parameters except the key set to NULL. It is +possible for this function to fail if the cipher does not have any ASN1 support +or the parameters cannot be set (for example the RC2 effective key length +is not supported. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl() allows various cipher specific parameters to be determined +and set. Currently only the RC2 effective key length and the number of rounds of +RC5 can be set. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_EncryptInit_ex(), EVP_EncryptUpdate() and EVP_EncryptFinal_ex() +return 1 for success and 0 for failure. + +EVP_DecryptInit_ex() and EVP_DecryptUpdate() return 1 for success and 0 for failure. +EVP_DecryptFinal_ex() returns 0 if the decrypt failed or 1 for success. + +EVP_CipherInit_ex() and EVP_CipherUpdate() return 1 for success and 0 for failure. +EVP_CipherFinal_ex() returns 0 for a decryption failure or 1 for success. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup() returns 1 for success and 0 for failure. + +EVP_get_cipherbyname(), EVP_get_cipherbynid() and EVP_get_cipherbyobj() +return an B structure or NULL on error. + +EVP_CIPHER_nid() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_nid() return a NID. + +EVP_CIPHER_block_size() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_block_size() return the block +size. + +EVP_CIPHER_key_length() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_key_length() return the key +length. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_padding() always returns 1. + +EVP_CIPHER_iv_length() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_iv_length() return the IV +length or zero if the cipher does not use an IV. + +EVP_CIPHER_type() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_type() return the NID of the cipher's +OBJECT IDENTIFIER or NID_undef if it has no defined OBJECT IDENTIFIER. + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cipher() returns an B structure. + +EVP_CIPHER_param_to_asn1() and EVP_CIPHER_asn1_to_param() return 1 for +success or zero for failure. + +=head1 CIPHER LISTING + +All algorithms have a fixed key length unless otherwise stated. + +=over 4 + +=item EVP_enc_null() + +Null cipher: does nothing. + +=item EVP_des_cbc(void), EVP_des_ecb(void), EVP_des_cfb(void), EVP_des_ofb(void) + +DES in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. + +=item EVP_des_ede_cbc(void), EVP_des_ede(), EVP_des_ede_ofb(void), EVP_des_ede_cfb(void) + +Two key triple DES in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. + +=item EVP_des_ede3_cbc(void), EVP_des_ede3(), EVP_des_ede3_ofb(void), EVP_des_ede3_cfb(void) + +Three key triple DES in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. + +=item EVP_desx_cbc(void) + +DESX algorithm in CBC mode. + +=item EVP_rc4(void) + +RC4 stream cipher. This is a variable key length cipher with default key length 128 bits. + +=item EVP_rc4_40(void) + +RC4 stream cipher with 40 bit key length. This is obsolete and new code should use EVP_rc4() +and the EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_key_length() function. + +=item EVP_idea_cbc() EVP_idea_ecb(void), EVP_idea_cfb(void), EVP_idea_ofb(void), EVP_idea_cbc(void) + +IDEA encryption algorithm in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. + +=item EVP_rc2_cbc(void), EVP_rc2_ecb(void), EVP_rc2_cfb(void), EVP_rc2_ofb(void) + +RC2 encryption algorithm in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. This is a variable key +length cipher with an additional parameter called "effective key bits" or "effective key length". +By default both are set to 128 bits. + +=item EVP_rc2_40_cbc(void), EVP_rc2_64_cbc(void) + +RC2 algorithm in CBC mode with a default key length and effective key length of 40 and 64 bits. +These are obsolete and new code should use EVP_rc2_cbc(), EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_key_length() and +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl() to set the key length and effective key length. + +=item EVP_bf_cbc(void), EVP_bf_ecb(void), EVP_bf_cfb(void), EVP_bf_ofb(void); + +Blowfish encryption algorithm in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. This is a variable key +length cipher. + +=item EVP_cast5_cbc(void), EVP_cast5_ecb(void), EVP_cast5_cfb(void), EVP_cast5_ofb(void) + +CAST encryption algorithm in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. This is a variable key +length cipher. + +=item EVP_rc5_32_12_16_cbc(void), EVP_rc5_32_12_16_ecb(void), EVP_rc5_32_12_16_cfb(void), EVP_rc5_32_12_16_ofb(void) + +RC5 encryption algorithm in CBC, ECB, CFB and OFB modes respectively. This is a variable key length +cipher with an additional "number of rounds" parameter. By default the key length is set to 128 +bits and 12 rounds. + +=back + +=head1 NOTES + +Where possible the B interface to symmetric ciphers should be used in +preference to the low level interfaces. This is because the code then becomes +transparent to the cipher used and much more flexible. + +PKCS padding works by adding B padding bytes of value B to make the total +length of the encrypted data a multiple of the block size. Padding is always +added so if the data is already a multiple of the block size B will equal +the block size. For example if the block size is 8 and 11 bytes are to be +encrypted then 5 padding bytes of value 5 will be added. + +When decrypting the final block is checked to see if it has the correct form. + +Although the decryption operation can produce an error if padding is enabled, +it is not a strong test that the input data or key is correct. A random block +has better than 1 in 256 chance of being of the correct format and problems with +the input data earlier on will not produce a final decrypt error. + +If padding is disabled then the decryption operation will always succeed if +the total amount of data decrypted is a multiple of the block size. + +The functions EVP_EncryptInit(), EVP_EncryptFinal(), EVP_DecryptInit(), +EVP_CipherInit() and EVP_CipherFinal() are obsolete but are retained for +compatibility with existing code. New code should use EVP_EncryptInit_ex(), +EVP_EncryptFinal_ex(), EVP_DecryptInit_ex(), EVP_DecryptFinal_ex(), +EVP_CipherInit_ex() and EVP_CipherFinal_ex() because they can reuse an +existing context without allocating and freeing it up on each call. + +=head1 BUGS + +For RC5 the number of rounds can currently only be set to 8, 12 or 16. This is +a limitation of the current RC5 code rather than the EVP interface. + +EVP_MAX_KEY_LENGTH and EVP_MAX_IV_LENGTH only refer to the internal ciphers with +default key lengths. If custom ciphers exceed these values the results are +unpredictable. This is because it has become standard practice to define a +generic key as a fixed unsigned char array containing EVP_MAX_KEY_LENGTH bytes. + +The ASN1 code is incomplete (and sometimes inaccurate) it has only been tested +for certain common S/MIME ciphers (RC2, DES, triple DES) in CBC mode. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Get the number of rounds used in RC5: + + int nrounds; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl(ctx, EVP_CTRL_GET_RC5_ROUNDS, 0, &nrounds); + +Get the RC2 effective key length: + + int key_bits; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl(ctx, EVP_CTRL_GET_RC2_KEY_BITS, 0, &key_bits); + +Set the number of rounds used in RC5: + + int nrounds; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl(ctx, EVP_CTRL_SET_RC5_ROUNDS, nrounds, NULL); + +Set the effective key length used in RC2: + + int key_bits; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_ctrl(ctx, EVP_CTRL_SET_RC2_KEY_BITS, key_bits, NULL); + +Encrypt a string using blowfish: + + int do_crypt(char *outfile) + { + unsigned char outbuf[1024]; + int outlen, tmplen; + /* Bogus key and IV: we'd normally set these from + * another source. + */ + unsigned char key[] = {0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10,11,12,13,14,15}; + unsigned char iv[] = {1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8}; + char intext[] = "Some Crypto Text"; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX ctx; + FILE *out; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_init(&ctx); + EVP_EncryptInit_ex(&ctx, EVP_bf_cbc(), NULL, key, iv); + + if(!EVP_EncryptUpdate(&ctx, outbuf, &outlen, intext, strlen(intext))) + { + /* Error */ + return 0; + } + /* Buffer passed to EVP_EncryptFinal() must be after data just + * encrypted to avoid overwriting it. + */ + if(!EVP_EncryptFinal_ex(&ctx, outbuf + outlen, &tmplen)) + { + /* Error */ + return 0; + } + outlen += tmplen; + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup(&ctx); + /* Need binary mode for fopen because encrypted data is + * binary data. Also cannot use strlen() on it because + * it wont be null terminated and may contain embedded + * nulls. + */ + out = fopen(outfile, "wb"); + fwrite(outbuf, 1, outlen, out); + fclose(out); + return 1; + } + +The ciphertext from the above example can be decrypted using the B +utility with the command line: + + S + +General encryption, decryption function example using FILE I/O and RC2 with an +80 bit key: + + int do_crypt(FILE *in, FILE *out, int do_encrypt) + { + /* Allow enough space in output buffer for additional block */ + inbuf[1024], outbuf[1024 + EVP_MAX_BLOCK_LENGTH]; + int inlen, outlen; + /* Bogus key and IV: we'd normally set these from + * another source. + */ + unsigned char key[] = "0123456789"; + unsigned char iv[] = "12345678"; + /* Don't set key or IV because we will modify the parameters */ + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_init(&ctx); + EVP_CipherInit_ex(&ctx, EVP_rc2(), NULL, NULL, NULL, do_encrypt); + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_key_length(&ctx, 10); + /* We finished modifying parameters so now we can set key and IV */ + EVP_CipherInit_ex(&ctx, NULL, NULL, key, iv, do_encrypt); + + for(;;) + { + inlen = fread(inbuf, 1, 1024, in); + if(inlen <= 0) break; + if(!EVP_CipherUpdate(&ctx, outbuf, &outlen, inbuf, inlen)) + { + /* Error */ + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup(&ctx); + return 0; + } + fwrite(outbuf, 1, outlen, out); + } + if(!EVP_CipherFinal_ex(&ctx, outbuf, &outlen)) + { + /* Error */ + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup(&ctx); + return 0; + } + fwrite(outbuf, 1, outlen, out); + + EVP_CIPHER_CTX_cleanup(&ctx); + return 1; + } + + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +EVP_CIPHER_CTX_init(), EVP_EncryptInit_ex(), EVP_EncryptFinal_ex(), +EVP_DecryptInit_ex(), EVP_DecryptFinal_ex(), EVP_CipherInit_ex(), +EVP_CipherFinal_ex() and EVP_CIPHER_CTX_set_padding() appeared in +OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_OpenInit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_OpenInit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2e710da94 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_OpenInit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_OpenInit, EVP_OpenUpdate, EVP_OpenFinal - EVP envelope decryption + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int EVP_OpenInit(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx,EVP_CIPHER *type,unsigned char *ek, + int ekl,unsigned char *iv,EVP_PKEY *priv); + int EVP_OpenUpdate(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl, unsigned char *in, int inl); + int EVP_OpenFinal(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP envelope routines are a high level interface to envelope +decryption. They decrypt a public key encrypted symmetric key and +then decrypt data using it. + +EVP_OpenInit() initializes a cipher context B for decryption +with cipher B. It decrypts the encrypted symmetric key of length +B bytes passed in the B parameter using the private key B. +The IV is supplied in the B parameter. + +EVP_OpenUpdate() and EVP_OpenFinal() have exactly the same properties +as the EVP_DecryptUpdate() and EVP_DecryptFinal() routines, as +documented on the L manual +page. + +=head1 NOTES + +It is possible to call EVP_OpenInit() twice in the same way as +EVP_DecryptInit(). The first call should have B set to NULL +and (after setting any cipher parameters) it should be called again +with B set to NULL. + +If the cipher passed in the B parameter is a variable length +cipher then the key length will be set to the value of the recovered +key length. If the cipher is a fixed length cipher then the recovered +key length must match the fixed cipher length. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_OpenInit() returns 0 on error or a non zero integer (actually the +recovered secret key size) if successful. + +EVP_OpenUpdate() returns 1 for success or 0 for failure. + +EVP_OpenFinal() returns 0 if the decrypt failed or 1 for success. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..10687e458 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_PKEY_new, EVP_PKEY_free - private key allocation functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + EVP_PKEY *EVP_PKEY_new(void); + void EVP_PKEY_free(EVP_PKEY *key); + + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP_PKEY_new() function allocates an empty B +structure which is used by OpenSSL to store private keys. + +EVP_PKEY_free() frees up the private key B. + +=head1 NOTES + +The B structure is used by various OpenSSL functions +which require a general private key without reference to any +particular algorithm. + +The structure returned by EVP_PKEY_new() is empty. To add a +private key to this empty structure the functions described in +L should be used. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_PKEY_new() returns either the newly allocated B +structure of B if an error occurred. + +EVP_PKEY_free() does not return a value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2db692e27 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA.pod @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA, EVP_PKEY_set1_DSA, EVP_PKEY_set1_DH, EVP_PKEY_set1_EC_KEY, +EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA, EVP_PKEY_get1_DSA, EVP_PKEY_get1_DH, EVP_PKEY_get1_EC_KEY, +EVP_PKEY_assign_RSA, EVP_PKEY_assign_DSA, EVP_PKEY_assign_DH, EVP_PKEY_assign_EC_KEY, +EVP_PKEY_type - EVP_PKEY assignment functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA(EVP_PKEY *pkey,RSA *key); + int EVP_PKEY_set1_DSA(EVP_PKEY *pkey,DSA *key); + int EVP_PKEY_set1_DH(EVP_PKEY *pkey,DH *key); + int EVP_PKEY_set1_EC_KEY(EVP_PKEY *pkey,EC_KEY *key); + + RSA *EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA(EVP_PKEY *pkey); + DSA *EVP_PKEY_get1_DSA(EVP_PKEY *pkey); + DH *EVP_PKEY_get1_DH(EVP_PKEY *pkey); + EC_KEY *EVP_PKEY_get1_EC_KEY(EVP_PKEY *pkey); + + int EVP_PKEY_assign_RSA(EVP_PKEY *pkey,RSA *key); + int EVP_PKEY_assign_DSA(EVP_PKEY *pkey,DSA *key); + int EVP_PKEY_assign_DH(EVP_PKEY *pkey,DH *key); + int EVP_PKEY_assign_EC_KEY(EVP_PKEY *pkey,EC_KEY *key); + + int EVP_PKEY_type(int type); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA(), EVP_PKEY_set1_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_set1_DH() and +EVP_PKEY_set1_EC_KEY() set the key referenced by B to B. + +EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA(), EVP_PKEY_get1_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_get1_DH() and +EVP_PKEY_get1_EC_KEY() return the referenced key in B or +B if the key is not of the correct type. + +EVP_PKEY_assign_RSA() EVP_PKEY_assign_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_assign_DH() +and EVP_PKEY_assign_EC_KEY() also set the referenced key to B +however these use the supplied B internally and so B +will be freed when the parent B is freed. + +EVP_PKEY_type() returns the type of key corresponding to the value +B. The type of a key can be obtained with +EVP_PKEY_type(pkey->type). The return value will be EVP_PKEY_RSA, +EVP_PKEY_DSA, EVP_PKEY_DH or EVP_PKEY_EC for the corresponding +key types or NID_undef if the key type is unassigned. + +=head1 NOTES + +In accordance with the OpenSSL naming convention the key obtained +from or assigned to the B using the B<1> functions must be +freed as well as B. + +EVP_PKEY_assign_RSA() EVP_PKEY_assign_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_assign_DH() +EVP_PKEY_assign_EC_KEY() are implemented as macros. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_PKEY_set1_RSA(), EVP_PKEY_set1_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_set1_DH() and +EVP_PKEY_set1_EC_KEY() return 1 for success or 0 for failure. + +EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA(), EVP_PKEY_get1_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_get1_DH() and +EVP_PKEY_get1_EC_KEY() return the referenced key or B if +an error occurred. + +EVP_PKEY_assign_RSA() EVP_PKEY_assign_DSA(), EVP_PKEY_assign_DH() +and EVP_PKEY_assign_EC_KEY() return 1 for success and 0 for failure. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SealInit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SealInit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7d793e19e --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SealInit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_SealInit, EVP_SealUpdate, EVP_SealFinal - EVP envelope encryption + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int EVP_SealInit(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, const EVP_CIPHER *type, + unsigned char **ek, int *ekl, unsigned char *iv, + EVP_PKEY **pubk, int npubk); + int EVP_SealUpdate(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl, unsigned char *in, int inl); + int EVP_SealFinal(EVP_CIPHER_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *out, + int *outl); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP envelope routines are a high level interface to envelope +encryption. They generate a random key and IV (if required) then +"envelope" it by using public key encryption. Data can then be +encrypted using this key. + +EVP_SealInit() initializes a cipher context B for encryption +with cipher B using a random secret key and IV. B is normally +supplied by a function such as EVP_des_cbc(). The secret key is encrypted +using one or more public keys, this allows the same encrypted data to be +decrypted using any of the corresponding private keys. B is an array of +buffers where the public key encrypted secret key will be written, each buffer +must contain enough room for the corresponding encrypted key: that is +B must have room for B bytes. The actual +size of each encrypted secret key is written to the array B. B is +an array of B public keys. + +The B parameter is a buffer where the generated IV is written to. It must +contain enough room for the corresponding cipher's IV, as determined by (for +example) EVP_CIPHER_iv_length(type). + +If the cipher does not require an IV then the B parameter is ignored +and can be B. + +EVP_SealUpdate() and EVP_SealFinal() have exactly the same properties +as the EVP_EncryptUpdate() and EVP_EncryptFinal() routines, as +documented on the L manual +page. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_SealInit() returns 0 on error or B if successful. + +EVP_SealUpdate() and EVP_SealFinal() return 1 for success and 0 for +failure. + +=head1 NOTES + +Because a random secret key is generated the random number generator +must be seeded before calling EVP_SealInit(). + +The public key must be RSA because it is the only OpenSSL public key +algorithm that supports key transport. + +Envelope encryption is the usual method of using public key encryption +on large amounts of data, this is because public key encryption is slow +but symmetric encryption is fast. So symmetric encryption is used for +bulk encryption and the small random symmetric key used is transferred +using public key encryption. + +It is possible to call EVP_SealInit() twice in the same way as +EVP_EncryptInit(). The first call should have B set to 0 +and (after setting any cipher parameters) it should be called again +with B set to NULL. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +EVP_SealFinal() did not return a value before OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SignInit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SignInit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b6e62ce7f --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_SignInit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_SignInit, EVP_SignUpdate, EVP_SignFinal - EVP signing functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int EVP_SignInit_ex(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const EVP_MD *type, ENGINE *impl); + int EVP_SignUpdate(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const void *d, unsigned int cnt); + int EVP_SignFinal(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx,unsigned char *sig,unsigned int *s, EVP_PKEY *pkey); + + void EVP_SignInit(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const EVP_MD *type); + + int EVP_PKEY_size(EVP_PKEY *pkey); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP signature routines are a high level interface to digital +signatures. + +EVP_SignInit_ex() sets up signing context B to use digest +B from ENGINE B. B must be initialized with +EVP_MD_CTX_init() before calling this function. + +EVP_SignUpdate() hashes B bytes of data at B into the +signature context B. This function can be called several times on the +same B to include additional data. + +EVP_SignFinal() signs the data in B using the private key B and +places the signature in B. The number of bytes of data written (i.e. the +length of the signature) will be written to the integer at B, at most +EVP_PKEY_size(pkey) bytes will be written. + +EVP_SignInit() initializes a signing context B to use the default +implementation of digest B. + +EVP_PKEY_size() returns the maximum size of a signature in bytes. The actual +signature returned by EVP_SignFinal() may be smaller. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_SignInit_ex(), EVP_SignUpdate() and EVP_SignFinal() return 1 +for success and 0 for failure. + +EVP_PKEY_size() returns the maximum size of a signature in bytes. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 NOTES + +The B interface to digital signatures should almost always be used in +preference to the low level interfaces. This is because the code then becomes +transparent to the algorithm used and much more flexible. + +Due to the link between message digests and public key algorithms the correct +digest algorithm must be used with the correct public key type. A list of +algorithms and associated public key algorithms appears in +L. + +When signing with DSA private keys the random number generator must be seeded +or the operation will fail. The random number generator does not need to be +seeded for RSA signatures. + +The call to EVP_SignFinal() internally finalizes a copy of the digest context. +This means that calls to EVP_SignUpdate() and EVP_SignFinal() can be called +later to digest and sign additional data. + +Since only a copy of the digest context is ever finalized the context must +be cleaned up after use by calling EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup() or a memory leak +will occur. + +=head1 BUGS + +Older versions of this documentation wrongly stated that calls to +EVP_SignUpdate() could not be made after calling EVP_SignFinal(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +EVP_SignInit(), EVP_SignUpdate() and EVP_SignFinal() are +available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +EVP_SignInit_ex() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_VerifyInit.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_VerifyInit.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b6afaedee --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/EVP_VerifyInit.pod @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +EVP_VerifyInit, EVP_VerifyUpdate, EVP_VerifyFinal - EVP signature verification functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int EVP_VerifyInit_ex(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const EVP_MD *type, ENGINE *impl); + int EVP_VerifyUpdate(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const void *d, unsigned int cnt); + int EVP_VerifyFinal(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx,unsigned char *sigbuf, unsigned int siglen,EVP_PKEY *pkey); + + int EVP_VerifyInit(EVP_MD_CTX *ctx, const EVP_MD *type); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP signature verification routines are a high level interface to digital +signatures. + +EVP_VerifyInit_ex() sets up verification context B to use digest +B from ENGINE B. B must be initialized by calling +EVP_MD_CTX_init() before calling this function. + +EVP_VerifyUpdate() hashes B bytes of data at B into the +verification context B. This function can be called several times on the +same B to include additional data. + +EVP_VerifyFinal() verifies the data in B using the public key B +and against the B bytes at B. + +EVP_VerifyInit() initializes verification context B to use the default +implementation of digest B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +EVP_VerifyInit_ex() and EVP_VerifyUpdate() return 1 for success and 0 for +failure. + +EVP_VerifyFinal() returns 1 for a correct signature, 0 for failure and -1 if some +other error occurred. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 NOTES + +The B interface to digital signatures should almost always be used in +preference to the low level interfaces. This is because the code then becomes +transparent to the algorithm used and much more flexible. + +Due to the link between message digests and public key algorithms the correct +digest algorithm must be used with the correct public key type. A list of +algorithms and associated public key algorithms appears in +L. + +The call to EVP_VerifyFinal() internally finalizes a copy of the digest context. +This means that calls to EVP_VerifyUpdate() and EVP_VerifyFinal() can be called +later to digest and verify additional data. + +Since only a copy of the digest context is ever finalized the context must +be cleaned up after use by calling EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup() or a memory leak +will occur. + +=head1 BUGS + +Older versions of this documentation wrongly stated that calls to +EVP_VerifyUpdate() could not be made after calling EVP_VerifyFinal(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, +L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +EVP_VerifyInit(), EVP_VerifyUpdate() and EVP_VerifyFinal() are +available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +EVP_VerifyInit_ex() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.7 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OBJ_nid2obj.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OBJ_nid2obj.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7dcc07923 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OBJ_nid2obj.pod @@ -0,0 +1,149 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OBJ_nid2obj, OBJ_nid2ln, OBJ_nid2sn, OBJ_obj2nid, OBJ_txt2nid, OBJ_ln2nid, OBJ_sn2nid, +OBJ_cmp, OBJ_dup, OBJ_txt2obj, OBJ_obj2txt, OBJ_create, OBJ_cleanup - ASN1 object utility +functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + ASN1_OBJECT * OBJ_nid2obj(int n); + const char * OBJ_nid2ln(int n); + const char * OBJ_nid2sn(int n); + + int OBJ_obj2nid(const ASN1_OBJECT *o); + int OBJ_ln2nid(const char *ln); + int OBJ_sn2nid(const char *sn); + + int OBJ_txt2nid(const char *s); + + ASN1_OBJECT * OBJ_txt2obj(const char *s, int no_name); + int OBJ_obj2txt(char *buf, int buf_len, const ASN1_OBJECT *a, int no_name); + + int OBJ_cmp(const ASN1_OBJECT *a,const ASN1_OBJECT *b); + ASN1_OBJECT * OBJ_dup(const ASN1_OBJECT *o); + + int OBJ_create(const char *oid,const char *sn,const char *ln); + void OBJ_cleanup(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The ASN1 object utility functions process ASN1_OBJECT structures which are +a representation of the ASN1 OBJECT IDENTIFIER (OID) type. + +OBJ_nid2obj(), OBJ_nid2ln() and OBJ_nid2sn() convert the NID B to +an ASN1_OBJECT structure, its long name and its short name respectively, +or B is an error occurred. + +OBJ_obj2nid(), OBJ_ln2nid(), OBJ_sn2nid() return the corresponding NID +for the object B, the long name or the short name respectively +or NID_undef if an error occurred. + +OBJ_txt2nid() returns NID corresponding to text string . B can be +a long name, a short name or the numerical respresentation of an object. + +OBJ_txt2obj() converts the text string B into an ASN1_OBJECT structure. +If B is 0 then long names and short names will be interpreted +as well as numerical forms. If B is 1 only the numerical form +is acceptable. + +OBJ_obj2txt() converts the B B into a textual representation. +The representation is written as a null terminated string to B +at most B bytes are written, truncating the result if necessary. +The total amount of space required is returned. If B is 0 then +if the object has a long or short name then that will be used, otherwise +the numerical form will be used. If B is 1 then the numerical +form will always be used. + +OBJ_cmp() compares B to B. If the two are identical 0 is returned. + +OBJ_dup() returns a copy of B. + +OBJ_create() adds a new object to the internal table. B is the +numerical form of the object, B the short name and B the +long name. A new NID is returned for the created object. + +OBJ_cleanup() cleans up OpenSSLs internal object table: this should +be called before an application exits if any new objects were added +using OBJ_create(). + +=head1 NOTES + +Objects in OpenSSL can have a short name, a long name and a numerical +identifier (NID) associated with them. A standard set of objects is +represented in an internal table. The appropriate values are defined +in the header file B. + +For example the OID for commonName has the following definitions: + + #define SN_commonName "CN" + #define LN_commonName "commonName" + #define NID_commonName 13 + +New objects can be added by calling OBJ_create(). + +Table objects have certain advantages over other objects: for example +their NIDs can be used in a C language switch statement. They are +also static constant structures which are shared: that is there +is only a single constant structure for each table object. + +Objects which are not in the table have the NID value NID_undef. + +Objects do not need to be in the internal tables to be processed, +the functions OBJ_txt2obj() and OBJ_obj2txt() can process the numerical +form of an OID. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Create an object for B: + + ASN1_OBJECT *o; + o = OBJ_nid2obj(NID_commonName); + +Check if an object is B + + if (OBJ_obj2nid(obj) == NID_commonName) + /* Do something */ + +Create a new NID and initialize an object from it: + + int new_nid; + ASN1_OBJECT *obj; + new_nid = OBJ_create("1.2.3.4", "NewOID", "New Object Identifier"); + + obj = OBJ_nid2obj(new_nid); + +Create a new object directly: + + obj = OBJ_txt2obj("1.2.3.4", 1); + +=head1 BUGS + +OBJ_obj2txt() is awkward and messy to use: it doesn't follow the +convention of other OpenSSL functions where the buffer can be set +to B to determine the amount of data that should be written. +Instead B must point to a valid buffer and B should +be set to a positive value. A buffer length of 80 should be more +than enough to handle any OID encountered in practice. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +OBJ_nid2obj() returns an B structure or B is an +error occurred. + +OBJ_nid2ln() and OBJ_nid2sn() returns a valid string or B +on error. + +OBJ_obj2nid(), OBJ_ln2nid(), OBJ_sn2nid() and OBJ_txt2nid() return +a NID or B on error. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_Applink.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_Applink.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e54de12cc --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_Applink.pod @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OPENSSL_Applink - glue between OpenSSL BIO and Win32 compiler run-time + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + __declspec(dllexport) void **OPENSSL_Applink(); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +OPENSSL_Applink is application-side interface which provides a glue +between OpenSSL BIO layer and Win32 compiler run-time environment. +Even though it appears at application side, it's essentially OpenSSL +private interface. For this reason application developers are not +expected to implement it, but to compile provided module with +compiler of their choice and link it into the target application. +The referred module is available as /ms/applink.c. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..c39ac35e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER.pod @@ -0,0 +1,101 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER, SSLeay, SSLeay_version - get OpenSSL version number + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #define OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER 0xnnnnnnnnnL + + #include + long SSLeay(void); + const char *SSLeay_version(int t); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER is a numeric release version identifier: + + MMNNFFPPS: major minor fix patch status + +The status nibble has one of the values 0 for development, 1 to e for betas +1 to 14, and f for release. + +for example + + 0x000906000 == 0.9.6 dev + 0x000906023 == 0.9.6b beta 3 + 0x00090605f == 0.9.6e release + +Versions prior to 0.9.3 have identifiers E 0x0930. +Versions between 0.9.3 and 0.9.5 had a version identifier with this +interpretation: + + MMNNFFRBB major minor fix final beta/patch + +for example + + 0x000904100 == 0.9.4 release + 0x000905000 == 0.9.5 dev + +Version 0.9.5a had an interim interpretation that is like the current one, +except the patch level got the highest bit set, to keep continuity. The +number was therefore 0x0090581f. + + +For backward compatibility, SSLEAY_VERSION_NUMBER is also defined. + +SSLeay() returns this number. The return value can be compared to the +macro to make sure that the correct version of the library has been +loaded, especially when using DLLs on Windows systems. + +SSLeay_version() returns different strings depending on B: + +=over 4 + +=item SSLEAY_VERSION + +The text variant of the version number and the release date. For example, +"OpenSSL 0.9.5a 1 Apr 2000". + +=item SSLEAY_CFLAGS + +The compiler flags set for the compilation process in the form +"compiler: ..." if available or "compiler: information not available" +otherwise. + +=item SSLEAY_BUILT_ON + +The date of the build process in the form "built on: ..." if available +or "built on: date not available" otherwise. + +=item SSLEAY_PLATFORM + +The "Configure" target of the library build in the form "platform: ..." +if available or "platform: information not available" otherwise. + +=item SSLEAY_DIR + +The "OPENSSLDIR" setting of the library build in the form "OPENSSLDIR: "..."" +if available or "OPENSSLDIR: N/A" otherwise. + +=back + +For an unknown B, the text "not available" is returned. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +The version number. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +SSLeay() and SSLEAY_VERSION_NUMBER are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER is available in all versions of OpenSSL. +B was added in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_config.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_config.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e7bba2aac --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_config.pod @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OPENSSL_config, OPENSSL_no_config - simple OpenSSL configuration functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void OPENSSL_config(const char *config_name); + void OPENSSL_no_config(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +OPENSSL_config() configures OpenSSL using the standard B +configuration file name using B. If B is NULL then +the default name B will be used. Any errors are ignored. Further +calls to OPENSSL_config() will have no effect. The configuration file format +is documented in the L manual page. + +OPENSSL_no_config() disables configuration. If called before OPENSSL_config() +no configuration takes place. + +=head1 NOTES + +It is B recommended that B new applications call OPENSSL_config() +or the more sophisticated functions such as CONF_modules_load() during +initialization (that is before starting any threads). By doing this +an application does not need to keep track of all configuration options +and some new functionality can be supported automatically. + +It is also possible to automatically call OPENSSL_config() when an application +calls OPENSSL_add_all_algorithms() by compiling an application with the +preprocessor symbol B #define'd. In this way configuration +can be added without source changes. + +The environment variable B can be set to specify the location +of the configuration file. + +Currently ASN1 OBJECTs and ENGINE configuration can be performed future +versions of OpenSSL will add new configuration options. + +There are several reasons why calling the OpenSSL configuration routines is +advisable. For example new ENGINE functionality was added to OpenSSL 0.9.7. +In OpenSSL 0.9.7 control functions can be supported by ENGINEs, this can be +used (among other things) to load dynamic ENGINEs from shared libraries (DSOs). +However very few applications currently support the control interface and so +very few can load and use dynamic ENGINEs. Equally in future more sophisticated +ENGINEs will require certain control operations to customize them. If an +application calls OPENSSL_config() it doesn't need to know or care about +ENGINE control operations because they can be performed by editing a +configuration file. + +Applications should free up configuration at application closedown by calling +CONF_modules_free(). + +=head1 RESTRICTIONS + +The OPENSSL_config() function is designed to be a very simple "call it and +forget it" function. As a result its behaviour is somewhat limited. It ignores +all errors silently and it can only load from the standard configuration file +location for example. + +It is however B better than nothing. Applications which need finer +control over their configuration functionality should use the configuration +functions such as CONF_load_modules() directly. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +Neither OPENSSL_config() nor OPENSSL_no_config() return a value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +OPENSSL_config() and OPENSSL_no_config() first appeared in OpenSSL 0.9.7 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_ia32cap.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_ia32cap.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2e659d34a --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_ia32cap.pod @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OPENSSL_ia32cap - finding the IA-32 processor capabilities + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + unsigned long *OPENSSL_ia32cap_loc(void); + #define OPENSSL_ia32cap (*(OPENSSL_ia32cap_loc())) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +Value returned by OPENSSL_ia32cap_loc() is address of a variable +containing IA-32 processor capabilities bit vector as it appears in EDX +register after executing CPUID instruction with EAX=1 input value (see +Intel Application Note #241618). Naturally it's meaningful on IA-32[E] +platforms only. The variable is normally set up automatically upon +toolkit initialization, but can be manipulated afterwards to modify +crypto library behaviour. For the moment of this writing six bits are +significant, namely: + +1. bit #28 denoting Hyperthreading, which is used to distiguish + cores with shared cache; +2. bit #26 denoting SSE2 support; +3. bit #25 denoting SSE support; +4. bit #23 denoting MMX support; +5. bit #20, reserved by Intel, is used to choose between RC4 code + pathes; +6. bit #4 denoting presence of Time-Stamp Counter. + +For example, clearing bit #26 at run-time disables high-performance +SSE2 code present in the crypto library. You might have to do this if +target OpenSSL application is executed on SSE2 capable CPU, but under +control of OS which does not support SSE2 extentions. Even though you +can manipulate the value programmatically, you most likely will find it +more appropriate to set up an environment variable with the same name +prior starting target application, e.g. on Intel P4 processor 'env +OPENSSL_ia32cap=0x12900010 apps/openssl', to achieve same effect +without modifying the application source code. Alternatively you can +reconfigure the toolkit with no-sse2 option and recompile. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..f14dfaf00 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules.pod @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules - add standard configuration modules + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules(void); + void ASN1_add_oid_module(void); + ENGINE_add_conf_module(); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The function OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules() adds all the standard OpenSSL +configuration modules to the internal list. They can then be used by the +OpenSSL configuration code. + +ASN1_add_oid_module() adds just the ASN1 OBJECT module. + +ENGINE_add_conf_module() adds just the ENGINE configuration module. + +=head1 NOTES + +If the simple configuration function OPENSSL_config() is called then +OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules() is called automatically. + +Applications which use the configuration functions directly will need to +call OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules() themselves I any other +configuration code. + +Applications should call OPENSSL_load_builtin_modules() to load all +configuration modules instead of adding modules selectively: otherwise +functionality may be missing from the application if an when new +modules are added. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +None of the functions return a value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +These functions first appeared in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e63411b5b --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms.pod @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms, OpenSSL_add_all_ciphers, OpenSSL_add_all_digests - +add algorithms to internal table + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms(void); + void OpenSSL_add_all_ciphers(void); + void OpenSSL_add_all_digests(void); + + void EVP_cleanup(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +OpenSSL keeps an internal table of digest algorithms and ciphers. It uses +this table to lookup ciphers via functions such as EVP_get_cipher_byname(). + +OpenSSL_add_all_digests() adds all digest algorithms to the table. + +OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms() adds all algorithms to the table (digests and +ciphers). + +OpenSSL_add_all_ciphers() adds all encryption algorithms to the table including +password based encryption algorithms. + +EVP_cleanup() removes all ciphers and digests from the table. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +None of the functions return a value. + +=head1 NOTES + +A typical application will call OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms() initially and +EVP_cleanup() before exiting. + +An application does not need to add algorithms to use them explicitly, for example +by EVP_sha1(). It just needs to add them if it (or any of the functions it calls) +needs to lookup algorithms. + +The cipher and digest lookup functions are used in many parts of the library. If +the table is not initialized several functions will misbehave and complain they +cannot find algorithms. This includes the PEM, PKCS#12, SSL and S/MIME libraries. +This is a common query in the OpenSSL mailing lists. + +Calling OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms() links in all algorithms: as a result a +statically linked executable can be quite large. If this is important it is possible +to just add the required ciphers and digests. + +=head1 BUGS + +Although the functions do not return error codes it is possible for them to fail. +This will only happen as a result of a memory allocation failure so this is not +too much of a problem in practice. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_create.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_create.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..de7cab2bd --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_create.pod @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PKCS12_create - create a PKCS#12 structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + PKCS12 *PKCS12_create(char *pass, char *name, EVP_PKEY *pkey, X509 *cert, STACK_OF(X509) *ca, + int nid_key, int nid_cert, int iter, int mac_iter, int keytype); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +PKCS12_create() creates a PKCS#12 structure. + +B is the passphrase to use. B is the B to use for +the supplied certifictate and key. B is the private key to include in +the structure and B its corresponding certificates. B, if not B +is an optional set of certificates to also include in the structure. + +B and B are the encryption algorithms that should be used +for the key and certificate respectively. B is the encryption algorithm +iteration count to use and B is the MAC iteration count to use. +B is the type of key. + +=head1 NOTES + +The parameters B, B, B, B and B +can all be set to zero and sensible defaults will be used. + +These defaults are: 40 bit RC2 encryption for certificates, triple DES +encryption for private keys, a key iteration count of PKCS12_DEFAULT_ITER +(currently 2048) and a MAC iteration count of 1. + +The default MAC iteration count is 1 in order to retain compatibility with +old software which did not interpret MAC iteration counts. If such compatibility +is not required then B should be set to PKCS12_DEFAULT_ITER. + +B adds a flag to the store private key. This is a non standard extension +that is only currently interpreted by MSIE. If set to zero the flag is omitted, +if set to B the key can be used for signing only, if set to B +it can be used for signing and encryption. This option was useful for old +export grade software which could use signing only keys of arbitrary size but +had restrictions on the permissible sizes of keys which could be used for +encryption. + +=head1 NEW FUNCTIONALITY IN OPENSSL 0.9.8 + +Some additional functionality was added to PKCS12_create() in OpenSSL +0.9.8. These extensions are detailed below. + +If a certificate contains an B or B then this will be +used for the corresponding B or B in the +PKCS12 structure. + +Either B, B or both can be B to indicate that no key or +certficate is required. In previous versions both had to be present or +a fatal error is returned. + +B or B can be set to -1 indicating that no encryption +should be used. + +B can be set to -1 and the MAC will then be omitted entirely. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +PKCS12_create was added in OpenSSL 0.9.3 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_parse.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_parse.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..51344f883 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS12_parse.pod @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PKCS12_parse - parse a PKCS#12 structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + +int PKCS12_parse(PKCS12 *p12, const char *pass, EVP_PKEY **pkey, X509 **cert, STACK_OF(X509) **ca); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +PKCS12_parse() parses a PKCS12 structure. + +B is the B structure to parse. B is the passphrase to use. +If successful the private key will be written to B<*pkey>, the corresponding +certificate to B<*cert> and any additional certificates to B<*ca>. + +=head1 NOTES + +The parameters B and B cannot be B. B can be +in which case additional certificates will be discarded. B<*ca> can also +be a valid STACK in which case additional certificates are appended to +B<*ca>. If B<*ca> is B a new STACK will be allocated. + +The B and B attributes (if present) on each certificate +will be stored in the B and B attributes of the B structure. + +=head1 BUGS + +Only a single private key and corresponding certificate is returned by this function. +More complex PKCS#12 files with multiple private keys will only return the first +match. + +Only B and B attributes are currently stored in certificates. +Other attributes are discarded. + +Attributes currently cannot be store in the private key B structure. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +PKCS12_parse was added in OpenSSL 0.9.3 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_decrypt.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_decrypt.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b0ca067b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_decrypt.pod @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PKCS7_decrypt - decrypt content from a PKCS#7 envelopedData structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +int PKCS7_decrypt(PKCS7 *p7, EVP_PKEY *pkey, X509 *cert, BIO *data, int flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +PKCS7_decrypt() extracts and decrypts the content from a PKCS#7 envelopedData +structure. B is the private key of the recipient, B is the +recipients certificate, B is a BIO to write the content to and +B is an optional set of flags. + +=head1 NOTES + +OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms() (or equivalent) should be called before using this +function or errors about unknown algorithms will occur. + +Although the recipients certificate is not needed to decrypt the data it is needed +to locate the appropriate (of possible several) recipients in the PKCS#7 structure. + +The following flags can be passed in the B parameter. + +If the B flag is set MIME headers for type B are deleted +from the content. If the content is not of type B then an error is +returned. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +PKCS7_decrypt() returns either 1 for success or 0 for failure. +The error can be obtained from ERR_get_error(3) + +=head1 BUGS + +PKCS7_decrypt() must be passed the correct recipient key and certificate. It would +be better if it could look up the correct key and certificate from a database. + +The lack of single pass processing and need to hold all data in memory as +mentioned in PKCS7_sign() also applies to PKCS7_verify(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +PKCS7_decrypt() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.5 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_encrypt.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_encrypt.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1a507b22a --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_encrypt.pod @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PKCS7_encrypt - create a PKCS#7 envelopedData structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +PKCS7 *PKCS7_encrypt(STACK_OF(X509) *certs, BIO *in, const EVP_CIPHER *cipher, int flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +PKCS7_encrypt() creates and returns a PKCS#7 envelopedData structure. B +is a list of recipient certificates. B is the content to be encrypted. +B is the symmetric cipher to use. B is an optional set of flags. + +=head1 NOTES + +Only RSA keys are supported in PKCS#7 and envelopedData so the recipient certificates +supplied to this function must all contain RSA public keys, though they do not have to +be signed using the RSA algorithm. + +EVP_des_ede3_cbc() (triple DES) is the algorithm of choice for S/MIME use because +most clients will support it. + +Some old "export grade" clients may only support weak encryption using 40 or 64 bit +RC2. These can be used by passing EVP_rc2_40_cbc() and EVP_rc2_64_cbc() respectively. + +The algorithm passed in the B parameter must support ASN1 encoding of its +parameters. + +Many browsers implement a "sign and encrypt" option which is simply an S/MIME +envelopedData containing an S/MIME signed message. This can be readily produced +by storing the S/MIME signed message in a memory BIO and passing it to +PKCS7_encrypt(). + +The following flags can be passed in the B parameter. + +If the B flag is set MIME headers for type B are prepended +to the data. + +Normally the supplied content is translated into MIME canonical format (as required +by the S/MIME specifications) if B is set no translation occurs. This +option should be used if the supplied data is in binary format otherwise the translation +will corrupt it. If B is set then B is ignored. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +PKCS7_encrypt() returns either a valid PKCS7 structure or NULL if an error occurred. +The error can be obtained from ERR_get_error(3). + +=head1 BUGS + +The lack of single pass processing and need to hold all data in memory as +mentioned in PKCS7_sign() also applies to PKCS7_verify(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +PKCS7_decrypt() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.5 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_sign.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_sign.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ffd0c734b --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_sign.pod @@ -0,0 +1,101 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PKCS7_sign - create a PKCS#7 signedData structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +PKCS7 *PKCS7_sign(X509 *signcert, EVP_PKEY *pkey, STACK_OF(X509) *certs, BIO *data, int flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +PKCS7_sign() creates and returns a PKCS#7 signedData structure. B +is the certificate to sign with, B is the corresponsding private key. +B is an optional additional set of certificates to include in the +PKCS#7 structure (for example any intermediate CAs in the chain). + +The data to be signed is read from BIO B. + +B is an optional set of flags. + +=head1 NOTES + +Any of the following flags (ored together) can be passed in the B parameter. + +Many S/MIME clients expect the signed content to include valid MIME headers. If +the B flag is set MIME headers for type B are prepended +to the data. + +If B is set the signer's certificate will not be included in the +PKCS7 structure, the signer's certificate must still be supplied in the B +parameter though. This can reduce the size of the signature if the signers certificate +can be obtained by other means: for example a previously signed message. + +The data being signed is included in the PKCS7 structure, unless B +is set in which case it is omitted. This is used for PKCS7 detached signatures +which are used in S/MIME plaintext signed messages for example. + +Normally the supplied content is translated into MIME canonical format (as required +by the S/MIME specifications) if B is set no translation occurs. This +option should be used if the supplied data is in binary format otherwise the translation +will corrupt it. + +The signedData structure includes several PKCS#7 autenticatedAttributes including +the signing time, the PKCS#7 content type and the supported list of ciphers in +an SMIMECapabilities attribute. If B is set then no authenticatedAttributes +will be used. If B is set then just the SMIMECapabilities are +omitted. + +If present the SMIMECapabilities attribute indicates support for the following +algorithms: triple DES, 128 bit RC2, 64 bit RC2, DES and 40 bit RC2. If any +of these algorithms is disabled then it will not be included. + +If the flags B is set then the returned B structure +is just initialized ready to perform the signing operation. The signing +is however B performed and the data to be signed is not read from +the B parameter. Signing is deferred until after the data has been +written. In this way data can be signed in a single pass. Currently the +flag B B also be set. + +=head1 NOTES + +Currently the flag B is only supported for detached +data. If this flag is set the returned B structure is B +complete and outputting its contents via a function that does not +properly finalize the B structure will give unpredictable +results. + +At present only the SMIME_write_PKCS7() function properly finalizes the +structure. + +=head1 BUGS + +PKCS7_sign() is somewhat limited. It does not support multiple signers, some +advanced attributes such as counter signatures are not supported. + +The SHA1 digest algorithm is currently always used. + +When the signed data is not detached it will be stored in memory within the +B structure. This effectively limits the size of messages which can be +signed due to memory restraints. There should be a way to sign data without +having to hold it all in memory, this would however require fairly major +revisions of the OpenSSL ASN1 code. + + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +PKCS7_sign() returns either a valid PKCS7 structure or NULL if an error occurred. +The error can be obtained from ERR_get_error(3). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +PKCS7_sign() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.5 + +The B flag was added in OpenSSL 0.9.8 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_verify.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_verify.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3490b5dc8 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/PKCS7_verify.pod @@ -0,0 +1,116 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PKCS7_verify - verify a PKCS#7 signedData structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +int PKCS7_verify(PKCS7 *p7, STACK_OF(X509) *certs, X509_STORE *store, BIO *indata, BIO *out, int flags); + +STACK_OF(X509) *PKCS7_get0_signers(PKCS7 *p7, STACK_OF(X509) *certs, int flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +PKCS7_verify() verifies a PKCS#7 signedData structure. B is the PKCS7 +structure to verify. B is a set of certificates in which to search for +the signer's certificate. B is a trusted certficate store (used for +chain verification). B is the signed data if the content is not +present in B (that is it is detached). The content is written to B +if it is not NULL. + +B is an optional set of flags, which can be used to modify the verify +operation. + +PKCS7_get0_signers() retrieves the signer's certificates from B, it does +B check their validity or whether any signatures are valid. The B +and B parameters have the same meanings as in PKCS7_verify(). + +=head1 VERIFY PROCESS + +Normally the verify process proceeds as follows. + +Initially some sanity checks are performed on B. The type of B must +be signedData. There must be at least one signature on the data and if +the content is detached B cannot be B. + +An attempt is made to locate all the signer's certificates, first looking in +the B parameter (if it is not B) and then looking in any certificates +contained in the B structure itself. If any signer's certificates cannot be +located the operation fails. + +Each signer's certificate is chain verified using the B purpose and +the supplied trusted certificate store. Any internal certificates in the message +are used as untrusted CAs. If any chain verify fails an error code is returned. + +Finally the signed content is read (and written to B is it is not NULL) and +the signature's checked. + +If all signature's verify correctly then the function is successful. + +Any of the following flags (ored together) can be passed in the B parameter +to change the default verify behaviour. Only the flag B is +meaningful to PKCS7_get0_signers(). + +If B is set the certificates in the message itself are not +searched when locating the signer's certificate. This means that all the signers +certificates must be in the B parameter. + +If the B flag is set MIME headers for type B are deleted +from the content. If the content is not of type B then an error is +returned. + +If B is set the signer's certificates are not chain verified. + +If B is set then the certificates contained in the message are +not used as untrusted CAs. This means that the whole verify chain (apart from +the signer's certificate) must be contained in the trusted store. + +If B is set then the signatures on the data are not checked. + +=head1 NOTES + +One application of B is to only accept messages signed by +a small number of certificates. The acceptable certificates would be passed +in the B parameter. In this case if the signer is not one of the +certificates supplied in B then the verify will fail because the +signer cannot be found. + +Care should be taken when modifying the default verify behaviour, for example +setting B will totally disable all verification +and any signed message will be considered valid. This combination is however +useful if one merely wishes to write the content to B and its validity +is not considered important. + +Chain verification should arguably be performed using the signing time rather +than the current time. However since the signing time is supplied by the +signer it cannot be trusted without additional evidence (such as a trusted +timestamp). + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +PKCS7_verify() returns 1 for a successful verification and zero or a negative +value if an error occurs. + +PKCS7_get0_signers() returns all signers or B if an error occurred. + +The error can be obtained from L + +=head1 BUGS + +The trusted certificate store is not searched for the signers certificate, +this is primarily due to the inadequacies of the current B +functionality. + +The lack of single pass processing and need to hold all data in memory as +mentioned in PKCS7_sign() also applies to PKCS7_verify(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +PKCS7_verify() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.5 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_add.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_add.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..67c66f3e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_add.pod @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RAND_add, RAND_seed, RAND_status, RAND_event, RAND_screen - add +entropy to the PRNG + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void RAND_seed(const void *buf, int num); + + void RAND_add(const void *buf, int num, double entropy); + + int RAND_status(void); + + int RAND_event(UINT iMsg, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); + void RAND_screen(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RAND_add() mixes the B bytes at B into the PRNG state. Thus, +if the data at B are unpredictable to an adversary, this +increases the uncertainty about the state and makes the PRNG output +less predictable. Suitable input comes from user interaction (random +key presses, mouse movements) and certain hardware events. The +B argument is (the lower bound of) an estimate of how much +randomness is contained in B, measured in bytes. Details about +sources of randomness and how to estimate their entropy can be found +in the literature, e.g. RFC 1750. + +RAND_add() may be called with sensitive data such as user entered +passwords. The seed values cannot be recovered from the PRNG output. + +OpenSSL makes sure that the PRNG state is unique for each thread. On +systems that provide C, the randomness device is used +to seed the PRNG transparently. However, on all other systems, the +application is responsible for seeding the PRNG by calling RAND_add(), +L +or L. + +RAND_seed() is equivalent to RAND_add() when B. + +RAND_event() collects the entropy from Windows events such as mouse +movements and other user interaction. It should be called with the +B, B and B arguments of I messages sent to +the window procedure. It will estimate the entropy contained in the +event message (if any), and add it to the PRNG. The program can then +process the messages as usual. + +The RAND_screen() function is available for the convenience of Windows +programmers. It adds the current contents of the screen to the PRNG. +For applications that can catch Windows events, seeding the PRNG by +calling RAND_event() is a significantly better source of +randomness. It should be noted that both methods cannot be used on +servers that run without user interaction. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RAND_status() and RAND_event() return 1 if the PRNG has been seeded +with enough data, 0 otherwise. + +The other functions do not return values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RAND_seed() and RAND_screen() are available in all versions of SSLeay +and OpenSSL. RAND_add() and RAND_status() have been added in OpenSSL +0.9.5, RAND_event() in OpenSSL 0.9.5a. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_bytes.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_bytes.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1a9b91e28 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_bytes.pod @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RAND_bytes, RAND_pseudo_bytes - generate random data + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RAND_bytes(unsigned char *buf, int num); + + int RAND_pseudo_bytes(unsigned char *buf, int num); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RAND_bytes() puts B cryptographically strong pseudo-random bytes +into B. An error occurs if the PRNG has not been seeded with +enough randomness to ensure an unpredictable byte sequence. + +RAND_pseudo_bytes() puts B pseudo-random bytes into B. +Pseudo-random byte sequences generated by RAND_pseudo_bytes() will be +unique if they are of sufficient length, but are not necessarily +unpredictable. They can be used for non-cryptographic purposes and for +certain purposes in cryptographic protocols, but usually not for key +generation etc. + +The contents of B is mixed into the entropy pool before retrieving +the new pseudo-random bytes unless disabled at compile time (see FAQ). + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RAND_bytes() returns 1 on success, 0 otherwise. The error code can be +obtained by L. RAND_pseudo_bytes() returns 1 if the +bytes generated are cryptographically strong, 0 otherwise. Both +functions return -1 if they are not supported by the current RAND +method. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RAND_bytes() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. It +has a return value since OpenSSL 0.9.5. RAND_pseudo_bytes() was added +in OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_cleanup.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_cleanup.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3a8f0749a --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_cleanup.pod @@ -0,0 +1,29 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RAND_cleanup - erase the PRNG state + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void RAND_cleanup(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RAND_cleanup() erases the memory used by the PRNG. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +RAND_cleanup() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RAND_cleanup() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_egd.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_egd.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..8b8c61d16 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_egd.pod @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RAND_egd - query entropy gathering daemon + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RAND_egd(const char *path); + int RAND_egd_bytes(const char *path, int bytes); + + int RAND_query_egd_bytes(const char *path, unsigned char *buf, int bytes); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RAND_egd() queries the entropy gathering daemon EGD on socket B. +It queries 255 bytes and uses L to seed the +OpenSSL built-in PRNG. RAND_egd(path) is a wrapper for +RAND_egd_bytes(path, 255); + +RAND_egd_bytes() queries the entropy gathering daemon EGD on socket B. +It queries B bytes and uses L to seed the +OpenSSL built-in PRNG. +This function is more flexible than RAND_egd(). +When only one secret key must +be generated, it is not necessary to request the full amount 255 bytes from +the EGD socket. This can be advantageous, since the amount of entropy +that can be retrieved from EGD over time is limited. + +RAND_query_egd_bytes() performs the actual query of the EGD daemon on socket +B. If B is given, B bytes are queried and written into +B. If B is NULL, B bytes are queried and used to seed the +OpenSSL built-in PRNG using L. + +=head1 NOTES + +On systems without /dev/*random devices providing entropy from the kernel, +the EGD entropy gathering daemon can be used to collect entropy. It provides +a socket interface through which entropy can be gathered in chunks up to +255 bytes. Several chunks can be queried during one connection. + +EGD is available from http://www.lothar.com/tech/crypto/ (C to install). It is run as B +I, where I is an absolute path designating a socket. When +RAND_egd() is called with that path as an argument, it tries to read +random bytes that EGD has collected. RAND_egd() retrieves entropy from the +daemon using the daemon's "non-blocking read" command which shall +be answered immediately by the daemon without waiting for additional +entropy to be collected. The write and read socket operations in the +communication are blocking. + +Alternatively, the EGD-interface compatible daemon PRNGD can be used. It is +available from +http://prngd.sourceforge.net/ . +PRNGD does employ an internal PRNG itself and can therefore never run +out of entropy. + +OpenSSL automatically queries EGD when entropy is requested via RAND_bytes() +or the status is checked via RAND_status() for the first time, if the socket +is located at /var/run/egd-pool, /dev/egd-pool or /etc/egd-pool. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +RAND_egd() and RAND_egd_bytes() return the number of bytes read from the +daemon on success, and -1 if the connection failed or the daemon did not +return enough data to fully seed the PRNG. + +RAND_query_egd_bytes() returns the number of bytes read from the daemon on +success, and -1 if the connection failed. The PRNG state is not considered. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RAND_egd() is available since OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +RAND_egd_bytes() is available since OpenSSL 0.9.6. + +RAND_query_egd_bytes() is available since OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +The automatic query of /var/run/egd-pool et al was added in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_load_file.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_load_file.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..d8c134e62 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_load_file.pod @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RAND_load_file, RAND_write_file, RAND_file_name - PRNG seed file + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + const char *RAND_file_name(char *buf, size_t num); + + int RAND_load_file(const char *filename, long max_bytes); + + int RAND_write_file(const char *filename); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RAND_file_name() generates a default path for the random seed +file. B points to a buffer of size B in which to store the +filename. The seed file is $RANDFILE if that environment variable is +set, $HOME/.rnd otherwise. If $HOME is not set either, or B is +too small for the path name, an error occurs. + +RAND_load_file() reads a number of bytes from file B and +adds them to the PRNG. If B is non-negative, +up to to B are read; starting with OpenSSL 0.9.5, +if B is -1, the complete file is read. + +RAND_write_file() writes a number of random bytes (currently 1024) to +file B which can be used to initialize the PRNG by calling +RAND_load_file() in a later session. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RAND_load_file() returns the number of bytes read. + +RAND_write_file() returns the number of bytes written, and -1 if the +bytes written were generated without appropriate seed. + +RAND_file_name() returns a pointer to B on success, and NULL on +error. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RAND_load_file(), RAND_write_file() and RAND_file_name() are available in +all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_set_rand_method.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_set_rand_method.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e5b780fad --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RAND_set_rand_method.pod @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RAND_set_rand_method, RAND_get_rand_method, RAND_SSLeay - select RAND method + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void RAND_set_rand_method(const RAND_METHOD *meth); + + const RAND_METHOD *RAND_get_rand_method(void); + + RAND_METHOD *RAND_SSLeay(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A B specifies the functions that OpenSSL uses for random number +generation. By modifying the method, alternative implementations such as +hardware RNGs may be used. IMPORTANT: See the NOTES section for important +information about how these RAND API functions are affected by the use of +B API calls. + +Initially, the default RAND_METHOD is the OpenSSL internal implementation, as +returned by RAND_SSLeay(). + +RAND_set_default_method() makes B the method for PRNG use. B: This is +true only whilst no ENGINE has been set as a default for RAND, so this function +is no longer recommended. + +RAND_get_default_method() returns a pointer to the current RAND_METHOD. +However, the meaningfulness of this result is dependent on whether the ENGINE +API is being used, so this function is no longer recommended. + +=head1 THE RAND_METHOD STRUCTURE + + typedef struct rand_meth_st + { + void (*seed)(const void *buf, int num); + int (*bytes)(unsigned char *buf, int num); + void (*cleanup)(void); + void (*add)(const void *buf, int num, int entropy); + int (*pseudorand)(unsigned char *buf, int num); + int (*status)(void); + } RAND_METHOD; + +The components point to the implementation of RAND_seed(), +RAND_bytes(), RAND_cleanup(), RAND_add(), RAND_pseudo_rand() +and RAND_status(). +Each component may be NULL if the function is not implemented. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RAND_set_rand_method() returns no value. RAND_get_rand_method() and +RAND_SSLeay() return pointers to the respective methods. + +=head1 NOTES + +As of version 0.9.7, RAND_METHOD implementations are grouped together with other +algorithmic APIs (eg. RSA_METHOD, EVP_CIPHER, etc) in B modules. If a +default ENGINE is specified for RAND functionality using an ENGINE API function, +that will override any RAND defaults set using the RAND API (ie. +RAND_set_rand_method()). For this reason, the ENGINE API is the recommended way +to control default implementations for use in RAND and other cryptographic +algorithms. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RAND_set_rand_method(), RAND_get_rand_method() and RAND_SSLeay() are +available in all versions of OpenSSL. + +In the engine version of version 0.9.6, RAND_set_rand_method() was altered to +take an ENGINE pointer as its argument. As of version 0.9.7, that has been +reverted as the ENGINE API transparently overrides RAND defaults if used, +otherwise RAND API functions work as before. RAND_set_rand_engine() was also +introduced in version 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_blinding_on.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_blinding_on.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..fd2c69abd --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_blinding_on.pod @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_blinding_on, RSA_blinding_off - protect the RSA operation from timing attacks + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_blinding_on(RSA *rsa, BN_CTX *ctx); + + void RSA_blinding_off(RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RSA is vulnerable to timing attacks. In a setup where attackers can +measure the time of RSA decryption or signature operations, blinding +must be used to protect the RSA operation from that attack. + +RSA_blinding_on() turns blinding on for key B and generates a +random blinding factor. B is B or a pre-allocated and +initialized B. The random number generator must be seeded +prior to calling RSA_blinding_on(). + +RSA_blinding_off() turns blinding off and frees the memory used for +the blinding factor. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RSA_blinding_on() returns 1 on success, and 0 if an error occurred. + +RSA_blinding_off() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_blinding_on() and RSA_blinding_off() appeared in SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_check_key.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_check_key.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..a5198f3db --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_check_key.pod @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_check_key - validate private RSA keys + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_check_key(RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This function validates RSA keys. It checks that B

and B are +in fact prime, and that B. + +It also checks that B, +and that B, B and B are set correctly or are B. + +As such, this function can not be used with any arbitrary RSA key object, +even if it is otherwise fit for regular RSA operation. See B for more +information. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +RSA_check_key() returns 1 if B is a valid RSA key, and 0 otherwise. +-1 is returned if an error occurs while checking the key. + +If the key is invalid or an error occurred, the reason code can be +obtained using L. + +=head1 NOTES + +This function does not work on RSA public keys that have only the modulus +and public exponent elements populated. It performs integrity checks on all +the RSA key material, so the RSA key structure must contain all the private +key data too. + +Unlike most other RSA functions, this function does B work +transparently with any underlying ENGINE implementation because it uses the +key data in the RSA structure directly. An ENGINE implementation can +override the way key data is stored and handled, and can even provide +support for HSM keys - in which case the RSA structure may contain B +key data at all! If the ENGINE in question is only being used for +acceleration or analysis purposes, then in all likelihood the RSA key data +is complete and untouched, but this can't be assumed in the general case. + +=head1 BUGS + +A method of verifying the RSA key using opaque RSA API functions might need +to be considered. Right now RSA_check_key() simply uses the RSA structure +elements directly, bypassing the RSA_METHOD table altogether (and +completely violating encapsulation and object-orientation in the process). +The best fix will probably be to introduce a "check_key()" handler to the +RSA_METHOD function table so that alternative implementations can also +provide their own verifiers. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_check_key() appeared in OpenSSL 0.9.4. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_generate_key.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_generate_key.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..52dbb14a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_generate_key.pod @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_generate_key - generate RSA key pair + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + RSA *RSA_generate_key(int num, unsigned long e, + void (*callback)(int,int,void *), void *cb_arg); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RSA_generate_key() generates a key pair and returns it in a newly +allocated B structure. The pseudo-random number generator must +be seeded prior to calling RSA_generate_key(). + +The modulus size will be B bits, and the public exponent will be +B. Key sizes with B E 1024 should be considered insecure. +The exponent is an odd number, typically 3, 17 or 65537. + +A callback function may be used to provide feedback about the +progress of the key generation. If B is not B, it +will be called as follows: + +=over 4 + +=item * + +While a random prime number is generated, it is called as +described in L. + +=item * + +When the n-th randomly generated prime is rejected as not +suitable for the key, B is called. + +=item * + +When a random p has been found with p-1 relatively prime to B, +it is called as B. + +=back + +The process is then repeated for prime q with B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +If key generation fails, RSA_generate_key() returns B; the +error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 BUGS + +B is used with two different meanings. + +RSA_generate_key() goes into an infinite loop for illegal input values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The B argument was added in SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_get_ex_new_index.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_get_ex_new_index.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7d0fd1f91 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_get_ex_new_index.pod @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_get_ex_new_index, RSA_set_ex_data, RSA_get_ex_data - add application specific data to RSA structures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_get_ex_new_index(long argl, void *argp, + CRYPTO_EX_new *new_func, + CRYPTO_EX_dup *dup_func, + CRYPTO_EX_free *free_func); + + int RSA_set_ex_data(RSA *r, int idx, void *arg); + + void *RSA_get_ex_data(RSA *r, int idx); + + typedef int CRYPTO_EX_new(void *parent, void *ptr, CRYPTO_EX_DATA *ad, + int idx, long argl, void *argp); + typedef void CRYPTO_EX_free(void *parent, void *ptr, CRYPTO_EX_DATA *ad, + int idx, long argl, void *argp); + typedef int CRYPTO_EX_dup(CRYPTO_EX_DATA *to, CRYPTO_EX_DATA *from, void *from_d, + int idx, long argl, void *argp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +Several OpenSSL structures can have application specific data attached to them. +This has several potential uses, it can be used to cache data associated with +a structure (for example the hash of some part of the structure) or some +additional data (for example a handle to the data in an external library). + +Since the application data can be anything at all it is passed and retrieved +as a B type. + +The B function is initially called to "register" some +new application specific data. It takes three optional function pointers which +are called when the parent structure (in this case an RSA structure) is +initially created, when it is copied and when it is freed up. If any or all of +these function pointer arguments are not used they should be set to NULL. The +precise manner in which these function pointers are called is described in more +detail below. B also takes additional long and pointer +parameters which will be passed to the supplied functions but which otherwise +have no special meaning. It returns an B which should be stored +(typically in a static variable) and passed used in the B parameter in +the remaining functions. Each successful call to B +will return an index greater than any previously returned, this is important +because the optional functions are called in order of increasing index value. + +B is used to set application specific data, the data is +supplied in the B parameter and its precise meaning is up to the +application. + +B is used to retrieve application specific data. The data +is returned to the application, this will be the same value as supplied to +a previous B call. + +B is called when a structure is initially allocated (for example +with B. The parent structure members will not have any meaningful +values at this point. This function will typically be used to allocate any +application specific structure. + +B is called when a structure is being freed up. The dynamic parent +structure members should not be accessed because they will be freed up when +this function is called. + +B and B take the same parameters. B is a +pointer to the parent RSA structure. B is a the application specific data +(this wont be of much use in B. B is a pointer to the +B structure from the parent RSA structure: the functions +B and B can be called to manipulate +it. The B parameter is the index: this will be the same value returned by +B when the functions were initially registered. Finally +the B and B parameters are the values originally passed to the same +corresponding parameters when B was called. + +B is called when a structure is being copied. Pointers to the +destination and source B structures are passed in the B and +B parameters respectively. The B parameter is passed a pointer to +the source application data when the function is called, when the function returns +the value is copied to the destination: the application can thus modify the data +pointed to by B and have different values in the source and destination. +The B, B and B parameters are the same as those in B +and B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +B returns a new index or -1 on failure (note 0 is a valid +index value). + +B returns 1 on success or 0 on failure. + +B returns the application data or 0 on failure. 0 may also +be valid application data but currently it can only fail if given an invalid B +parameter. + +B and B should return 0 for failure and 1 for success. + +On failure an error code can be obtained from L. + +=head1 BUGS + +B is currently never called. + +The return value of B is ignored. + +The B function isn't very useful because no meaningful values are +present in the parent RSA structure when it is called. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_get_ex_new_index(), RSA_set_ex_data() and RSA_get_ex_data() are +available since SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3d15b9282 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_new, RSA_free - allocate and free RSA objects + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + RSA * RSA_new(void); + + void RSA_free(RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RSA_new() allocates and initializes an B structure. It is equivalent to +calling RSA_new_method(NULL). + +RSA_free() frees the B structure and its components. The key is +erased before the memory is returned to the system. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +If the allocation fails, RSA_new() returns B and sets an error +code that can be obtained by L. Otherwise it returns +a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +RSA_free() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_new() and RSA_free() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b8f678fe7 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1.pod @@ -0,0 +1,124 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1, RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_type_1, +RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_2, RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_type_2, +RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_OAEP, RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_OAEP, +RSA_padding_add_SSLv23, RSA_padding_check_SSLv23, +RSA_padding_add_none, RSA_padding_check_none - asymmetric encryption +padding + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl); + + int RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_type_1(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl, int rsa_len); + + int RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_2(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl); + + int RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_type_2(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl, int rsa_len); + + int RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_OAEP(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl, unsigned char *p, int pl); + + int RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_OAEP(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl, int rsa_len, unsigned char *p, int pl); + + int RSA_padding_add_SSLv23(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl); + + int RSA_padding_check_SSLv23(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl, int rsa_len); + + int RSA_padding_add_none(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl); + + int RSA_padding_check_none(unsigned char *to, int tlen, + unsigned char *f, int fl, int rsa_len); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The RSA_padding_xxx_xxx() functions are called from the RSA encrypt, +decrypt, sign and verify functions. Normally they should not be called +from application programs. + +However, they can also be called directly to implement padding for other +asymmetric ciphers. RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_OAEP() and +RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_OAEP() may be used in an application combined +with B in order to implement OAEP with an encoding +parameter. + +RSA_padding_add_xxx() encodes B bytes from B so as to fit into +B bytes and stores the result at B. An error occurs if B +does not meet the size requirements of the encoding method. + +The following encoding methods are implemented: + +=over 4 + +=item PKCS1_type_1 + +PKCS #1 v2.0 EMSA-PKCS1-v1_5 (PKCS #1 v1.5 block type 1); used for signatures + +=item PKCS1_type_2 + +PKCS #1 v2.0 EME-PKCS1-v1_5 (PKCS #1 v1.5 block type 2) + +=item PKCS1_OAEP + +PKCS #1 v2.0 EME-OAEP + +=item SSLv23 + +PKCS #1 EME-PKCS1-v1_5 with SSL-specific modification + +=item none + +simply copy the data + +=back + +The random number generator must be seeded prior to calling +RSA_padding_add_xxx(). + +RSA_padding_check_xxx() verifies that the B bytes at B contain +a valid encoding for a B byte RSA key in the respective +encoding method and stores the recovered data of at most B bytes +(for B: of size B) +at B. + +For RSA_padding_xxx_OAEP(), B

points to the encoding parameter +of length B. B

may be B if B is 0. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +The RSA_padding_add_xxx() functions return 1 on success, 0 on error. +The RSA_padding_check_xxx() functions return the length of the +recovered data, -1 on error. Error codes can be obtained by calling +L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_1(), RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_type_1(), +RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_type_2(), RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_type_2(), +RSA_padding_add_SSLv23(), RSA_padding_check_SSLv23(), +RSA_padding_add_none() and RSA_padding_check_none() appeared in +SSLeay 0.9.0. + +RSA_padding_add_PKCS1_OAEP() and RSA_padding_check_PKCS1_OAEP() were +added in OpenSSL 0.9.2b. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_print.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_print.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..c971e91f4 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_print.pod @@ -0,0 +1,49 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_print, RSA_print_fp, +DSAparams_print, DSAparams_print_fp, DSA_print, DSA_print_fp, +DHparams_print, DHparams_print_fp - print cryptographic parameters + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_print(BIO *bp, RSA *x, int offset); + int RSA_print_fp(FILE *fp, RSA *x, int offset); + + #include + + int DSAparams_print(BIO *bp, DSA *x); + int DSAparams_print_fp(FILE *fp, DSA *x); + int DSA_print(BIO *bp, DSA *x, int offset); + int DSA_print_fp(FILE *fp, DSA *x, int offset); + + #include + + int DHparams_print(BIO *bp, DH *x); + int DHparams_print_fp(FILE *fp, DH *x); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A human-readable hexadecimal output of the components of the RSA +key, DSA parameters or key or DH parameters is printed to B or B. + +The output lines are indented by B spaces. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +These functions return 1 on success, 0 on error. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_print(), RSA_print_fp(), DSA_print(), DSA_print_fp(), DH_print(), +DH_print_fp() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +DSAparams_print() and DSAparams_print_fp() were added in SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_private_encrypt.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_private_encrypt.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..746a80c79 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_private_encrypt.pod @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_private_encrypt, RSA_public_decrypt - low level signature operations + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_private_encrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + + int RSA_public_decrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions handle RSA signatures at a low level. + +RSA_private_encrypt() signs the B bytes at B (usually a +message digest with an algorithm identifier) using the private key +B and stores the signature in B. B must point to +B bytes of memory. + +B denotes one of the following modes: + +=over 4 + +=item RSA_PKCS1_PADDING + +PKCS #1 v1.5 padding. This function does not handle the +B specified in PKCS #1. When generating or +verifying PKCS #1 signatures, L and L should be +used. + +=item RSA_NO_PADDING + +Raw RSA signature. This mode should I be used to implement +cryptographically sound padding modes in the application code. +Signing user data directly with RSA is insecure. + +=back + +RSA_public_decrypt() recovers the message digest from the B +bytes long signature at B using the signer's public key +B. B must point to a memory section large enough to hold the +message digest (which is smaller than B). B is the padding mode that was used to sign the data. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RSA_private_encrypt() returns the size of the signature (i.e., +RSA_size(rsa)). RSA_public_decrypt() returns the size of the +recovered message digest. + +On error, -1 is returned; the error codes can be +obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The B argument was added in SSLeay 0.8. RSA_NO_PADDING is +available since SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_public_encrypt.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_public_encrypt.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ab0fe3b2c --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_public_encrypt.pod @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_public_encrypt, RSA_private_decrypt - RSA public key cryptography + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_public_encrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + + int RSA_private_decrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RSA_public_encrypt() encrypts the B bytes at B (usually a +session key) using the public key B and stores the ciphertext in +B. B must point to RSA_size(B) bytes of memory. + +B denotes one of the following modes: + +=over 4 + +=item RSA_PKCS1_PADDING + +PKCS #1 v1.5 padding. This currently is the most widely used mode. + +=item RSA_PKCS1_OAEP_PADDING + +EME-OAEP as defined in PKCS #1 v2.0 with SHA-1, MGF1 and an empty +encoding parameter. This mode is recommended for all new applications. + +=item RSA_SSLV23_PADDING + +PKCS #1 v1.5 padding with an SSL-specific modification that denotes +that the server is SSL3 capable. + +=item RSA_NO_PADDING + +Raw RSA encryption. This mode should I be used to implement +cryptographically sound padding modes in the application code. +Encrypting user data directly with RSA is insecure. + +=back + +B must be less than RSA_size(B) - 11 for the PKCS #1 v1.5 +based padding modes, less than RSA_size(B) - 41 for +RSA_PKCS1_OAEP_PADDING and exactly RSA_size(B) for RSA_NO_PADDING. +The random number generator must be seeded prior to calling +RSA_public_encrypt(). + +RSA_private_decrypt() decrypts the B bytes at B using the +private key B and stores the plaintext in B. B must point +to a memory section large enough to hold the decrypted data (which is +smaller than RSA_size(B)). B is the padding mode that +was used to encrypt the data. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RSA_public_encrypt() returns the size of the encrypted data (i.e., +RSA_size(B)). RSA_private_decrypt() returns the size of the +recovered plaintext. + +On error, -1 is returned; the error codes can be +obtained by L. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +SSL, PKCS #1 v2.0 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The B argument was added in SSLeay 0.8. RSA_NO_PADDING is +available since SSLeay 0.9.0, OAEP was added in OpenSSL 0.9.2b. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_set_method.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_set_method.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2c963d7e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_set_method.pod @@ -0,0 +1,202 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_set_default_method, RSA_get_default_method, RSA_set_method, +RSA_get_method, RSA_PKCS1_SSLeay, RSA_null_method, RSA_flags, +RSA_new_method - select RSA method + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void RSA_set_default_method(const RSA_METHOD *meth); + + RSA_METHOD *RSA_get_default_method(void); + + int RSA_set_method(RSA *rsa, const RSA_METHOD *meth); + + RSA_METHOD *RSA_get_method(const RSA *rsa); + + RSA_METHOD *RSA_PKCS1_SSLeay(void); + + RSA_METHOD *RSA_null_method(void); + + int RSA_flags(const RSA *rsa); + + RSA *RSA_new_method(RSA_METHOD *method); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +An B specifies the functions that OpenSSL uses for RSA +operations. By modifying the method, alternative implementations such as +hardware accelerators may be used. IMPORTANT: See the NOTES section for +important information about how these RSA API functions are affected by the +use of B API calls. + +Initially, the default RSA_METHOD is the OpenSSL internal implementation, +as returned by RSA_PKCS1_SSLeay(). + +RSA_set_default_method() makes B the default method for all RSA +structures created later. B: This is true only whilst no ENGINE has +been set as a default for RSA, so this function is no longer recommended. + +RSA_get_default_method() returns a pointer to the current default +RSA_METHOD. However, the meaningfulness of this result is dependent on +whether the ENGINE API is being used, so this function is no longer +recommended. + +RSA_set_method() selects B to perform all operations using the key +B. This will replace the RSA_METHOD used by the RSA key and if the +previous method was supplied by an ENGINE, the handle to that ENGINE will +be released during the change. It is possible to have RSA keys that only +work with certain RSA_METHOD implementations (eg. from an ENGINE module +that supports embedded hardware-protected keys), and in such cases +attempting to change the RSA_METHOD for the key can have unexpected +results. + +RSA_get_method() returns a pointer to the RSA_METHOD being used by B. +This method may or may not be supplied by an ENGINE implementation, but if +it is, the return value can only be guaranteed to be valid as long as the +RSA key itself is valid and does not have its implementation changed by +RSA_set_method(). + +RSA_flags() returns the B that are set for B's current +RSA_METHOD. See the BUGS section. + +RSA_new_method() allocates and initializes an RSA structure so that +B will be used for the RSA operations. If B is NULL, the +default ENGINE for RSA operations is used, and if no default ENGINE is set, +the RSA_METHOD controlled by RSA_set_default_method() is used. + +RSA_flags() returns the B that are set for B's current method. + +RSA_new_method() allocates and initializes an B structure so that +B will be used for the RSA operations. If B is B, +the default method is used. + +=head1 THE RSA_METHOD STRUCTURE + + typedef struct rsa_meth_st + { + /* name of the implementation */ + const char *name; + + /* encrypt */ + int (*rsa_pub_enc)(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + + /* verify arbitrary data */ + int (*rsa_pub_dec)(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + + /* sign arbitrary data */ + int (*rsa_priv_enc)(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + + /* decrypt */ + int (*rsa_priv_dec)(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + + /* compute r0 = r0 ^ I mod rsa->n (May be NULL for some + implementations) */ + int (*rsa_mod_exp)(BIGNUM *r0, BIGNUM *I, RSA *rsa); + + /* compute r = a ^ p mod m (May be NULL for some implementations) */ + int (*bn_mod_exp)(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *p, + const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx, BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx); + + /* called at RSA_new */ + int (*init)(RSA *rsa); + + /* called at RSA_free */ + int (*finish)(RSA *rsa); + + /* RSA_FLAG_EXT_PKEY - rsa_mod_exp is called for private key + * operations, even if p,q,dmp1,dmq1,iqmp + * are NULL + * RSA_FLAG_SIGN_VER - enable rsa_sign and rsa_verify + * RSA_METHOD_FLAG_NO_CHECK - don't check pub/private match + */ + int flags; + + char *app_data; /* ?? */ + + /* sign. For backward compatibility, this is used only + * if (flags & RSA_FLAG_SIGN_VER) + */ + int (*rsa_sign)(int type, unsigned char *m, unsigned int m_len, + unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, RSA *rsa); + + /* verify. For backward compatibility, this is used only + * if (flags & RSA_FLAG_SIGN_VER) + */ + int (*rsa_verify)(int type, unsigned char *m, unsigned int m_len, + unsigned char *sigbuf, unsigned int siglen, RSA *rsa); + + } RSA_METHOD; + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RSA_PKCS1_SSLeay(), RSA_PKCS1_null_method(), RSA_get_default_method() +and RSA_get_method() return pointers to the respective RSA_METHODs. + +RSA_set_default_method() returns no value. + +RSA_set_method() returns a pointer to the old RSA_METHOD implementation +that was replaced. However, this return value should probably be ignored +because if it was supplied by an ENGINE, the pointer could be invalidated +at any time if the ENGINE is unloaded (in fact it could be unloaded as a +result of the RSA_set_method() function releasing its handle to the +ENGINE). For this reason, the return type may be replaced with a B +declaration in a future release. + +RSA_new_method() returns NULL and sets an error code that can be obtained +by L if the allocation fails. Otherwise +it returns a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +=head1 NOTES + +As of version 0.9.7, RSA_METHOD implementations are grouped together with +other algorithmic APIs (eg. DSA_METHOD, EVP_CIPHER, etc) into B +modules. If a default ENGINE is specified for RSA functionality using an +ENGINE API function, that will override any RSA defaults set using the RSA +API (ie. RSA_set_default_method()). For this reason, the ENGINE API is the +recommended way to control default implementations for use in RSA and other +cryptographic algorithms. + +=head1 BUGS + +The behaviour of RSA_flags() is a mis-feature that is left as-is for now +to avoid creating compatibility problems. RSA functionality, such as the +encryption functions, are controlled by the B value in the RSA key +itself, not by the B value in the RSA_METHOD attached to the RSA key +(which is what this function returns). If the flags element of an RSA key +is changed, the changes will be honoured by RSA functionality but will not +be reflected in the return value of the RSA_flags() function - in effect +RSA_flags() behaves more like an RSA_default_flags() function (which does +not currently exist). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_new_method() and RSA_set_default_method() appeared in SSLeay 0.8. +RSA_get_default_method(), RSA_set_method() and RSA_get_method() as +well as the rsa_sign and rsa_verify components of RSA_METHOD were +added in OpenSSL 0.9.4. + +RSA_set_default_openssl_method() and RSA_get_default_openssl_method() +replaced RSA_set_default_method() and RSA_get_default_method() +respectively, and RSA_set_method() and RSA_new_method() were altered to use +Bs rather than Bs during development of the engine +version of OpenSSL 0.9.6. For 0.9.7, the handling of defaults in the ENGINE +API was restructured so that this change was reversed, and behaviour of the +other functions resembled more closely the previous behaviour. The +behaviour of defaults in the ENGINE API now transparently overrides the +behaviour of defaults in the RSA API without requiring changing these +function prototypes. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..8553be8e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign.pod @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_sign, RSA_verify - RSA signatures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_sign(int type, const unsigned char *m, unsigned int m_len, + unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, RSA *rsa); + + int RSA_verify(int type, const unsigned char *m, unsigned int m_len, + unsigned char *sigbuf, unsigned int siglen, RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RSA_sign() signs the message digest B of size B using the +private key B as specified in PKCS #1 v2.0. It stores the +signature in B and the signature size in B. B +must point to RSA_size(B) bytes of memory. + +B denotes the message digest algorithm that was used to generate +B. It usually is one of B, B and B; +see L for details. If B is B, +an SSL signature (MD5 and SHA1 message digests with PKCS #1 padding +and no algorithm identifier) is created. + +RSA_verify() verifies that the signature B of size B +matches a given message digest B of size B. B denotes +the message digest algorithm that was used to generate the signature. +B is the signer's public key. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RSA_sign() returns 1 on success, 0 otherwise. RSA_verify() returns 1 +on successful verification, 0 otherwise. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 BUGS + +Certain signatures with an improper algorithm identifier are accepted +for compatibility with SSLeay 0.4.5 :-) + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +SSL, PKCS #1 v2.0 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_sign() and RSA_verify() are available in all versions of SSLeay +and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e70380bbf --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING.pod @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING, RSA_verify_ASN1_OCTET_STRING - RSA signatures + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING(int dummy, unsigned char *m, + unsigned int m_len, unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, + RSA *rsa); + + int RSA_verify_ASN1_OCTET_STRING(int dummy, unsigned char *m, + unsigned int m_len, unsigned char *sigbuf, unsigned int siglen, + RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING() signs the octet string B of size +B using the private key B represented in DER using PKCS #1 +padding. It stores the signature in B and the signature size +in B. B must point to B bytes of +memory. + +B is ignored. + +The random number generator must be seeded prior to calling RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING(). + +RSA_verify_ASN1_OCTET_STRING() verifies that the signature B +of size B is the DER representation of a given octet string +B of size B. B is ignored. B is the signer's +public key. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING() returns 1 on success, 0 otherwise. +RSA_verify_ASN1_OCTET_STRING() returns 1 on successful verification, 0 +otherwise. + +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 BUGS + +These functions serve no recognizable purpose. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING() and RSA_verify_ASN1_OCTET_STRING() were +added in SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_size.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_size.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..5b7f835f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/RSA_size.pod @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RSA_size - get RSA modulus size + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RSA_size(const RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This function returns the RSA modulus size in bytes. It can be used to +determine how much memory must be allocated for an RSA encrypted +value. + +Bn> must not be B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUE + +The size in bytes. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RSA_size() is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_read_PKCS7.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_read_PKCS7.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ffafa3788 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_read_PKCS7.pod @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +SMIME_read_PKCS7 - parse S/MIME message. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +PKCS7 *SMIME_read_PKCS7(BIO *in, BIO **bcont); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +SMIME_read_PKCS7() parses a message in S/MIME format. + +B is a BIO to read the message from. + +If cleartext signing is used then the content is saved in +a memory bio which is written to B<*bcont>, otherwise +B<*bcont> is set to B. + +The parsed PKCS#7 structure is returned or B if an +error occurred. + +=head1 NOTES + +If B<*bcont> is not B then the message is clear text +signed. B<*bcont> can then be passed to PKCS7_verify() with +the B flag set. + +Otherwise the type of the returned structure can be determined +using PKCS7_type(). + +To support future functionality if B is not B +B<*bcont> should be initialized to B. For example: + + BIO *cont = NULL; + PKCS7 *p7; + + p7 = SMIME_read_PKCS7(in, &cont); + +=head1 BUGS + +The MIME parser used by SMIME_read_PKCS7() is somewhat primitive. +While it will handle most S/MIME messages more complex compound +formats may not work. + +The parser assumes that the PKCS7 structure is always base64 +encoded and will not handle the case where it is in binary format +or uses quoted printable format. + +The use of a memory BIO to hold the signed content limits the size +of message which can be processed due to memory restraints: a +streaming single pass option should be available. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +SMIME_read_PKCS7() returns a valid B structure or B +is an error occurred. The error can be obtained from ERR_get_error(3). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L +L, L, +L, L +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +SMIME_read_PKCS7() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.5 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_write_PKCS7.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_write_PKCS7.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..61945b388 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/SMIME_write_PKCS7.pod @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +SMIME_write_PKCS7 - convert PKCS#7 structure to S/MIME format. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +int SMIME_write_PKCS7(BIO *out, PKCS7 *p7, BIO *data, int flags); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +SMIME_write_PKCS7() adds the appropriate MIME headers to a PKCS#7 +structure to produce an S/MIME message. + +B is the BIO to write the data to. B is the appropriate +B structure. If cleartext signing (B) is +being used then the signed data must be supplied in the B +argument. B is an optional set of flags. + +=head1 NOTES + +The following flags can be passed in the B parameter. + +If B is set then cleartext signing will be used, +this option only makes sense for signedData where B +is also set when PKCS7_sign() is also called. + +If the B flag is set MIME headers for type B +are added to the content, this only makes sense if B +is also set. + +If the B flag is set the signed data is finalized +and output along with the content. This flag should only be set +if B is also set and the previous call to PKCS7_sign() +also set these flags. + +If cleartext signing is being used and B not set then +the data must be read twice: once to compute the signature in PKCS7_sign() +and once to output the S/MIME message. + +=head1 BUGS + +SMIME_write_PKCS7() always base64 encodes PKCS#7 structures, there +should be an option to disable this. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +SMIME_write_PKCS7() returns 1 for success or 0 for failure. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +SMIME_write_PKCS7() was added to OpenSSL 0.9.5 + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..11b35f6fd --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object.pod @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object, X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_data, +X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_object, X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_data, +X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_txt, X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_NID, +X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_OBJ - X509_NAME_ENTRY utility functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +ASN1_OBJECT * X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object(X509_NAME_ENTRY *ne); +ASN1_STRING * X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_data(X509_NAME_ENTRY *ne); + +int X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_object(X509_NAME_ENTRY *ne, ASN1_OBJECT *obj); +int X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_data(X509_NAME_ENTRY *ne, int type, const unsigned char *bytes, int len); + +X509_NAME_ENTRY *X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_txt(X509_NAME_ENTRY **ne, const char *field, int type, const unsigned char *bytes, int len); +X509_NAME_ENTRY *X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_NID(X509_NAME_ENTRY **ne, int nid, int type,unsigned char *bytes, int len); +X509_NAME_ENTRY *X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_OBJ(X509_NAME_ENTRY **ne, ASN1_OBJECT *obj, int type, const unsigned char *bytes, int len); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object() retrieves the field name of B in +and B structure. + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_data() retrieves the field value of B in +and B structure. + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_object() sets the field name of B to B. + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_data() sets the field value of B to string type +B and value determined by B and B. + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_txt(), X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_NID() +and X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_OBJ() create and return an +B structure. + +=head1 NOTES + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_object() and X509_NAME_ENTRY_get_data() can be +used to examine an B function as returned by +X509_NAME_get_entry() for example. + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_txt(), X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_NID(), +and X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_OBJ() create and return an + +X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_txt(), X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_OBJ(), +X509_NAME_ENTRY_create_by_NID() and X509_NAME_ENTRY_set_data() +are seldom used in practice because B structures +are almost always part of B structures and the +corresponding B functions are typically used to +create and add new entries in a single operation. + +The arguments of these functions support similar options to the similarly +named ones of the corresponding B functions such as +X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(). So for example B can be set to +B but in the case of X509_set_data() the field name must be +set first so the relevant field information can be looked up internally. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e2ab4b0d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt.pod @@ -0,0 +1,114 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt, X509_NAME_add_entry_by_OBJ, X509_NAME_add_entry_by_NID, +X509_NAME_add_entry, X509_NAME_delete_entry - X509_NAME modification functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +int X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(X509_NAME *name, const char *field, int type, const unsigned char *bytes, int len, int loc, int set); + +int X509_NAME_add_entry_by_OBJ(X509_NAME *name, ASN1_OBJECT *obj, int type, unsigned char *bytes, int len, int loc, int set); + +int X509_NAME_add_entry_by_NID(X509_NAME *name, int nid, int type, unsigned char *bytes, int len, int loc, int set); + +int X509_NAME_add_entry(X509_NAME *name,X509_NAME_ENTRY *ne, int loc, int set); + +X509_NAME_ENTRY *X509_NAME_delete_entry(X509_NAME *name, int loc); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(), X509_NAME_add_entry_by_OBJ() and +X509_NAME_add_entry_by_NID() add a field whose name is defined +by a string B, an object B or a NID B respectively. +The field value to be added is in B of length B. If +B is -1 then the field length is calculated internally using +strlen(bytes). + +The type of field is determined by B which can either be a +definition of the type of B (such as B) or a +standard ASN1 type (such as B). The new entry is +added to a position determined by B and B. + +X509_NAME_add_entry() adds a copy of B structure B +to B. The new entry is added to a position determined by B +and B. Since a copy of B is added B must be freed up after +the call. + +X509_NAME_delete_entry() deletes an entry from B at position +B. The deleted entry is returned and must be freed up. + +=head1 NOTES + +The use of string types such as B or B +is strongly recommened for the B parameter. This allows the +internal code to correctly determine the type of the field and to +apply length checks according to the relevant standards. This is +done using ASN1_STRING_set_by_NID(). + +If instead an ASN1 type is used no checks are performed and the +supplied data in B is used directly. + +In X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt() the B string represents +the field name using OBJ_txt2obj(field, 0). + +The B and B parameters determine where a new entry should +be added. For almost all applications B can be set to -1 and B +to 0. This adds a new entry to the end of B as a single valued +RelativeDistinguishedName (RDN). + +B actually determines the index where the new entry is inserted: +if it is -1 it is appended. + +B determines how the new type is added. If it is zero a +new RDN is created. + +If B is -1 or 1 it is added to the previous or next RDN +structure respectively. This will then be a multivalued RDN: +since multivalues RDNs are very seldom used B is almost +always set to zero. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Create an B structure: + +"C=UK, O=Disorganized Organization, CN=Joe Bloggs" + + X509_NAME *nm; + nm = X509_NAME_new(); + if (nm == NULL) + /* Some error */ + if (!X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(nm, MBSTRING_ASC, + "C", "UK", -1, -1, 0)) + /* Error */ + if (!X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(nm, MBSTRING_ASC, + "O", "Disorganized Organization", -1, -1, 0)) + /* Error */ + if (!X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(nm, MBSTRING_ASC, + "CN", "Joe Bloggs", -1, -1, 0)) + /* Error */ + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +X509_NAME_add_entry_by_txt(), X509_NAME_add_entry_by_OBJ(), +X509_NAME_add_entry_by_NID() and X509_NAME_add_entry() return 1 for +success of 0 if an error occurred. + +X509_NAME_delete_entry() returns either the deleted B +structure of B if an error occurred. + +=head1 BUGS + +B can still be set to B to use a +different algorithm to determine field types. Since this form does +not understand multicharacter types, performs no length checks and +can result in invalid field types its use is strongly discouraged. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..333323d73 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID.pod @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID, X509_NAME_get_index_by_OBJ, X509_NAME_get_entry, +X509_NAME_entry_count, X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID, X509_NAME_get_text_by_OBJ - +X509_NAME lookup and enumeration functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +int X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID(X509_NAME *name,int nid,int lastpos); +int X509_NAME_get_index_by_OBJ(X509_NAME *name,ASN1_OBJECT *obj, int lastpos); + +int X509_NAME_entry_count(X509_NAME *name); +X509_NAME_ENTRY *X509_NAME_get_entry(X509_NAME *name, int loc); + +int X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID(X509_NAME *name, int nid, char *buf,int len); +int X509_NAME_get_text_by_OBJ(X509_NAME *name, ASN1_OBJECT *obj, char *buf,int len); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions allow an B structure to be examined. The +B structure is the same as the B type defined in +RFC2459 (and elsewhere) and used for example in certificate subject +and issuer names. + +X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID() and X509_NAME_get_index_by_OBJ() retrieve +the next index matching B or B after B. B +should initially be set to -1. If there are no more entries -1 is returned. + +X509_NAME_entry_count() returns the total number of entries in B. + +X509_NAME_get_entry() retrieves the B from B +corresponding to index B. Acceptable values for B run from +0 to (X509_NAME_entry_count(name) - 1). The value returned is an +internal pointer which must not be freed. + +X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID(), X509_NAME_get_text_by_OBJ() retrieve +the "text" from the first entry in B which matches B or +B, if no such entry exists -1 is returned. At most B bytes +will be written and the text written to B will be null +terminated. The length of the output string written is returned +excluding the terminating null. If B is then the amount +of space needed in B (excluding the final null) is returned. + +=head1 NOTES + +X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID() and X509_NAME_get_text_by_OBJ() are +legacy functions which have various limitations which make them +of minimal use in practice. They can only find the first matching +entry and will copy the contents of the field verbatim: this can +be highly confusing if the target is a muticharacter string type +like a BMPString or a UTF8String. + +For a more general solution X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID() or +X509_NAME_get_index_by_OBJ() should be used followed by +X509_NAME_get_entry() on any matching indices and then the +various B utility functions on the result. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Process all entries: + + int i; + X509_NAME_ENTRY *e; + + for (i = 0; i < X509_NAME_entry_count(nm); i++) + { + e = X509_NAME_get_entry(nm, i); + /* Do something with e */ + } + +Process all commonName entries: + + int loc; + X509_NAME_ENTRY *e; + + loc = -1; + for (;;) + { + lastpos = X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID(nm, NID_commonName, lastpos); + if (lastpos == -1) + break; + e = X509_NAME_get_entry(nm, lastpos); + /* Do something with e */ + } + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +X509_NAME_get_index_by_NID() and X509_NAME_get_index_by_OBJ() +return the index of the next matching entry or -1 if not found. + +X509_NAME_entry_count() returns the total number of entries. + +X509_NAME_get_entry() returns an B pointer to the +requested entry or B if the index is invalid. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_print_ex.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_print_ex.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..2579a5dc9 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_NAME_print_ex.pod @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +X509_NAME_print_ex, X509_NAME_print_ex_fp, X509_NAME_print, +X509_NAME_oneline - X509_NAME printing routines. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int X509_NAME_print_ex(BIO *out, X509_NAME *nm, int indent, unsigned long flags); + int X509_NAME_print_ex_fp(FILE *fp, X509_NAME *nm, int indent, unsigned long flags); + char * X509_NAME_oneline(X509_NAME *a,char *buf,int size); + int X509_NAME_print(BIO *bp, X509_NAME *name, int obase); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +X509_NAME_print_ex() prints a human readable version of B to BIO B. Each +line (for multiline formats) is indented by B spaces. The output format +can be extensively customised by use of the B parameter. + +X509_NAME_print_ex_fp() is identical to X509_NAME_print_ex() except the output is +written to FILE pointer B. + +X509_NAME_oneline() prints an ASCII version of B to B. At most B +bytes will be written. If B is B then a buffer is dynamically allocated +and returned, otherwise B is returned. + +X509_NAME_print() prints out B to B indenting each line by B +characters. Multiple lines are used if the output (including indent) exceeds +80 characters. + +=head1 NOTES + +The functions X509_NAME_oneline() and X509_NAME_print() are legacy functions which +produce a non standard output form, they don't handle multi character fields and +have various quirks and inconsistencies. Their use is strongly discouraged in new +applications. + +Although there are a large number of possible flags for most purposes +B, B or B will suffice. +As noted on the L manual page +for UTF8 terminals the B should be unset: so for example +B would be used. + +The complete set of the flags supported by X509_NAME_print_ex() is listed below. + +Several options can be ored together. + +The options B, B, +B and B determine the field separators +to use. Two distinct separators are used between distinct RelativeDistinguishedName +components and separate values in the same RDN for a multi-valued RDN. Multi-valued +RDNs are currently very rare so the second separator will hardly ever be used. + +B uses comma and plus as separators. B +uses comma and plus with spaces: this is more readable that plain comma and plus. +B uses spaced semicolon and plus. B uses +spaced newline and plus respectively. + +If B is set the whole DN is printed in reversed order. + +The fields B, B, B, +B determine how a field name is displayed. It will +use the short name (e.g. CN) the long name (e.g. commonName) always +use OID numerical form (normally OIDs are only used if the field name is not +recognised) and no field name respectively. + +If B is set then spaces will be placed around the '=' character +separating field names and values. + +If B is set then the encoding of unknown fields is +printed instead of the values. + +If B is set then field names are padded to 20 characters: this +is only of use for multiline format. + +Additionally all the options supported by ASN1_STRING_print_ex() can be used to +control how each field value is displayed. + +In addition a number options can be set for commonly used formats. + +B sets options which produce an output compatible with RFC2253 it +is equivalent to: + B + + +B is a more readable one line format which is the same as: + B + +B is a multiline format which is the same as: + B + +B uses a format identical to X509_NAME_print(): in fact it calls X509_NAME_print() internally. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_new.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_new.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..fd5fc65ce --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/X509_new.pod @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +X509_new, X509_free - X509 certificate ASN1 allocation functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + X509 *X509_new(void); + void X509_free(X509 *a); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The X509 ASN1 allocation routines, allocate and free an +X509 structure, which represents an X509 certificate. + +X509_new() allocates and initializes a X509 structure. + +X509_free() frees up the B structure B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +If the allocation fails, X509_new() returns B and sets an error +code that can be obtained by L. +Otherwise it returns a pointer to the newly allocated structure. + +X509_free() returns no value. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +X509_new() and X509_free() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/bio.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/bio.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..f9239226f --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/bio.pod @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +bio - I/O abstraction + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + +TBA + + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A BIO is an I/O abstraction, it hides many of the underlying I/O +details from an application. If an application uses a BIO for its +I/O it can transparently handle SSL connections, unencrypted network +connections and file I/O. + +There are two type of BIO, a source/sink BIO and a filter BIO. + +As its name implies a source/sink BIO is a source and/or sink of data, +examples include a socket BIO and a file BIO. + +A filter BIO takes data from one BIO and passes it through to +another, or the application. The data may be left unmodified (for +example a message digest BIO) or translated (for example an +encryption BIO). The effect of a filter BIO may change according +to the I/O operation it is performing: for example an encryption +BIO will encrypt data if it is being written to and decrypt data +if it is being read from. + +BIOs can be joined together to form a chain (a single BIO is a chain +with one component). A chain normally consist of one source/sink +BIO and one or more filter BIOs. Data read from or written to the +first BIO then traverses the chain to the end (normally a source/sink +BIO). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, +L diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/blowfish.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/blowfish.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..5b2d274c1 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/blowfish.pod @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +blowfish, BF_set_key, BF_encrypt, BF_decrypt, BF_ecb_encrypt, BF_cbc_encrypt, +BF_cfb64_encrypt, BF_ofb64_encrypt, BF_options - Blowfish encryption + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void BF_set_key(BF_KEY *key, int len, const unsigned char *data); + + void BF_ecb_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + BF_KEY *key, int enc); + void BF_cbc_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, BF_KEY *schedule, unsigned char *ivec, int enc); + void BF_cfb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, BF_KEY *schedule, unsigned char *ivec, int *num, + int enc); + void BF_ofb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, BF_KEY *schedule, unsigned char *ivec, int *num); + const char *BF_options(void); + + void BF_encrypt(BF_LONG *data,const BF_KEY *key); + void BF_decrypt(BF_LONG *data,const BF_KEY *key); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This library implements the Blowfish cipher, which was invented and described +by Counterpane (see http://www.counterpane.com/blowfish.html ). + +Blowfish is a block cipher that operates on 64 bit (8 byte) blocks of data. +It uses a variable size key, but typically, 128 bit (16 byte) keys are +considered good for strong encryption. Blowfish can be used in the same +modes as DES (see L). Blowfish is currently one +of the faster block ciphers. It is quite a bit faster than DES, and much +faster than IDEA or RC2. + +Blowfish consists of a key setup phase and the actual encryption or decryption +phase. + +BF_set_key() sets up the B B using the B bytes long key +at B. + +BF_ecb_encrypt() is the basic Blowfish encryption and decryption function. +It encrypts or decrypts the first 64 bits of B using the key B, +putting the result in B. B decides if encryption (B) +or decryption (B) shall be performed. The vector pointed at by +B and B must be 64 bits in length, no less. If they are larger, +everything after the first 64 bits is ignored. + +The mode functions BF_cbc_encrypt(), BF_cfb64_encrypt() and BF_ofb64_encrypt() +all operate on variable length data. They all take an initialization vector +B which needs to be passed along into the next call of the same function +for the same message. B may be initialized with anything, but the +recipient needs to know what it was initialized with, or it won't be able +to decrypt. Some programs and protocols simplify this, like SSH, where +B is simply initialized to zero. +BF_cbc_encrypt() operates on data that is a multiple of 8 bytes long, while +BF_cfb64_encrypt() and BF_ofb64_encrypt() are used to encrypt an variable +number of bytes (the amount does not have to be an exact multiple of 8). The +purpose of the latter two is to simulate stream ciphers, and therefore, they +need the parameter B, which is a pointer to an integer where the current +offset in B is stored between calls. This integer must be initialized +to zero when B is initialized. + +BF_cbc_encrypt() is the Cipher Block Chaining function for Blowfish. It +encrypts or decrypts the 64 bits chunks of B using the key B, +putting the result in B. B decides if encryption (BF_ENCRYPT) or +decryption (BF_DECRYPT) shall be performed. B must point at an 8 byte +long initialization vector. + +BF_cfb64_encrypt() is the CFB mode for Blowfish with 64 bit feedback. +It encrypts or decrypts the bytes in B using the key B, +putting the result in B. B decides if encryption (B) +or decryption (B) shall be performed. B must point at an +8 byte long initialization vector. B must point at an integer which must +be initially zero. + +BF_ofb64_encrypt() is the OFB mode for Blowfish with 64 bit feedback. +It uses the same parameters as BF_cfb64_encrypt(), which must be initialized +the same way. + +BF_encrypt() and BF_decrypt() are the lowest level functions for Blowfish +encryption. They encrypt/decrypt the first 64 bits of the vector pointed by +B, using the key B. These functions should not be used unless you +implement 'modes' of Blowfish. The alternative is to use BF_ecb_encrypt(). +If you still want to use these functions, you should be aware that they take +each 32-bit chunk in host-byte order, which is little-endian on little-endian +platforms and big-endian on big-endian ones. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +None of the functions presented here return any value. + +=head1 NOTE + +Applications should use the higher level functions +L etc. instead of calling the +blowfish functions directly. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The Blowfish functions are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut + diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/bn.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/bn.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..cd2f8e50c --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/bn.pod @@ -0,0 +1,181 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +bn - multiprecision integer arithmetics + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BIGNUM *BN_new(void); + void BN_free(BIGNUM *a); + void BN_init(BIGNUM *); + void BN_clear(BIGNUM *a); + void BN_clear_free(BIGNUM *a); + + BN_CTX *BN_CTX_new(void); + void BN_CTX_init(BN_CTX *c); + void BN_CTX_free(BN_CTX *c); + + BIGNUM *BN_copy(BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *b); + BIGNUM *BN_dup(const BIGNUM *a); + + BIGNUM *BN_swap(BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b); + + int BN_num_bytes(const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_num_bits(const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_num_bits_word(BN_ULONG w); + + void BN_set_negative(BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_is_negative(const BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_add(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *b); + int BN_sub(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *b); + int BN_mul(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_sqr(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_div(BIGNUM *dv, BIGNUM *rem, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *d, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod(BIGNUM *rem, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_nnmod(BIGNUM *rem, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod_add(BIGNUM *ret, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod_sub(BIGNUM *ret, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod_mul(BIGNUM *ret, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, const BIGNUM *m, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod_sqr(BIGNUM *ret, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_exp(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *p, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod_exp(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *p, + const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_gcd(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + + int BN_add_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + int BN_sub_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + int BN_mul_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + BN_ULONG BN_div_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + BN_ULONG BN_mod_word(const BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + + int BN_cmp(BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b); + int BN_ucmp(BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b); + int BN_is_zero(BIGNUM *a); + int BN_is_one(BIGNUM *a); + int BN_is_word(BIGNUM *a, BN_ULONG w); + int BN_is_odd(BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_zero(BIGNUM *a); + int BN_one(BIGNUM *a); + const BIGNUM *BN_value_one(void); + int BN_set_word(BIGNUM *a, unsigned long w); + unsigned long BN_get_word(BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_rand(BIGNUM *rnd, int bits, int top, int bottom); + int BN_pseudo_rand(BIGNUM *rnd, int bits, int top, int bottom); + int BN_rand_range(BIGNUM *rnd, BIGNUM *range); + int BN_pseudo_rand_range(BIGNUM *rnd, BIGNUM *range); + + BIGNUM *BN_generate_prime(BIGNUM *ret, int bits,int safe, BIGNUM *add, + BIGNUM *rem, void (*callback)(int, int, void *), void *cb_arg); + int BN_is_prime(const BIGNUM *p, int nchecks, + void (*callback)(int, int, void *), BN_CTX *ctx, void *cb_arg); + + int BN_set_bit(BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_clear_bit(BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_is_bit_set(const BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_mask_bits(BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_lshift(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_lshift1(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a); + int BN_rshift(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, int n); + int BN_rshift1(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a); + + int BN_bn2bin(const BIGNUM *a, unsigned char *to); + BIGNUM *BN_bin2bn(const unsigned char *s, int len, BIGNUM *ret); + char *BN_bn2hex(const BIGNUM *a); + char *BN_bn2dec(const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_hex2bn(BIGNUM **a, const char *str); + int BN_dec2bn(BIGNUM **a, const char *str); + int BN_print(BIO *fp, const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_print_fp(FILE *fp, const BIGNUM *a); + int BN_bn2mpi(const BIGNUM *a, unsigned char *to); + BIGNUM *BN_mpi2bn(unsigned char *s, int len, BIGNUM *ret); + + BIGNUM *BN_mod_inverse(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *n, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + BN_RECP_CTX *BN_RECP_CTX_new(void); + void BN_RECP_CTX_init(BN_RECP_CTX *recp); + void BN_RECP_CTX_free(BN_RECP_CTX *recp); + int BN_RECP_CTX_set(BN_RECP_CTX *recp, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_mod_mul_reciprocal(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, + BN_RECP_CTX *recp, BN_CTX *ctx); + + BN_MONT_CTX *BN_MONT_CTX_new(void); + void BN_MONT_CTX_init(BN_MONT_CTX *ctx); + void BN_MONT_CTX_free(BN_MONT_CTX *mont); + int BN_MONT_CTX_set(BN_MONT_CTX *mont, const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx); + BN_MONT_CTX *BN_MONT_CTX_copy(BN_MONT_CTX *to, BN_MONT_CTX *from); + int BN_mod_mul_montgomery(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BIGNUM *b, + BN_MONT_CTX *mont, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_from_montgomery(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BN_MONT_CTX *mont, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_to_montgomery(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, BN_MONT_CTX *mont, + BN_CTX *ctx); + + BN_BLINDING *BN_BLINDING_new(const BIGNUM *A, const BIGNUM *Ai, + BIGNUM *mod); + void BN_BLINDING_free(BN_BLINDING *b); + int BN_BLINDING_update(BN_BLINDING *b,BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_convert(BIGNUM *n, BN_BLINDING *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_invert(BIGNUM *n, BN_BLINDING *b, BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_convert_ex(BIGNUM *n, BIGNUM *r, BN_BLINDING *b, + BN_CTX *ctx); + int BN_BLINDING_invert_ex(BIGNUM *n,const BIGNUM *r,BN_BLINDING *b, + BN_CTX *ctx); + unsigned long BN_BLINDING_get_thread_id(const BN_BLINDING *); + void BN_BLINDING_set_thread_id(BN_BLINDING *, unsigned long); + unsigned long BN_BLINDING_get_flags(const BN_BLINDING *); + void BN_BLINDING_set_flags(BN_BLINDING *, unsigned long); + BN_BLINDING *BN_BLINDING_create_param(BN_BLINDING *b, + const BIGNUM *e, BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx, + int (*bn_mod_exp)(BIGNUM *r, const BIGNUM *a, const BIGNUM *p, + const BIGNUM *m, BN_CTX *ctx, BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx), + BN_MONT_CTX *m_ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This library performs arithmetic operations on integers of arbitrary +size. It was written for use in public key cryptography, such as RSA +and Diffie-Hellman. + +It uses dynamic memory allocation for storing its data structures. +That means that there is no limit on the size of the numbers +manipulated by these functions, but return values must always be +checked in case a memory allocation error has occurred. + +The basic object in this library is a B. It is used to hold a +single large integer. This type should be considered opaque and fields +should not be modified or accessed directly. + +The creation of B objects is described in L; +L describes most of the arithmetic operations. +Comparison is described in L; L +describes certain assignments, L the generation of +random numbers, L deals with prime +numbers and L with bit operations. The conversion +of Bs to external formats is described in L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, L, L, L, +L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L, +L, L, +L, +L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/bn_internal.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/bn_internal.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..891914678 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/bn_internal.pod @@ -0,0 +1,226 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +bn_mul_words, bn_mul_add_words, bn_sqr_words, bn_div_words, +bn_add_words, bn_sub_words, bn_mul_comba4, bn_mul_comba8, +bn_sqr_comba4, bn_sqr_comba8, bn_cmp_words, bn_mul_normal, +bn_mul_low_normal, bn_mul_recursive, bn_mul_part_recursive, +bn_mul_low_recursive, bn_mul_high, bn_sqr_normal, bn_sqr_recursive, +bn_expand, bn_wexpand, bn_expand2, bn_fix_top, bn_check_top, +bn_print, bn_dump, bn_set_max, bn_set_high, bn_set_low - BIGNUM +library internal functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + BN_ULONG bn_mul_words(BN_ULONG *rp, BN_ULONG *ap, int num, BN_ULONG w); + BN_ULONG bn_mul_add_words(BN_ULONG *rp, BN_ULONG *ap, int num, + BN_ULONG w); + void bn_sqr_words(BN_ULONG *rp, BN_ULONG *ap, int num); + BN_ULONG bn_div_words(BN_ULONG h, BN_ULONG l, BN_ULONG d); + BN_ULONG bn_add_words(BN_ULONG *rp, BN_ULONG *ap, BN_ULONG *bp, + int num); + BN_ULONG bn_sub_words(BN_ULONG *rp, BN_ULONG *ap, BN_ULONG *bp, + int num); + + void bn_mul_comba4(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b); + void bn_mul_comba8(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b); + void bn_sqr_comba4(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a); + void bn_sqr_comba8(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a); + + int bn_cmp_words(BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b, int n); + + void bn_mul_normal(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, int na, BN_ULONG *b, + int nb); + void bn_mul_low_normal(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b, int n); + void bn_mul_recursive(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b, int n2, + int dna,int dnb,BN_ULONG *tmp); + void bn_mul_part_recursive(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b, + int n, int tna,int tnb, BN_ULONG *tmp); + void bn_mul_low_recursive(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b, + int n2, BN_ULONG *tmp); + void bn_mul_high(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, BN_ULONG *b, BN_ULONG *l, + int n2, BN_ULONG *tmp); + + void bn_sqr_normal(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, int n, BN_ULONG *tmp); + void bn_sqr_recursive(BN_ULONG *r, BN_ULONG *a, int n2, BN_ULONG *tmp); + + void mul(BN_ULONG r, BN_ULONG a, BN_ULONG w, BN_ULONG c); + void mul_add(BN_ULONG r, BN_ULONG a, BN_ULONG w, BN_ULONG c); + void sqr(BN_ULONG r0, BN_ULONG r1, BN_ULONG a); + + BIGNUM *bn_expand(BIGNUM *a, int bits); + BIGNUM *bn_wexpand(BIGNUM *a, int n); + BIGNUM *bn_expand2(BIGNUM *a, int n); + void bn_fix_top(BIGNUM *a); + + void bn_check_top(BIGNUM *a); + void bn_print(BIGNUM *a); + void bn_dump(BN_ULONG *d, int n); + void bn_set_max(BIGNUM *a); + void bn_set_high(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, int n); + void bn_set_low(BIGNUM *r, BIGNUM *a, int n); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This page documents the internal functions used by the OpenSSL +B implementation. They are described here to facilitate +debugging and extending the library. They are I to be used by +applications. + +=head2 The BIGNUM structure + + typedef struct bignum_st + { + int top; /* number of words used in d */ + BN_ULONG *d; /* pointer to an array containing the integer value */ + int max; /* size of the d array */ + int neg; /* sign */ + } BIGNUM; + +The integer value is stored in B, a malloc()ed array of words (B), +least significant word first. A B can be either 16, 32 or 64 bits +in size, depending on the 'number of bits' (B) specified in +C. + +B is the size of the B array that has been allocated. B +is the number of words being used, so for a value of 4, bn.d[0]=4 and +bn.top=1. B is 1 if the number is negative. When a B is +B<0>, the B field can be B and B == B<0>. + +Various routines in this library require the use of temporary +B variables during their execution. Since dynamic memory +allocation to create Bs is rather expensive when used in +conjunction with repeated subroutine calls, the B structure is +used. This structure contains B Bs, see +L. + +=head2 Low-level arithmetic operations + +These functions are implemented in C and for several platforms in +assembly language: + +bn_mul_words(B, B, B, B) operates on the B word +arrays B and B. It computes B * B, places the result +in B, and returns the high word (carry). + +bn_mul_add_words(B, B, B, B) operates on the B +word arrays B and B. It computes B * B + B, places +the result in B, and returns the high word (carry). + +bn_sqr_words(B, B, B) operates on the B word array +B and the 2*B word array B. It computes B * B +word-wise, and places the low and high bytes of the result in B. + +bn_div_words(B, B, B) divides the two word number (B,B) +by B and returns the result. + +bn_add_words(B, B, B, B) operates on the B word +arrays B, B and B. It computes B + B, places the +result in B, and returns the high word (carry). + +bn_sub_words(B, B, B, B) operates on the B word +arrays B, B and B. It computes B - B, places the +result in B, and returns the carry (1 if B E B, 0 +otherwise). + +bn_mul_comba4(B, B, B) operates on the 4 word arrays B and +B and the 8 word array B. It computes B*B and places the +result in B. + +bn_mul_comba8(B, B, B) operates on the 8 word arrays B and +B and the 16 word array B. It computes B*B and places the +result in B. + +bn_sqr_comba4(B, B, B) operates on the 4 word arrays B and +B and the 8 word array B. + +bn_sqr_comba8(B, B, B) operates on the 8 word arrays B and +B and the 16 word array B. + +The following functions are implemented in C: + +bn_cmp_words(B, B, B) operates on the B word arrays B +and B. It returns 1, 0 and -1 if B is greater than, equal and +less than B. + +bn_mul_normal(B, B, B, B, B) operates on the B +word array B, the B word array B and the B+B word +array B. It computes B*B and places the result in B. + +bn_mul_low_normal(B, B, B, B) operates on the B word +arrays B, B and B. It computes the B low words of +B*B and places the result in B. + +bn_mul_recursive(B, B, B, B, B, B, B) operates +on the word arrays B and B of length B+B and B+B +(B and B are currently allowed to be 0 or negative) and the 2*B +word arrays B and B. B must be a power of 2. It computes +B*B and places the result in B. + +bn_mul_part_recursive(B, B, B, B, B, B, B) +operates on the word arrays B and B of length B+B and +B+B and the 4*B word arrays B and B. + +bn_mul_low_recursive(B, B, B, B, B) operates on the +B word arrays B and B and the B/2 word arrays B +and B. + +bn_mul_high(B, B, B, B, B, B) operates on the +B word arrays B, B, B and B (?) and the 3*B word +array B. + +BN_mul() calls bn_mul_normal(), or an optimized implementation if the +factors have the same size: bn_mul_comba8() is used if they are 8 +words long, bn_mul_recursive() if they are larger than +B and the size is an exact multiple of the word +size, and bn_mul_part_recursive() for others that are larger than +B. + +bn_sqr_normal(B, B, B, B) operates on the B word array +B and the 2*B word arrays B and B. + +The implementations use the following macros which, depending on the +architecture, may use "long long" C operations or inline assembler. +They are defined in C. + +mul(B, B, B, B) computes B*B+B and places the +low word of the result in B and the high word in B. + +mul_add(B, B, B, B) computes B*B+B+B and +places the low word of the result in B and the high word in B. + +sqr(B, B, B) computes B*B and places the low word +of the result in B and the high word in B. + +=head2 Size changes + +bn_expand() ensures that B has enough space for a B bit +number. bn_wexpand() ensures that B has enough space for an +B word number. If the number has to be expanded, both macros +call bn_expand2(), which allocates a new B array and copies the +data. They return B on error, B otherwise. + +The bn_fix_top() macro reduces Btop> to point to the most +significant non-zero word plus one when B has shrunk. + +=head2 Debugging + +bn_check_top() verifies that C<((a)-Etop E= 0 && (a)-Etop +E= (a)-Emax)>. A violation will cause the program to abort. + +bn_print() prints B to stderr. bn_dump() prints B words at B +(in reverse order, i.e. most significant word first) to stderr. + +bn_set_max() makes B a static number with a B of its current size. +This is used by bn_set_low() and bn_set_high() to make B a read-only +B that contains the B low or high words of B. + +If B is not defined, bn_check_top(), bn_print(), bn_dump() +and bn_set_max() are defined as empty macros. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/buffer.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/buffer.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..781f5b11e --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/buffer.pod @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +BUF_MEM_new, BUF_MEM_free, BUF_MEM_grow, BUF_strdup - simple +character arrays structure + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + BUF_MEM *BUF_MEM_new(void); + + void BUF_MEM_free(BUF_MEM *a); + + int BUF_MEM_grow(BUF_MEM *str, int len); + + char * BUF_strdup(const char *str); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The buffer library handles simple character arrays. Buffers are used for +various purposes in the library, most notably memory BIOs. + +The library uses the BUF_MEM structure defined in buffer.h: + + typedef struct buf_mem_st + { + int length; /* current number of bytes */ + char *data; + int max; /* size of buffer */ + } BUF_MEM; + +B is the current size of the buffer in bytes, B is the amount of +memory allocated to the buffer. There are three functions which handle these +and one "miscellaneous" function. + +BUF_MEM_new() allocates a new buffer of zero size. + +BUF_MEM_free() frees up an already existing buffer. The data is zeroed +before freeing up in case the buffer contains sensitive data. + +BUF_MEM_grow() changes the size of an already existing buffer to +B. Any data already in the buffer is preserved if it increases in +size. + +BUF_strdup() copies a null terminated string into a block of allocated +memory and returns a pointer to the allocated block. +Unlike the standard C library strdup() this function uses OPENSSL_malloc() and so +should be used in preference to the standard library strdup() because it can +be used for memory leak checking or replacing the malloc() function. + +The memory allocated from BUF_strdup() should be freed up using the OPENSSL_free() +function. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +BUF_MEM_new() returns the buffer or NULL on error. + +BUF_MEM_free() has no return value. + +BUF_MEM_grow() returns zero on error or the new size (i.e. B). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +BUF_MEM_new(), BUF_MEM_free() and BUF_MEM_grow() are available in all +versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. BUF_strdup() was added in SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/crypto.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/crypto.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..7a527992b --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/crypto.pod @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +crypto - OpenSSL cryptographic library + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The OpenSSL B library implements a wide range of cryptographic +algorithms used in various Internet standards. The services provided +by this library are used by the OpenSSL implementations of SSL, TLS +and S/MIME, and they have also been used to implement SSH, OpenPGP, and +other cryptographic standards. + +=head1 OVERVIEW + +B consists of a number of sub-libraries that implement the +individual algorithms. + +The functionality includes symmetric encryption, public key +cryptography and key agreement, certificate handling, cryptographic +hash functions and a cryptographic pseudo-random number generator. + +=over 4 + +=item SYMMETRIC CIPHERS + +L, L, L, +L, L, L, L + +=item PUBLIC KEY CRYPTOGRAPHY AND KEY AGREEMENT + +L, L, L + +=item CERTIFICATES + +L, L + +=item AUTHENTICATION CODES, HASH FUNCTIONS + +L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L + +=item AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS + +L, L, L, +L + +=item INPUT/OUTPUT, DATA ENCODING + +L, L, L, L, +L, L + +=item INTERNAL FUNCTIONS + +L, L, L, +L, L, +L + +=back + +=head1 NOTES + +Some of the newer functions follow a naming convention using the numbers +B<0> and B<1>. For example the functions: + + int X509_CRL_add0_revoked(X509_CRL *crl, X509_REVOKED *rev); + int X509_add1_trust_object(X509 *x, ASN1_OBJECT *obj); + +The B<0> version uses the supplied structure pointer directly +in the parent and it will be freed up when the parent is freed. +In the above example B would be freed but B would not. + +The B<1> function uses a copy of the supplied structure pointer +(or in some cases increases its link count) in the parent and +so both (B and B above) should be freed up. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_ASN1_OBJECT.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_ASN1_OBJECT.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..45bb18492 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_ASN1_OBJECT.pod @@ -0,0 +1,29 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_ASN1_OBJECT, i2d_ASN1_OBJECT - ASN1 OBJECT IDENTIFIER functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + ASN1_OBJECT *d2i_ASN1_OBJECT(ASN1_OBJECT **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_ASN1_OBJECT(ASN1_OBJECT *a, unsigned char **pp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode an ASN1 OBJECT IDENTIFIER. + +Othewise these behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DHparams.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DHparams.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1e98aebec --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DHparams.pod @@ -0,0 +1,30 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_DHparams, i2d_DHparams - PKCS#3 DH parameter functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + DH *d2i_DHparams(DH **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_DHparams(DH *a, unsigned char **pp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode PKCS#3 DH parameters using the +DHparameter structure described in PKCS#3. + +Othewise these behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DSAPublicKey.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DSAPublicKey.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..22c1b50f2 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_DSAPublicKey.pod @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_DSAPublicKey, i2d_DSAPublicKey, d2i_DSAPrivateKey, i2d_DSAPrivateKey, +d2i_DSA_PUBKEY, i2d_DSA_PUBKEY, d2i_DSA_SIG, i2d_DSA_SIG - DSA key encoding +and parsing functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + DSA * d2i_DSAPublicKey(DSA **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_DSAPublicKey(const DSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + DSA * d2i_DSA_PUBKEY(DSA **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_DSA_PUBKEY(const DSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + DSA * d2i_DSAPrivateKey(DSA **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_DSAPrivateKey(const DSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + DSA * d2i_DSAparams(DSA **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_DSAparams(const DSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + DSA * d2i_DSA_SIG(DSA_SIG **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_DSA_SIG(const DSA_SIG *a, unsigned char **pp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +d2i_DSAPublicKey() and i2d_DSAPublicKey() decode and encode the DSA public key +components structure. + +d2i_DSA_PUBKEY() and i2d_DSA_PUBKEY() decode and encode an DSA public key using +a SubjectPublicKeyInfo (certificate public key) structure. + +d2i_DSAPrivateKey(), i2d_DSAPrivateKey() decode and encode the DSA private key +components. + +d2i_DSAparams(), i2d_DSAparams() decode and encode the DSA parameters using +a B structure as defined in RFC2459. + +d2i_DSA_SIG(), i2d_DSA_SIG() decode and encode a DSA signature using a +B structure as defined in RFC2459. + +The usage of all of these functions is similar to the d2i_X509() and +i2d_X509() described in the L manual page. + +=head1 NOTES + +The B structure passed to the private key encoding functions should have +all the private key components present. + +The data encoded by the private key functions is unencrypted and therefore +offers no private key security. + +The B functions should be used in preference to the B +functions when encoding public keys because they use a standard format. + +The B functions use an non standard format the actual data encoded +depends on the value of the B field of the B key parameter. +If B is zero then only the B field is encoded as an +B. If B is 1 then a B consisting of the +B

, B, B and B respectively fields are encoded. + +The B functions also use a non standard structure consiting +consisting of a SEQUENCE containing the B

, B, B and B and +B fields respectively. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..a54b77908 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey.pod @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey_bio, d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey_fp, +i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_bio, i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_fp, +i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid_bio, i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid_fp - PKCS#8 format private key functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + EVP_PKEY *d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey_bio(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + EVP_PKEY *d2i_PKCS8PrivateKey_fp(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_bio(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_fp(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid_bio(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY *x, int nid, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int i2d_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid_fp(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY *x, int nid, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The PKCS#8 functions encode and decode private keys in PKCS#8 format using both +PKCS#5 v1.5 and PKCS#5 v2.0 password based encryption algorithms. + +Other than the use of DER as opposed to PEM these functions are identical to the +corresponding B function as described in the L manual page. + +=head1 NOTES + +Before using these functions L +should be called to initialize the internal algorithm lookup tables otherwise errors about +unknown algorithms will occur if an attempt is made to decrypt a private key. + +These functions are currently the only way to store encrypted private keys using DER format. + +Currently all the functions use BIOs or FILE pointers, there are no functions which +work directly on memory: this can be readily worked around by converting the buffers +to memory BIOs, see L for details. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_RSAPublicKey.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_RSAPublicKey.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..279b29c87 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_RSAPublicKey.pod @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_RSAPublicKey, i2d_RSAPublicKey, d2i_RSAPrivateKey, i2d_RSAPrivateKey, +d2i_RSA_PUBKEY, i2d_RSA_PUBKEY, i2d_Netscape_RSA, +d2i_Netscape_RSA - RSA public and private key encoding functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + RSA * d2i_RSAPublicKey(RSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_RSAPublicKey(RSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + RSA * d2i_RSA_PUBKEY(RSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_RSA_PUBKEY(RSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + RSA * d2i_RSAPrivateKey(RSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + + int i2d_RSAPrivateKey(RSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + + int i2d_Netscape_RSA(RSA *a, unsigned char **pp, int (*cb)()); + + RSA * d2i_Netscape_RSA(RSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length, int (*cb)()); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +d2i_RSAPublicKey() and i2d_RSAPublicKey() decode and encode a PKCS#1 RSAPublicKey +structure. + +d2i_RSA_PUBKEY() and i2d_RSA_PUBKEY() decode and encode an RSA public key using +a SubjectPublicKeyInfo (certificate public key) structure. + +d2i_RSAPrivateKey(), i2d_RSAPrivateKey() decode and encode a PKCS#1 RSAPrivateKey +structure. + +d2i_Netscape_RSA(), i2d_Netscape_RSA() decode and encode an RSA private key in +NET format. + +The usage of all of these functions is similar to the d2i_X509() and +i2d_X509() described in the L manual page. + +=head1 NOTES + +The B structure passed to the private key encoding functions should have +all the PKCS#1 private key components present. + +The data encoded by the private key functions is unencrypted and therefore +offers no private key security. + +The NET format functions are present to provide compatibility with certain very +old software. This format has some severe security weaknesses and should be +avoided if possible. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..5bfa18afb --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509.pod @@ -0,0 +1,231 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_X509, i2d_X509, d2i_X509_bio, d2i_X509_fp, i2d_X509_bio, +i2d_X509_fp - X509 encode and decode functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + X509 *d2i_X509(X509 **px, const unsigned char **in, int len); + int i2d_X509(X509 *x, unsigned char **out); + + X509 *d2i_X509_bio(BIO *bp, X509 **x); + X509 *d2i_X509_fp(FILE *fp, X509 **x); + + int i2d_X509_bio(X509 *x, BIO *bp); + int i2d_X509_fp(X509 *x, FILE *fp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The X509 encode and decode routines encode and parse an +B structure, which represents an X509 certificate. + +d2i_X509() attempts to decode B bytes at B<*in>. If +successful a pointer to the B structure is returned. If an error +occurred then B is returned. If B is not B then the +returned structure is written to B<*px>. If B<*px> is not B +then it is assumed that B<*px> contains a valid B +structure and an attempt is made to reuse it. If the call is +successful B<*in> is incremented to the byte following the +parsed data. + +i2d_X509() encodes the structure pointed to by B into DER format. +If B is not B is writes the DER encoded data to the buffer +at B<*out>, and increments it to point after the data just written. +If the return value is negative an error occurred, otherwise it +returns the length of the encoded data. + +For OpenSSL 0.9.7 and later if B<*out> is B memory will be +allocated for a buffer and the encoded data written to it. In this +case B<*out> is not incremented and it points to the start of the +data just written. + +d2i_X509_bio() is similar to d2i_X509() except it attempts +to parse data from BIO B. + +d2i_X509_fp() is similar to d2i_X509() except it attempts +to parse data from FILE pointer B. + +i2d_X509_bio() is similar to i2d_X509() except it writes +the encoding of the structure B to BIO B and it +returns 1 for success and 0 for failure. + +i2d_X509_fp() is similar to i2d_X509() except it writes +the encoding of the structure B to BIO B and it +returns 1 for success and 0 for failure. + +=head1 NOTES + +The letters B and B in for example B stand for +"internal" (that is an internal C structure) and "DER". So that +B converts from internal to DER. + +The functions can also understand B forms. + +The actual X509 structure passed to i2d_X509() must be a valid +populated B structure it can B simply be fed with an +empty structure such as that returned by X509_new(). + +The encoded data is in binary form and may contain embedded zeroes. +Therefore any FILE pointers or BIOs should be opened in binary mode. +Functions such as B will B return the correct length +of the encoded structure. + +The ways that B<*in> and B<*out> are incremented after the operation +can trap the unwary. See the B section for some common +errors. + +The reason for the auto increment behaviour is to reflect a typical +usage of ASN1 functions: after one structure is encoded or decoded +another will processed after it. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Allocate and encode the DER encoding of an X509 structure: + + int len; + unsigned char *buf, *p; + + len = i2d_X509(x, NULL); + + buf = OPENSSL_malloc(len); + + if (buf == NULL) + /* error */ + + p = buf; + + i2d_X509(x, &p); + +If you are using OpenSSL 0.9.7 or later then this can be +simplified to: + + + int len; + unsigned char *buf; + + buf = NULL; + + len = i2d_X509(x, &buf); + + if (len < 0) + /* error */ + +Attempt to decode a buffer: + + X509 *x; + + unsigned char *buf, *p; + + int len; + + /* Something to setup buf and len */ + + p = buf; + + x = d2i_X509(NULL, &p, len); + + if (x == NULL) + /* Some error */ + +Alternative technique: + + X509 *x; + + unsigned char *buf, *p; + + int len; + + /* Something to setup buf and len */ + + p = buf; + + x = NULL; + + if(!d2i_X509(&x, &p, len)) + /* Some error */ + + +=head1 WARNINGS + +The use of temporary variable is mandatory. A common +mistake is to attempt to use a buffer directly as follows: + + int len; + unsigned char *buf; + + len = i2d_X509(x, NULL); + + buf = OPENSSL_malloc(len); + + if (buf == NULL) + /* error */ + + i2d_X509(x, &buf); + + /* Other stuff ... */ + + OPENSSL_free(buf); + +This code will result in B apparently containing garbage because +it was incremented after the call to point after the data just written. +Also B will no longer contain the pointer allocated by B +and the subsequent call to B may well crash. + +The auto allocation feature (setting buf to NULL) only works on OpenSSL +0.9.7 and later. Attempts to use it on earlier versions will typically +cause a segmentation violation. + +Another trap to avoid is misuse of the B argument to B: + + X509 *x; + + if (!d2i_X509(&x, &p, len)) + /* Some error */ + +This will probably crash somewhere in B. The reason for this +is that the variable B is uninitialized and an attempt will be made to +interpret its (invalid) value as an B structure, typically causing +a segmentation violation. If B is set to NULL first then this will not +happen. + +=head1 BUGS + +In some versions of OpenSSL the "reuse" behaviour of d2i_X509() when +B<*px> is valid is broken and some parts of the reused structure may +persist if they are not present in the new one. As a result the use +of this "reuse" behaviour is strongly discouraged. + +i2d_X509() will not return an error in many versions of OpenSSL, +if mandatory fields are not initialized due to a programming error +then the encoded structure may contain invalid data or omit the +fields entirely and will not be parsed by d2i_X509(). This may be +fixed in future so code should not assume that i2d_X509() will +always succeed. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +d2i_X509(), d2i_X509_bio() and d2i_X509_fp() return a valid B structure +or B if an error occurs. The error code that can be obtained by +L. + +i2d_X509(), i2d_X509_bio() and i2d_X509_fp() return a the number of bytes +successfully encoded or a negative value if an error occurs. The error code +can be obtained by L. + +i2d_X509_bio() and i2d_X509_fp() returns 1 for success and 0 if an error +occurs The error code can be obtained by L. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +d2i_X509, i2d_X509, d2i_X509_bio, d2i_X509_fp, i2d_X509_bio and i2d_X509_fp +are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_ALGOR.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_ALGOR.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9e5cd92ca --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_ALGOR.pod @@ -0,0 +1,30 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_X509_ALGOR, i2d_X509_ALGOR - AlgorithmIdentifier functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + X509_ALGOR *d2i_X509_ALGOR(X509_ALGOR **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_X509_ALGOR(X509_ALGOR *a, unsigned char **pp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode an B structure which is +equivalent to the B structure. + +Othewise these behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_CRL.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_CRL.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e7295a5d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_CRL.pod @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_X509_CRL, i2d_X509_CRL, d2i_X509_CRL_bio, d2i_509_CRL_fp, +i2d_X509_CRL_bio, i2d_X509_CRL_fp - PKCS#10 certificate request functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + X509_CRL *d2i_X509_CRL(X509_CRL **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_X509_CRL(X509_CRL *a, unsigned char **pp); + + X509_CRL *d2i_X509_CRL_bio(BIO *bp, X509_CRL **x); + X509_CRL *d2i_X509_CRL_fp(FILE *fp, X509_CRL **x); + + int i2d_X509_CRL_bio(X509_CRL *x, BIO *bp); + int i2d_X509_CRL_fp(X509_CRL *x, FILE *fp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode an X509 CRL (certificate revocation +list). + +Othewise the functions behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_NAME.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_NAME.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..343ffe151 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_NAME.pod @@ -0,0 +1,31 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_X509_NAME, i2d_X509_NAME - X509_NAME encoding functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + X509_NAME *d2i_X509_NAME(X509_NAME **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_X509_NAME(X509_NAME *a, unsigned char **pp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode an B structure which is the +the same as the B type defined in RFC2459 (and elsewhere) and used +for example in certificate subject and issuer names. + +Othewise the functions behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_REQ.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_REQ.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ae32a3891 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_REQ.pod @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_X509_REQ, i2d_X509_REQ, d2i_X509_REQ_bio, d2i_X509_REQ_fp, +i2d_X509_REQ_bio, i2d_X509_REQ_fp - PKCS#10 certificate request functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + X509_REQ *d2i_X509_REQ(X509_REQ **a, const unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_X509_REQ(X509_REQ *a, unsigned char **pp); + + X509_REQ *d2i_X509_REQ_bio(BIO *bp, X509_REQ **x); + X509_REQ *d2i_X509_REQ_fp(FILE *fp, X509_REQ **x); + + int i2d_X509_REQ_bio(X509_REQ *x, BIO *bp); + int i2d_X509_REQ_fp(X509_REQ *x, FILE *fp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode a PKCS#10 certificate request. + +Othewise these behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_SIG.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_SIG.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e48fd79a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/d2i_X509_SIG.pod @@ -0,0 +1,30 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +d2i_X509_SIG, i2d_X509_SIG - DigestInfo functions. + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + X509_SIG *d2i_X509_SIG(X509_SIG **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_X509_SIG(X509_SIG *a, unsigned char **pp); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions decode and encode an X509_SIG structure which is +equivalent to the B structure defined in PKCS#1 and PKCS#7. + +Othewise these behave in a similar way to d2i_X509() and i2d_X509() +described in the L manual page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +TBA + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/des.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/des.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..6f0cf1cc5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/des.pod @@ -0,0 +1,358 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +DES_random_key, DES_set_key, DES_key_sched, DES_set_key_checked, +DES_set_key_unchecked, DES_set_odd_parity, DES_is_weak_key, +DES_ecb_encrypt, DES_ecb2_encrypt, DES_ecb3_encrypt, DES_ncbc_encrypt, +DES_cfb_encrypt, DES_ofb_encrypt, DES_pcbc_encrypt, DES_cfb64_encrypt, +DES_ofb64_encrypt, DES_xcbc_encrypt, DES_ede2_cbc_encrypt, +DES_ede2_cfb64_encrypt, DES_ede2_ofb64_encrypt, DES_ede3_cbc_encrypt, +DES_ede3_cbcm_encrypt, DES_ede3_cfb64_encrypt, DES_ede3_ofb64_encrypt, +DES_cbc_cksum, DES_quad_cksum, DES_string_to_key, DES_string_to_2keys, +DES_fcrypt, DES_crypt, DES_enc_read, DES_enc_write - DES encryption + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void DES_random_key(DES_cblock *ret); + + int DES_set_key(const_DES_cblock *key, DES_key_schedule *schedule); + int DES_key_sched(const_DES_cblock *key, DES_key_schedule *schedule); + int DES_set_key_checked(const_DES_cblock *key, + DES_key_schedule *schedule); + void DES_set_key_unchecked(const_DES_cblock *key, + DES_key_schedule *schedule); + + void DES_set_odd_parity(DES_cblock *key); + int DES_is_weak_key(const_DES_cblock *key); + + void DES_ecb_encrypt(const_DES_cblock *input, DES_cblock *output, + DES_key_schedule *ks, int enc); + void DES_ecb2_encrypt(const_DES_cblock *input, DES_cblock *output, + DES_key_schedule *ks1, DES_key_schedule *ks2, int enc); + void DES_ecb3_encrypt(const_DES_cblock *input, DES_cblock *output, + DES_key_schedule *ks1, DES_key_schedule *ks2, + DES_key_schedule *ks3, int enc); + + void DES_ncbc_encrypt(const unsigned char *input, unsigned char *output, + long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, DES_cblock *ivec, + int enc); + void DES_cfb_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + int numbits, long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, + DES_cblock *ivec, int enc); + void DES_ofb_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + int numbits, long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, + DES_cblock *ivec); + void DES_pcbc_encrypt(const unsigned char *input, unsigned char *output, + long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, DES_cblock *ivec, + int enc); + void DES_cfb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, DES_cblock *ivec, + int *num, int enc); + void DES_ofb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, DES_cblock *ivec, + int *num); + + void DES_xcbc_encrypt(const unsigned char *input, unsigned char *output, + long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, DES_cblock *ivec, + const_DES_cblock *inw, const_DES_cblock *outw, int enc); + + void DES_ede2_cbc_encrypt(const unsigned char *input, + unsigned char *output, long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, + DES_key_schedule *ks2, DES_cblock *ivec, int enc); + void DES_ede2_cfb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, + unsigned char *out, long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, + DES_key_schedule *ks2, DES_cblock *ivec, int *num, int enc); + void DES_ede2_ofb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, + unsigned char *out, long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, + DES_key_schedule *ks2, DES_cblock *ivec, int *num); + + void DES_ede3_cbc_encrypt(const unsigned char *input, + unsigned char *output, long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, + DES_key_schedule *ks2, DES_key_schedule *ks3, DES_cblock *ivec, + int enc); + void DES_ede3_cbcm_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, DES_key_schedule *ks2, + DES_key_schedule *ks3, DES_cblock *ivec1, DES_cblock *ivec2, + int enc); + void DES_ede3_cfb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, DES_key_schedule *ks2, + DES_key_schedule *ks3, DES_cblock *ivec, int *num, int enc); + void DES_ede3_ofb64_encrypt(const unsigned char *in, unsigned char *out, + long length, DES_key_schedule *ks1, + DES_key_schedule *ks2, DES_key_schedule *ks3, + DES_cblock *ivec, int *num); + + DES_LONG DES_cbc_cksum(const unsigned char *input, DES_cblock *output, + long length, DES_key_schedule *schedule, + const_DES_cblock *ivec); + DES_LONG DES_quad_cksum(const unsigned char *input, DES_cblock output[], + long length, int out_count, DES_cblock *seed); + void DES_string_to_key(const char *str, DES_cblock *key); + void DES_string_to_2keys(const char *str, DES_cblock *key1, + DES_cblock *key2); + + char *DES_fcrypt(const char *buf, const char *salt, char *ret); + char *DES_crypt(const char *buf, const char *salt); + + int DES_enc_read(int fd, void *buf, int len, DES_key_schedule *sched, + DES_cblock *iv); + int DES_enc_write(int fd, const void *buf, int len, + DES_key_schedule *sched, DES_cblock *iv); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This library contains a fast implementation of the DES encryption +algorithm. + +There are two phases to the use of DES encryption. The first is the +generation of a I from a key, the second is the +actual encryption. A DES key is of type I. This type is +consists of 8 bytes with odd parity. The least significant bit in +each byte is the parity bit. The key schedule is an expanded form of +the key; it is used to speed the encryption process. + +DES_random_key() generates a random key. The PRNG must be seeded +prior to using this function (see L). If the PRNG +could not generate a secure key, 0 is returned. + +Before a DES key can be used, it must be converted into the +architecture dependent I via the +DES_set_key_checked() or DES_set_key_unchecked() function. + +DES_set_key_checked() will check that the key passed is of odd parity +and is not a week or semi-weak key. If the parity is wrong, then -1 +is returned. If the key is a weak key, then -2 is returned. If an +error is returned, the key schedule is not generated. + +DES_set_key() works like +DES_set_key_checked() if the I flag is non-zero, +otherwise like DES_set_key_unchecked(). These functions are available +for compatibility; it is recommended to use a function that does not +depend on a global variable. + +DES_set_odd_parity() sets the parity of the passed I to odd. + +DES_is_weak_key() returns 1 is the passed key is a weak key, 0 if it +is ok. The probability that a randomly generated key is weak is +1/2^52, so it is not really worth checking for them. + +The following routines mostly operate on an input and output stream of +Is. + +DES_ecb_encrypt() is the basic DES encryption routine that encrypts or +decrypts a single 8-byte I in I +(ECB) mode. It always transforms the input data, pointed to by +I, into the output data, pointed to by the I argument. +If the I argument is non-zero (DES_ENCRYPT), the I +(cleartext) is encrypted in to the I (ciphertext) using the +key_schedule specified by the I argument, previously set via +I. If I is zero (DES_DECRYPT), the I (now +ciphertext) is decrypted into the I (now cleartext). Input +and output may overlap. DES_ecb_encrypt() does not return a value. + +DES_ecb3_encrypt() encrypts/decrypts the I block by using +three-key Triple-DES encryption in ECB mode. This involves encrypting +the input with I, decrypting with the key schedule I, and +then encrypting with I. This routine greatly reduces the chances +of brute force breaking of DES and has the advantage of if I, +I and I are the same, it is equivalent to just encryption +using ECB mode and I as the key. + +The macro DES_ecb2_encrypt() is provided to perform two-key Triple-DES +encryption by using I for the final encryption. + +DES_ncbc_encrypt() encrypts/decrypts using the I +(CBC) mode of DES. If the I argument is non-zero, the +routine cipher-block-chain encrypts the cleartext data pointed to by +the I argument into the ciphertext pointed to by the I +argument, using the key schedule provided by the I argument, +and initialization vector provided by the I argument. If the +I argument is not an integral multiple of eight bytes, the +last block is copied to a temporary area and zero filled. The output +is always an integral multiple of eight bytes. + +DES_xcbc_encrypt() is RSA's DESX mode of DES. It uses I and +I to 'whiten' the encryption. I and I are secret +(unlike the iv) and are as such, part of the key. So the key is sort +of 24 bytes. This is much better than CBC DES. + +DES_ede3_cbc_encrypt() implements outer triple CBC DES encryption with +three keys. This means that each DES operation inside the CBC mode is +really an C. This mode is used by SSL. + +The DES_ede2_cbc_encrypt() macro implements two-key Triple-DES by +reusing I for the final encryption. C. +This form of Triple-DES is used by the RSAREF library. + +DES_pcbc_encrypt() encrypt/decrypts using the propagating cipher block +chaining mode used by Kerberos v4. Its parameters are the same as +DES_ncbc_encrypt(). + +DES_cfb_encrypt() encrypt/decrypts using cipher feedback mode. This +method takes an array of characters as input and outputs and array of +characters. It does not require any padding to 8 character groups. +Note: the I variable is changed and the new changed value needs to +be passed to the next call to this function. Since this function runs +a complete DES ECB encryption per I, this function is only +suggested for use when sending small numbers of characters. + +DES_cfb64_encrypt() +implements CFB mode of DES with 64bit feedback. Why is this +useful you ask? Because this routine will allow you to encrypt an +arbitrary number of bytes, no 8 byte padding. Each call to this +routine will encrypt the input bytes to output and then update ivec +and num. num contains 'how far' we are though ivec. If this does +not make much sense, read more about cfb mode of DES :-). + +DES_ede3_cfb64_encrypt() and DES_ede2_cfb64_encrypt() is the same as +DES_cfb64_encrypt() except that Triple-DES is used. + +DES_ofb_encrypt() encrypts using output feedback mode. This method +takes an array of characters as input and outputs and array of +characters. It does not require any padding to 8 character groups. +Note: the I variable is changed and the new changed value needs to +be passed to the next call to this function. Since this function runs +a complete DES ECB encryption per numbits, this function is only +suggested for use when sending small numbers of characters. + +DES_ofb64_encrypt() is the same as DES_cfb64_encrypt() using Output +Feed Back mode. + +DES_ede3_ofb64_encrypt() and DES_ede2_ofb64_encrypt() is the same as +DES_ofb64_encrypt(), using Triple-DES. + +The following functions are included in the DES library for +compatibility with the MIT Kerberos library. + +DES_cbc_cksum() produces an 8 byte checksum based on the input stream +(via CBC encryption). The last 4 bytes of the checksum are returned +and the complete 8 bytes are placed in I. This function is +used by Kerberos v4. Other applications should use +L etc. instead. + +DES_quad_cksum() is a Kerberos v4 function. It returns a 4 byte +checksum from the input bytes. The algorithm can be iterated over the +input, depending on I, 1, 2, 3 or 4 times. If I is +non-NULL, the 8 bytes generated by each pass are written into +I. + +The following are DES-based transformations: + +DES_fcrypt() is a fast version of the Unix crypt(3) function. This +version takes only a small amount of space relative to other fast +crypt() implementations. This is different to the normal crypt in +that the third parameter is the buffer that the return value is +written into. It needs to be at least 14 bytes long. This function +is thread safe, unlike the normal crypt. + +DES_crypt() is a faster replacement for the normal system crypt(). +This function calls DES_fcrypt() with a static array passed as the +third parameter. This emulates the normal non-thread safe semantics +of crypt(3). + +DES_enc_write() writes I bytes to file descriptor I from +buffer I. The data is encrypted via I (default) +using I for the key and I as a starting vector. The actual +data send down I consists of 4 bytes (in network byte order) +containing the length of the following encrypted data. The encrypted +data then follows, padded with random data out to a multiple of 8 +bytes. + +DES_enc_read() is used to read I bytes from file descriptor +I into buffer I. The data being read from I is assumed to +have come from DES_enc_write() and is decrypted using I for +the key schedule and I for the initial vector. + +B The data format used by DES_enc_write() and DES_enc_read() +has a cryptographic weakness: When asked to write more than MAXWRITE +bytes, DES_enc_write() will split the data into several chunks that +are all encrypted using the same IV. So don't use these functions +unless you are sure you know what you do (in which case you might not +want to use them anyway). They cannot handle non-blocking sockets. +DES_enc_read() uses an internal state and thus cannot be used on +multiple files. + +I is used to specify the encryption mode to use with +DES_enc_read() and DES_end_write(). If set to I (the +default), DES_pcbc_encrypt is used. If set to I +DES_cbc_encrypt is used. + +=head1 NOTES + +Single-key DES is insecure due to its short key size. ECB mode is +not suitable for most applications; see L. + +The L library provides higher-level encryption functions. + +=head1 BUGS + +DES_3cbc_encrypt() is flawed and must not be used in applications. + +DES_cbc_encrypt() does not modify B; use DES_ncbc_encrypt() +instead. + +DES_cfb_encrypt() and DES_ofb_encrypt() operates on input of 8 bits. +What this means is that if you set numbits to 12, and length to 2, the +first 12 bits will come from the 1st input byte and the low half of +the second input byte. The second 12 bits will have the low 8 bits +taken from the 3rd input byte and the top 4 bits taken from the 4th +input byte. The same holds for output. This function has been +implemented this way because most people will be using a multiple of 8 +and because once you get into pulling bytes input bytes apart things +get ugly! + +DES_string_to_key() is available for backward compatibility with the +MIT library. New applications should use a cryptographic hash function. +The same applies for DES_string_to_2key(). + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +ANSI X3.106 + +The B library was written to be source code compatible with +the MIT Kerberos library. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +crypt(3), L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +In OpenSSL 0.9.7, all des_ functions were renamed to DES_ to avoid +clashes with older versions of libdes. Compatibility des_ functions +are provided for a short while, as well as crypt(). +Declarations for these are in . There is no DES_ +variant for des_random_seed(). +This will happen to other functions +as well if they are deemed redundant (des_random_seed() just calls +RAND_seed() and is present for backward compatibility only), buggy or +already scheduled for removal. + +des_cbc_cksum(), des_cbc_encrypt(), des_ecb_encrypt(), +des_is_weak_key(), des_key_sched(), des_pcbc_encrypt(), +des_quad_cksum(), des_random_key() and des_string_to_key() +are available in the MIT Kerberos library; +des_check_key_parity(), des_fixup_key_parity() and des_is_weak_key() +are available in newer versions of that library. + +des_set_key_checked() and des_set_key_unchecked() were added in +OpenSSL 0.9.5. + +des_generate_random_block(), des_init_random_number_generator(), +des_new_random_key(), des_set_random_generator_seed() and +des_set_sequence_number() and des_rand_data() are used in newer +versions of Kerberos but are not implemented here. + +des_random_key() generated cryptographically weak random data in +SSLeay and in OpenSSL prior version 0.9.5, as well as in the original +MIT library. + +=head1 AUTHOR + +Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). Modified for the OpenSSL project +(http://www.openssl.org). + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/des_modes.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/des_modes.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e883ca8fd --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/des_modes.pod @@ -0,0 +1,255 @@ +=pod + +=for comment openssl_manual_section:7 + +=head1 NAME + +des_modes - the variants of DES and other crypto algorithms of OpenSSL + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +Several crypto algorithms for OpenSSL can be used in a number of modes. Those +are used for using block ciphers in a way similar to stream ciphers, among +other things. + +=head1 OVERVIEW + +=head2 Electronic Codebook Mode (ECB) + +Normally, this is found as the function I_ecb_encrypt(). + +=over 2 + +=item * + +64 bits are enciphered at a time. + +=item * + +The order of the blocks can be rearranged without detection. + +=item * + +The same plaintext block always produces the same ciphertext block +(for the same key) making it vulnerable to a 'dictionary attack'. + +=item * + +An error will only affect one ciphertext block. + +=back + +=head2 Cipher Block Chaining Mode (CBC) + +Normally, this is found as the function I_cbc_encrypt(). +Be aware that des_cbc_encrypt() is not really DES CBC (it does +not update the IV); use des_ncbc_encrypt() instead. + +=over 2 + +=item * + +a multiple of 64 bits are enciphered at a time. + +=item * + +The CBC mode produces the same ciphertext whenever the same +plaintext is encrypted using the same key and starting variable. + +=item * + +The chaining operation makes the ciphertext blocks dependent on the +current and all preceding plaintext blocks and therefore blocks can not +be rearranged. + +=item * + +The use of different starting variables prevents the same plaintext +enciphering to the same ciphertext. + +=item * + +An error will affect the current and the following ciphertext blocks. + +=back + +=head2 Cipher Feedback Mode (CFB) + +Normally, this is found as the function I_cfb_encrypt(). + +=over 2 + +=item * + +a number of bits (j) <= 64 are enciphered at a time. + +=item * + +The CFB mode produces the same ciphertext whenever the same +plaintext is encrypted using the same key and starting variable. + +=item * + +The chaining operation makes the ciphertext variables dependent on the +current and all preceding variables and therefore j-bit variables are +chained together and can not be rearranged. + +=item * + +The use of different starting variables prevents the same plaintext +enciphering to the same ciphertext. + +=item * + +The strength of the CFB mode depends on the size of k (maximal if +j == k). In my implementation this is always the case. + +=item * + +Selection of a small value for j will require more cycles through +the encipherment algorithm per unit of plaintext and thus cause +greater processing overheads. + +=item * + +Only multiples of j bits can be enciphered. + +=item * + +An error will affect the current and the following ciphertext variables. + +=back + +=head2 Output Feedback Mode (OFB) + +Normally, this is found as the function I_ofb_encrypt(). + +=over 2 + + +=item * + +a number of bits (j) <= 64 are enciphered at a time. + +=item * + +The OFB mode produces the same ciphertext whenever the same +plaintext enciphered using the same key and starting variable. More +over, in the OFB mode the same key stream is produced when the same +key and start variable are used. Consequently, for security reasons +a specific start variable should be used only once for a given key. + +=item * + +The absence of chaining makes the OFB more vulnerable to specific attacks. + +=item * + +The use of different start variables values prevents the same +plaintext enciphering to the same ciphertext, by producing different +key streams. + +=item * + +Selection of a small value for j will require more cycles through +the encipherment algorithm per unit of plaintext and thus cause +greater processing overheads. + +=item * + +Only multiples of j bits can be enciphered. + +=item * + +OFB mode of operation does not extend ciphertext errors in the +resultant plaintext output. Every bit error in the ciphertext causes +only one bit to be in error in the deciphered plaintext. + +=item * + +OFB mode is not self-synchronizing. If the two operation of +encipherment and decipherment get out of synchronism, the system needs +to be re-initialized. + +=item * + +Each re-initialization should use a value of the start variable +different from the start variable values used before with the same +key. The reason for this is that an identical bit stream would be +produced each time from the same parameters. This would be +susceptible to a 'known plaintext' attack. + +=back + +=head2 Triple ECB Mode + +Normally, this is found as the function I_ecb3_encrypt(). + +=over 2 + +=item * + +Encrypt with key1, decrypt with key2 and encrypt with key3 again. + +=item * + +As for ECB encryption but increases the key length to 168 bits. +There are theoretic attacks that can be used that make the effective +key length 112 bits, but this attack also requires 2^56 blocks of +memory, not very likely, even for the NSA. + +=item * + +If both keys are the same it is equivalent to encrypting once with +just one key. + +=item * + +If the first and last key are the same, the key length is 112 bits. +There are attacks that could reduce the effective key strength +to only slightly more than 56 bits, but these require a lot of memory. + +=item * + +If all 3 keys are the same, this is effectively the same as normal +ecb mode. + +=back + +=head2 Triple CBC Mode + +Normally, this is found as the function I_ede3_cbc_encrypt(). + +=over 2 + + +=item * + +Encrypt with key1, decrypt with key2 and then encrypt with key3. + +=item * + +As for CBC encryption but increases the key length to 168 bits with +the same restrictions as for triple ecb mode. + +=back + +=head1 NOTES + +This text was been written in large parts by Eric Young in his original +documentation for SSLeay, the predecessor of OpenSSL. In turn, he attributed +it to: + + AS 2805.5.2 + Australian Standard + Electronic funds transfer - Requirements for interfaces, + Part 5.2: Modes of operation for an n-bit block cipher algorithm + Appendix A + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, +L + +=cut + diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/dh.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/dh.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..c3ccd0620 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/dh.pod @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +dh - Diffie-Hellman key agreement + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + DH * DH_new(void); + void DH_free(DH *dh); + + int DH_size(const DH *dh); + + DH * DH_generate_parameters(int prime_len, int generator, + void (*callback)(int, int, void *), void *cb_arg); + int DH_check(const DH *dh, int *codes); + + int DH_generate_key(DH *dh); + int DH_compute_key(unsigned char *key, BIGNUM *pub_key, DH *dh); + + void DH_set_default_method(const DH_METHOD *meth); + const DH_METHOD *DH_get_default_method(void); + int DH_set_method(DH *dh, const DH_METHOD *meth); + DH *DH_new_method(ENGINE *engine); + const DH_METHOD *DH_OpenSSL(void); + + int DH_get_ex_new_index(long argl, char *argp, int (*new_func)(), + int (*dup_func)(), void (*free_func)()); + int DH_set_ex_data(DH *d, int idx, char *arg); + char *DH_get_ex_data(DH *d, int idx); + + DH * d2i_DHparams(DH **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_DHparams(const DH *a, unsigned char **pp); + + int DHparams_print_fp(FILE *fp, const DH *x); + int DHparams_print(BIO *bp, const DH *x); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions implement the Diffie-Hellman key agreement protocol. +The generation of shared DH parameters is described in +L; L describes how +to perform a key agreement. + +The B structure consists of several BIGNUM components. + + struct + { + BIGNUM *p; // prime number (shared) + BIGNUM *g; // generator of Z_p (shared) + BIGNUM *priv_key; // private DH value x + BIGNUM *pub_key; // public DH value g^x + // ... + }; + DH + +Note that DH keys may use non-standard B implementations, +either directly or by the use of B modules. In some cases (eg. an +ENGINE providing support for hardware-embedded keys), these BIGNUM values +will not be used by the implementation or may be used for alternative data +storage. For this reason, applications should generally avoid using DH +structure elements directly and instead use API functions to query or +modify keys. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L, L, +L, +L, +L, L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/dsa.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/dsa.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..da07d2b93 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/dsa.pod @@ -0,0 +1,114 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +dsa - Digital Signature Algorithm + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + DSA * DSA_new(void); + void DSA_free(DSA *dsa); + + int DSA_size(const DSA *dsa); + + DSA * DSA_generate_parameters(int bits, unsigned char *seed, + int seed_len, int *counter_ret, unsigned long *h_ret, + void (*callback)(int, int, void *), void *cb_arg); + + DH * DSA_dup_DH(const DSA *r); + + int DSA_generate_key(DSA *dsa); + + int DSA_sign(int dummy, const unsigned char *dgst, int len, + unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, DSA *dsa); + int DSA_sign_setup(DSA *dsa, BN_CTX *ctx, BIGNUM **kinvp, + BIGNUM **rp); + int DSA_verify(int dummy, const unsigned char *dgst, int len, + const unsigned char *sigbuf, int siglen, DSA *dsa); + + void DSA_set_default_method(const DSA_METHOD *meth); + const DSA_METHOD *DSA_get_default_method(void); + int DSA_set_method(DSA *dsa, const DSA_METHOD *meth); + DSA *DSA_new_method(ENGINE *engine); + const DSA_METHOD *DSA_OpenSSL(void); + + int DSA_get_ex_new_index(long argl, char *argp, int (*new_func)(), + int (*dup_func)(), void (*free_func)()); + int DSA_set_ex_data(DSA *d, int idx, char *arg); + char *DSA_get_ex_data(DSA *d, int idx); + + DSA_SIG *DSA_SIG_new(void); + void DSA_SIG_free(DSA_SIG *a); + int i2d_DSA_SIG(const DSA_SIG *a, unsigned char **pp); + DSA_SIG *d2i_DSA_SIG(DSA_SIG **v, unsigned char **pp, long length); + + DSA_SIG *DSA_do_sign(const unsigned char *dgst, int dlen, DSA *dsa); + int DSA_do_verify(const unsigned char *dgst, int dgst_len, + DSA_SIG *sig, DSA *dsa); + + DSA * d2i_DSAPublicKey(DSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + DSA * d2i_DSAPrivateKey(DSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + DSA * d2i_DSAparams(DSA **a, unsigned char **pp, long length); + int i2d_DSAPublicKey(const DSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + int i2d_DSAPrivateKey(const DSA *a, unsigned char **pp); + int i2d_DSAparams(const DSA *a,unsigned char **pp); + + int DSAparams_print(BIO *bp, const DSA *x); + int DSAparams_print_fp(FILE *fp, const DSA *x); + int DSA_print(BIO *bp, const DSA *x, int off); + int DSA_print_fp(FILE *bp, const DSA *x, int off); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions implement the Digital Signature Algorithm (DSA). The +generation of shared DSA parameters is described in +L; +L describes how to +generate a signature key. Signature generation and verification are +described in L. + +The B structure consists of several BIGNUM components. + + struct + { + BIGNUM *p; // prime number (public) + BIGNUM *q; // 160-bit subprime, q | p-1 (public) + BIGNUM *g; // generator of subgroup (public) + BIGNUM *priv_key; // private key x + BIGNUM *pub_key; // public key y = g^x + // ... + } + DSA; + +In public keys, B is NULL. + +Note that DSA keys may use non-standard B implementations, +either directly or by the use of B modules. In some cases (eg. an +ENGINE providing support for hardware-embedded keys), these BIGNUM values +will not be used by the implementation or may be used for alternative data +storage. For this reason, applications should generally avoid using DSA +structure elements directly and instead use API functions to query or +modify keys. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +US Federal Information Processing Standard FIPS 186 (Digital Signature +Standard, DSS), ANSI X9.30 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, L, +L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ecdsa.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ecdsa.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..49b10f224 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ecdsa.pod @@ -0,0 +1,210 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +ecdsa - Elliptic Curve Digital Signature Algorithm + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + ECDSA_SIG* ECDSA_SIG_new(void); + void ECDSA_SIG_free(ECDSA_SIG *sig); + int i2d_ECDSA_SIG(const ECDSA_SIG *sig, unsigned char **pp); + ECDSA_SIG* d2i_ECDSA_SIG(ECDSA_SIG **sig, const unsigned char **pp, + long len); + + ECDSA_SIG* ECDSA_do_sign(const unsigned char *dgst, int dgst_len, + EC_KEY *eckey); + ECDSA_SIG* ECDSA_do_sign_ex(const unsigned char *dgst, int dgstlen, + const BIGNUM *kinv, const BIGNUM *rp, + EC_KEY *eckey); + int ECDSA_do_verify(const unsigned char *dgst, int dgst_len, + const ECDSA_SIG *sig, EC_KEY* eckey); + int ECDSA_sign_setup(EC_KEY *eckey, BN_CTX *ctx, + BIGNUM **kinv, BIGNUM **rp); + int ECDSA_sign(int type, const unsigned char *dgst, + int dgstlen, unsigned char *sig, + unsigned int *siglen, EC_KEY *eckey); + int ECDSA_sign_ex(int type, const unsigned char *dgst, + int dgstlen, unsigned char *sig, + unsigned int *siglen, const BIGNUM *kinv, + const BIGNUM *rp, EC_KEY *eckey); + int ECDSA_verify(int type, const unsigned char *dgst, + int dgstlen, const unsigned char *sig, + int siglen, EC_KEY *eckey); + int ECDSA_size(const EC_KEY *eckey); + + const ECDSA_METHOD* ECDSA_OpenSSL(void); + void ECDSA_set_default_method(const ECDSA_METHOD *meth); + const ECDSA_METHOD* ECDSA_get_default_method(void); + int ECDSA_set_method(EC_KEY *eckey,const ECDSA_METHOD *meth); + + int ECDSA_get_ex_new_index(long argl, void *argp, + CRYPTO_EX_new *new_func, + CRYPTO_EX_dup *dup_func, + CRYPTO_EX_free *free_func); + int ECDSA_set_ex_data(EC_KEY *d, int idx, void *arg); + void* ECDSA_get_ex_data(EC_KEY *d, int idx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The B structure consists of two BIGNUMs for the +r and s value of a ECDSA signature (see X9.62 or FIPS 186-2). + + struct + { + BIGNUM *r; + BIGNUM *s; + } ECDSA_SIG; + +ECDSA_SIG_new() allocates a new B structure (note: this +function also allocates the BIGNUMs) and initialize it. + +ECDSA_SIG_free() frees the B structure B. + +i2d_ECDSA_SIG() creates the DER encoding of the ECDSA signature +B and writes the encoded signature to B<*pp> (note: if B +is NULL B returns the expected length in bytes of +the DER encoded signature). B returns the length +of the DER encoded signature (or 0 on error). + +d2i_ECDSA_SIG() decodes a DER encoded ECDSA signature and returns +the decoded signature in a newly allocated B structure. +B<*sig> points to the buffer containing the DER encoded signature +of size B. + +ECDSA_size() returns the maximum length of a DER encoded +ECDSA signature created with the private EC key B. + +ECDSA_sign_setup() may be used to precompute parts of the +signing operation. B is the private EC key and B +is a pointer to B structure (or NULL). The precomputed +values or returned in B and B and can be used in a +later call to B or B. + +ECDSA_sign() is wrapper function for ECDSA_sign_ex with B +and B set to NULL. + +ECDSA_sign_ex() computes a digital signature of the B bytes +hash value B using the private EC key B and the optional +pre-computed values B and B. The DER encoded signatures is +stored in B and it's length is returned in B. Note: B +must point to B bytes of memory. The parameter B +is ignored. + +ECDSA_verify() verifies that the signature in B of size +B is a valid ECDSA signature of the hash value +value B of size B using the public key B. +The parameter B is ignored. + +ECDSA_do_sign() is wrapper function for ECDSA_do_sign_ex with B +and B set to NULL. + +ECDSA_do_sign_ex() computes a digital signature of the B +bytes hash value B using the private key B and the +optional pre-computed values B and B. The signature is +returned in a newly allocated B structure (or NULL on error). + +ECDSA_do_verify() verifies that the signature B is a valid +ECDSA signature of the hash value B of size B +using the public key B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +ECDSA_size() returns the maximum length signature or 0 on error. + +ECDSA_sign_setup() and ECDSA_sign() return 1 if successful or -1 +on error. + +ECDSA_verify() and ECDSA_do_verify() return 1 for a valid +signature, 0 for an invalid signature and -1 on error. +The error codes can be obtained by L. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Creating a ECDSA signature of given SHA-1 hash value using the +named curve secp192k1. + +First step: create a EC_KEY object (note: this part is B ECDSA +specific) + + int ret; + ECDSA_SIG *sig; + EC_KEY *eckey = EC_KEY_new(); + if (eckey == NULL) + { + /* error */ + } + key->group = EC_GROUP_new_by_nid(NID_secp192k1); + if (key->group == NULL) + { + /* error */ + } + if (!EC_KEY_generate_key(eckey)) + { + /* error */ + } + +Second step: compute the ECDSA signature of a SHA-1 hash value +using B + + sig = ECDSA_do_sign(digest, 20, eckey); + if (sig == NULL) + { + /* error */ + } + +or using B + + unsigned char *buffer, *pp; + int buf_len; + buf_len = ECDSA_size(eckey); + buffer = OPENSSL_malloc(buf_len); + pp = buffer; + if (!ECDSA_sign(0, dgst, dgstlen, pp, &buf_len, eckey); + { + /* error */ + } + +Third step: verify the created ECDSA signature using B + + ret = ECDSA_do_verify(digest, 20, sig, eckey); + +or using B + + ret = ECDSA_verify(0, digest, 20, buffer, buf_len, eckey); + +and finally evaluate the return value: + + if (ret == -1) + { + /* error */ + } + else if (ret == 0) + { + /* incorrect signature */ + } + else /* ret == 1 */ + { + /* signature ok */ + } + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +ANSI X9.62, US Federal Information Processing Standard FIPS 186-2 +(Digital Signature Standard, DSS) + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The ecdsa implementation was first introduced in OpenSSL 0.9.8 + +=head1 AUTHOR + +Nils Larsch for the OpenSSL project (http://www.openssl.org). + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/engine.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/engine.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..f5ab1c3e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/engine.pod @@ -0,0 +1,599 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +engine - ENGINE cryptographic module support + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_first(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_last(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_next(ENGINE *e); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_prev(ENGINE *e); + + int ENGINE_add(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_remove(ENGINE *e); + + ENGINE *ENGINE_by_id(const char *id); + + int ENGINE_init(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_finish(ENGINE *e); + + void ENGINE_load_openssl(void); + void ENGINE_load_dynamic(void); + #ifndef OPENSSL_NO_STATIC_ENGINE + void ENGINE_load_4758cca(void); + void ENGINE_load_aep(void); + void ENGINE_load_atalla(void); + void ENGINE_load_chil(void); + void ENGINE_load_cswift(void); + void ENGINE_load_gmp(void); + void ENGINE_load_nuron(void); + void ENGINE_load_sureware(void); + void ENGINE_load_ubsec(void); + #endif + void ENGINE_load_cryptodev(void); + void ENGINE_load_builtin_engines(void); + + void ENGINE_cleanup(void); + + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_default_RSA(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_default_DSA(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_default_ECDH(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_default_ECDSA(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_default_DH(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_default_RAND(void); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_cipher_engine(int nid); + ENGINE *ENGINE_get_digest_engine(int nid); + + int ENGINE_set_default_RSA(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_DSA(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_ECDH(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_ECDSA(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_DH(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_RAND(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_ciphers(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_digests(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_set_default_string(ENGINE *e, const char *list); + + int ENGINE_set_default(ENGINE *e, unsigned int flags); + + unsigned int ENGINE_get_table_flags(void); + void ENGINE_set_table_flags(unsigned int flags); + + int ENGINE_register_RSA(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_RSA(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_RSA(void); + int ENGINE_register_DSA(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_DSA(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_DSA(void); + int ENGINE_register_ECDH(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_ECDH(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_ECDH(void); + int ENGINE_register_ECDSA(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_ECDSA(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_ECDSA(void); + int ENGINE_register_DH(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_DH(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_DH(void); + int ENGINE_register_RAND(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_RAND(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_RAND(void); + int ENGINE_register_STORE(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_STORE(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_STORE(void); + int ENGINE_register_ciphers(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_ciphers(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_ciphers(void); + int ENGINE_register_digests(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_unregister_digests(ENGINE *e); + void ENGINE_register_all_digests(void); + int ENGINE_register_complete(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_register_all_complete(void); + + int ENGINE_ctrl(ENGINE *e, int cmd, long i, void *p, void (*f)(void)); + int ENGINE_cmd_is_executable(ENGINE *e, int cmd); + int ENGINE_ctrl_cmd(ENGINE *e, const char *cmd_name, + long i, void *p, void (*f)(void), int cmd_optional); + int ENGINE_ctrl_cmd_string(ENGINE *e, const char *cmd_name, const char *arg, + int cmd_optional); + + int ENGINE_set_ex_data(ENGINE *e, int idx, void *arg); + void *ENGINE_get_ex_data(const ENGINE *e, int idx); + + int ENGINE_get_ex_new_index(long argl, void *argp, CRYPTO_EX_new *new_func, + CRYPTO_EX_dup *dup_func, CRYPTO_EX_free *free_func); + + ENGINE *ENGINE_new(void); + int ENGINE_free(ENGINE *e); + int ENGINE_up_ref(ENGINE *e); + + int ENGINE_set_id(ENGINE *e, const char *id); + int ENGINE_set_name(ENGINE *e, const char *name); + int ENGINE_set_RSA(ENGINE *e, const RSA_METHOD *rsa_meth); + int ENGINE_set_DSA(ENGINE *e, const DSA_METHOD *dsa_meth); + int ENGINE_set_ECDH(ENGINE *e, const ECDH_METHOD *dh_meth); + int ENGINE_set_ECDSA(ENGINE *e, const ECDSA_METHOD *dh_meth); + int ENGINE_set_DH(ENGINE *e, const DH_METHOD *dh_meth); + int ENGINE_set_RAND(ENGINE *e, const RAND_METHOD *rand_meth); + int ENGINE_set_STORE(ENGINE *e, const STORE_METHOD *rand_meth); + int ENGINE_set_destroy_function(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_GEN_INT_FUNC_PTR destroy_f); + int ENGINE_set_init_function(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_GEN_INT_FUNC_PTR init_f); + int ENGINE_set_finish_function(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_GEN_INT_FUNC_PTR finish_f); + int ENGINE_set_ctrl_function(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_CTRL_FUNC_PTR ctrl_f); + int ENGINE_set_load_privkey_function(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_LOAD_KEY_PTR loadpriv_f); + int ENGINE_set_load_pubkey_function(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_LOAD_KEY_PTR loadpub_f); + int ENGINE_set_ciphers(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_CIPHERS_PTR f); + int ENGINE_set_digests(ENGINE *e, ENGINE_DIGESTS_PTR f); + int ENGINE_set_flags(ENGINE *e, int flags); + int ENGINE_set_cmd_defns(ENGINE *e, const ENGINE_CMD_DEFN *defns); + + const char *ENGINE_get_id(const ENGINE *e); + const char *ENGINE_get_name(const ENGINE *e); + const RSA_METHOD *ENGINE_get_RSA(const ENGINE *e); + const DSA_METHOD *ENGINE_get_DSA(const ENGINE *e); + const ECDH_METHOD *ENGINE_get_ECDH(const ENGINE *e); + const ECDSA_METHOD *ENGINE_get_ECDSA(const ENGINE *e); + const DH_METHOD *ENGINE_get_DH(const ENGINE *e); + const RAND_METHOD *ENGINE_get_RAND(const ENGINE *e); + const STORE_METHOD *ENGINE_get_STORE(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_GEN_INT_FUNC_PTR ENGINE_get_destroy_function(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_GEN_INT_FUNC_PTR ENGINE_get_init_function(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_GEN_INT_FUNC_PTR ENGINE_get_finish_function(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_CTRL_FUNC_PTR ENGINE_get_ctrl_function(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_LOAD_KEY_PTR ENGINE_get_load_privkey_function(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_LOAD_KEY_PTR ENGINE_get_load_pubkey_function(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_CIPHERS_PTR ENGINE_get_ciphers(const ENGINE *e); + ENGINE_DIGESTS_PTR ENGINE_get_digests(const ENGINE *e); + const EVP_CIPHER *ENGINE_get_cipher(ENGINE *e, int nid); + const EVP_MD *ENGINE_get_digest(ENGINE *e, int nid); + int ENGINE_get_flags(const ENGINE *e); + const ENGINE_CMD_DEFN *ENGINE_get_cmd_defns(const ENGINE *e); + + EVP_PKEY *ENGINE_load_private_key(ENGINE *e, const char *key_id, + UI_METHOD *ui_method, void *callback_data); + EVP_PKEY *ENGINE_load_public_key(ENGINE *e, const char *key_id, + UI_METHOD *ui_method, void *callback_data); + + void ENGINE_add_conf_module(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions create, manipulate, and use cryptographic modules in the +form of B objects. These objects act as containers for +implementations of cryptographic algorithms, and support a +reference-counted mechanism to allow them to be dynamically loaded in and +out of the running application. + +The cryptographic functionality that can be provided by an B +implementation includes the following abstractions; + + RSA_METHOD - for providing alternative RSA implementations + DSA_METHOD, DH_METHOD, RAND_METHOD, ECDH_METHOD, ECDSA_METHOD, + STORE_METHOD - similarly for other OpenSSL APIs + EVP_CIPHER - potentially multiple cipher algorithms (indexed by 'nid') + EVP_DIGEST - potentially multiple hash algorithms (indexed by 'nid') + key-loading - loading public and/or private EVP_PKEY keys + +=head2 Reference counting and handles + +Due to the modular nature of the ENGINE API, pointers to ENGINEs need to be +treated as handles - ie. not only as pointers, but also as references to +the underlying ENGINE object. Ie. one should obtain a new reference when +making copies of an ENGINE pointer if the copies will be used (and +released) independently. + +ENGINE objects have two levels of reference-counting to match the way in +which the objects are used. At the most basic level, each ENGINE pointer is +inherently a B reference - a structural reference is required +to use the pointer value at all, as this kind of reference is a guarantee +that the structure can not be deallocated until the reference is released. + +However, a structural reference provides no guarantee that the ENGINE is +initiliased and able to use any of its cryptographic +implementations. Indeed it's quite possible that most ENGINEs will not +initialise at all in typical environments, as ENGINEs are typically used to +support specialised hardware. To use an ENGINE's functionality, you need a +B reference. This kind of reference can be considered a +specialised form of structural reference, because each functional reference +implicitly contains a structural reference as well - however to avoid +difficult-to-find programming bugs, it is recommended to treat the two +kinds of reference independently. If you have a functional reference to an +ENGINE, you have a guarantee that the ENGINE has been initialised ready to +perform cryptographic operations and will remain uninitialised +until after you have released your reference. + +I + +This basic type of reference is used for instantiating new ENGINEs, +iterating across OpenSSL's internal linked-list of loaded +ENGINEs, reading information about an ENGINE, etc. Essentially a structural +reference is sufficient if you only need to query or manipulate the data of +an ENGINE implementation rather than use its functionality. + +The ENGINE_new() function returns a structural reference to a new (empty) +ENGINE object. There are other ENGINE API functions that return structural +references such as; ENGINE_by_id(), ENGINE_get_first(), ENGINE_get_last(), +ENGINE_get_next(), ENGINE_get_prev(). All structural references should be +released by a corresponding to call to the ENGINE_free() function - the +ENGINE object itself will only actually be cleaned up and deallocated when +the last structural reference is released. + +It should also be noted that many ENGINE API function calls that accept a +structural reference will internally obtain another reference - typically +this happens whenever the supplied ENGINE will be needed by OpenSSL after +the function has returned. Eg. the function to add a new ENGINE to +OpenSSL's internal list is ENGINE_add() - if this function returns success, +then OpenSSL will have stored a new structural reference internally so the +caller is still responsible for freeing their own reference with +ENGINE_free() when they are finished with it. In a similar way, some +functions will automatically release the structural reference passed to it +if part of the function's job is to do so. Eg. the ENGINE_get_next() and +ENGINE_get_prev() functions are used for iterating across the internal +ENGINE list - they will return a new structural reference to the next (or +previous) ENGINE in the list or NULL if at the end (or beginning) of the +list, but in either case the structural reference passed to the function is +released on behalf of the caller. + +To clarify a particular function's handling of references, one should +always consult that function's documentation "man" page, or failing that +the openssl/engine.h header file includes some hints. + +I + +As mentioned, functional references exist when the cryptographic +functionality of an ENGINE is required to be available. A functional +reference can be obtained in one of two ways; from an existing structural +reference to the required ENGINE, or by asking OpenSSL for the default +operational ENGINE for a given cryptographic purpose. + +To obtain a functional reference from an existing structural reference, +call the ENGINE_init() function. This returns zero if the ENGINE was not +already operational and couldn't be successfully initialised (eg. lack of +system drivers, no special hardware attached, etc), otherwise it will +return non-zero to indicate that the ENGINE is now operational and will +have allocated a new B reference to the ENGINE. All functional +references are released by calling ENGINE_finish() (which removes the +implicit structural reference as well). + +The second way to get a functional reference is by asking OpenSSL for a +default implementation for a given task, eg. by ENGINE_get_default_RSA(), +ENGINE_get_default_cipher_engine(), etc. These are discussed in the next +section, though they are not usually required by application programmers as +they are used automatically when creating and using the relevant +algorithm-specific types in OpenSSL, such as RSA, DSA, EVP_CIPHER_CTX, etc. + +=head2 Default implementations + +For each supported abstraction, the ENGINE code maintains an internal table +of state to control which implementations are available for a given +abstraction and which should be used by default. These implementations are +registered in the tables and indexed by an 'nid' value, because +abstractions like EVP_CIPHER and EVP_DIGEST support many distinct +algorithms and modes, and ENGINEs can support arbitrarily many of them. +In the case of other abstractions like RSA, DSA, etc, there is only one +"algorithm" so all implementations implicitly register using the same 'nid' +index. + +When a default ENGINE is requested for a given abstraction/algorithm/mode, (eg. +when calling RSA_new_method(NULL)), a "get_default" call will be made to the +ENGINE subsystem to process the corresponding state table and return a +functional reference to an initialised ENGINE whose implementation should be +used. If no ENGINE should (or can) be used, it will return NULL and the caller +will operate with a NULL ENGINE handle - this usually equates to using the +conventional software implementation. In the latter case, OpenSSL will from +then on behave the way it used to before the ENGINE API existed. + +Each state table has a flag to note whether it has processed this +"get_default" query since the table was last modified, because to process +this question it must iterate across all the registered ENGINEs in the +table trying to initialise each of them in turn, in case one of them is +operational. If it returns a functional reference to an ENGINE, it will +also cache another reference to speed up processing future queries (without +needing to iterate across the table). Likewise, it will cache a NULL +response if no ENGINE was available so that future queries won't repeat the +same iteration unless the state table changes. This behaviour can also be +changed; if the ENGINE_TABLE_FLAG_NOINIT flag is set (using +ENGINE_set_table_flags()), no attempted initialisations will take place, +instead the only way for the state table to return a non-NULL ENGINE to the +"get_default" query will be if one is expressly set in the table. Eg. +ENGINE_set_default_RSA() does the same job as ENGINE_register_RSA() except +that it also sets the state table's cached response for the "get_default" +query. In the case of abstractions like EVP_CIPHER, where implementations are +indexed by 'nid', these flags and cached-responses are distinct for each 'nid' +value. + +=head2 Application requirements + +This section will explain the basic things an application programmer should +support to make the most useful elements of the ENGINE functionality +available to the user. The first thing to consider is whether the +programmer wishes to make alternative ENGINE modules available to the +application and user. OpenSSL maintains an internal linked list of +"visible" ENGINEs from which it has to operate - at start-up, this list is +empty and in fact if an application does not call any ENGINE API calls and +it uses static linking against openssl, then the resulting application +binary will not contain any alternative ENGINE code at all. So the first +consideration is whether any/all available ENGINE implementations should be +made visible to OpenSSL - this is controlled by calling the various "load" +functions, eg. + + /* Make the "dynamic" ENGINE available */ + void ENGINE_load_dynamic(void); + /* Make the CryptoSwift hardware acceleration support available */ + void ENGINE_load_cswift(void); + /* Make support for nCipher's "CHIL" hardware available */ + void ENGINE_load_chil(void); + ... + /* Make ALL ENGINE implementations bundled with OpenSSL available */ + void ENGINE_load_builtin_engines(void); + +Having called any of these functions, ENGINE objects would have been +dynamically allocated and populated with these implementations and linked +into OpenSSL's internal linked list. At this point it is important to +mention an important API function; + + void ENGINE_cleanup(void); + +If no ENGINE API functions are called at all in an application, then there +are no inherent memory leaks to worry about from the ENGINE functionality, +however if any ENGINEs are loaded, even if they are never registered or +used, it is necessary to use the ENGINE_cleanup() function to +correspondingly cleanup before program exit, if the caller wishes to avoid +memory leaks. This mechanism uses an internal callback registration table +so that any ENGINE API functionality that knows it requires cleanup can +register its cleanup details to be called during ENGINE_cleanup(). This +approach allows ENGINE_cleanup() to clean up after any ENGINE functionality +at all that your program uses, yet doesn't automatically create linker +dependencies to all possible ENGINE functionality - only the cleanup +callbacks required by the functionality you do use will be required by the +linker. + +The fact that ENGINEs are made visible to OpenSSL (and thus are linked into +the program and loaded into memory at run-time) does not mean they are +"registered" or called into use by OpenSSL automatically - that behaviour +is something for the application to control. Some applications +will want to allow the user to specify exactly which ENGINE they want used +if any is to be used at all. Others may prefer to load all support and have +OpenSSL automatically use at run-time any ENGINE that is able to +successfully initialise - ie. to assume that this corresponds to +acceleration hardware attached to the machine or some such thing. There are +probably numerous other ways in which applications may prefer to handle +things, so we will simply illustrate the consequences as they apply to a +couple of simple cases and leave developers to consider these and the +source code to openssl's builtin utilities as guides. + +I + +Here we'll assume an application has been configured by its user or admin +to want to use the "ACME" ENGINE if it is available in the version of +OpenSSL the application was compiled with. If it is available, it should be +used by default for all RSA, DSA, and symmetric cipher operation, otherwise +OpenSSL should use its builtin software as per usual. The following code +illustrates how to approach this; + + ENGINE *e; + const char *engine_id = "ACME"; + ENGINE_load_builtin_engines(); + e = ENGINE_by_id(engine_id); + if(!e) + /* the engine isn't available */ + return; + if(!ENGINE_init(e)) { + /* the engine couldn't initialise, release 'e' */ + ENGINE_free(e); + return; + } + if(!ENGINE_set_default_RSA(e)) + /* This should only happen when 'e' can't initialise, but the previous + * statement suggests it did. */ + abort(); + ENGINE_set_default_DSA(e); + ENGINE_set_default_ciphers(e); + /* Release the functional reference from ENGINE_init() */ + ENGINE_finish(e); + /* Release the structural reference from ENGINE_by_id() */ + ENGINE_free(e); + +I + +Here we'll assume we want to load and register all ENGINE implementations +bundled with OpenSSL, such that for any cryptographic algorithm required by +OpenSSL - if there is an ENGINE that implements it and can be initialise, +it should be used. The following code illustrates how this can work; + + /* Load all bundled ENGINEs into memory and make them visible */ + ENGINE_load_builtin_engines(); + /* Register all of them for every algorithm they collectively implement */ + ENGINE_register_all_complete(); + +That's all that's required. Eg. the next time OpenSSL tries to set up an +RSA key, any bundled ENGINEs that implement RSA_METHOD will be passed to +ENGINE_init() and if any of those succeed, that ENGINE will be set as the +default for RSA use from then on. + +=head2 Advanced configuration support + +There is a mechanism supported by the ENGINE framework that allows each +ENGINE implementation to define an arbitrary set of configuration +"commands" and expose them to OpenSSL and any applications based on +OpenSSL. This mechanism is entirely based on the use of name-value pairs +and assumes ASCII input (no unicode or UTF for now!), so it is ideal if +applications want to provide a transparent way for users to provide +arbitrary configuration "directives" directly to such ENGINEs. It is also +possible for the application to dynamically interrogate the loaded ENGINE +implementations for the names, descriptions, and input flags of their +available "control commands", providing a more flexible configuration +scheme. However, if the user is expected to know which ENGINE device he/she +is using (in the case of specialised hardware, this goes without saying) +then applications may not need to concern themselves with discovering the +supported control commands and simply prefer to pass settings into ENGINEs +exactly as they are provided by the user. + +Before illustrating how control commands work, it is worth mentioning what +they are typically used for. Broadly speaking there are two uses for +control commands; the first is to provide the necessary details to the +implementation (which may know nothing at all specific to the host system) +so that it can be initialised for use. This could include the path to any +driver or config files it needs to load, required network addresses, +smart-card identifiers, passwords to initialise protected devices, +logging information, etc etc. This class of commands typically needs to be +passed to an ENGINE B attempting to initialise it, ie. before +calling ENGINE_init(). The other class of commands consist of settings or +operations that tweak certain behaviour or cause certain operations to take +place, and these commands may work either before or after ENGINE_init(), or +in some cases both. ENGINE implementations should provide indications of +this in the descriptions attached to builtin control commands and/or in +external product documentation. + +I + +Let's illustrate by example; a function for which the caller supplies the +name of the ENGINE it wishes to use, a table of string-pairs for use before +initialisation, and another table for use after initialisation. Note that +the string-pairs used for control commands consist of a command "name" +followed by the command "parameter" - the parameter could be NULL in some +cases but the name can not. This function should initialise the ENGINE +(issuing the "pre" commands beforehand and the "post" commands afterwards) +and set it as the default for everything except RAND and then return a +boolean success or failure. + + int generic_load_engine_fn(const char *engine_id, + const char **pre_cmds, int pre_num, + const char **post_cmds, int post_num) + { + ENGINE *e = ENGINE_by_id(engine_id); + if(!e) return 0; + while(pre_num--) { + if(!ENGINE_ctrl_cmd_string(e, pre_cmds[0], pre_cmds[1], 0)) { + fprintf(stderr, "Failed command (%s - %s:%s)\n", engine_id, + pre_cmds[0], pre_cmds[1] ? pre_cmds[1] : "(NULL)"); + ENGINE_free(e); + return 0; + } + pre_cmds += 2; + } + if(!ENGINE_init(e)) { + fprintf(stderr, "Failed initialisation\n"); + ENGINE_free(e); + return 0; + } + /* ENGINE_init() returned a functional reference, so free the structural + * reference from ENGINE_by_id(). */ + ENGINE_free(e); + while(post_num--) { + if(!ENGINE_ctrl_cmd_string(e, post_cmds[0], post_cmds[1], 0)) { + fprintf(stderr, "Failed command (%s - %s:%s)\n", engine_id, + post_cmds[0], post_cmds[1] ? post_cmds[1] : "(NULL)"); + ENGINE_finish(e); + return 0; + } + post_cmds += 2; + } + ENGINE_set_default(e, ENGINE_METHOD_ALL & ~ENGINE_METHOD_RAND); + /* Success */ + return 1; + } + +Note that ENGINE_ctrl_cmd_string() accepts a boolean argument that can +relax the semantics of the function - if set non-zero it will only return +failure if the ENGINE supported the given command name but failed while +executing it, if the ENGINE doesn't support the command name it will simply +return success without doing anything. In this case we assume the user is +only supplying commands specific to the given ENGINE so we set this to +FALSE. + +I + +It is possible to discover at run-time the names, numerical-ids, descriptions +and input parameters of the control commands supported by an ENGINE using a +structural reference. Note that some control commands are defined by OpenSSL +itself and it will intercept and handle these control commands on behalf of the +ENGINE, ie. the ENGINE's ctrl() handler is not used for the control command. +openssl/engine.h defines an index, ENGINE_CMD_BASE, that all control commands +implemented by ENGINEs should be numbered from. Any command value lower than +this symbol is considered a "generic" command is handled directly by the +OpenSSL core routines. + +It is using these "core" control commands that one can discover the the control +commands implemented by a given ENGINE, specifically the commands; + + #define ENGINE_HAS_CTRL_FUNCTION 10 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_FIRST_CMD_TYPE 11 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_NEXT_CMD_TYPE 12 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_CMD_FROM_NAME 13 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_NAME_LEN_FROM_CMD 14 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_NAME_FROM_CMD 15 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_DESC_LEN_FROM_CMD 16 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_DESC_FROM_CMD 17 + #define ENGINE_CTRL_GET_CMD_FLAGS 18 + +Whilst these commands are automatically processed by the OpenSSL framework code, +they use various properties exposed by each ENGINE to process these +queries. An ENGINE has 3 properties it exposes that can affect how this behaves; +it can supply a ctrl() handler, it can specify ENGINE_FLAGS_MANUAL_CMD_CTRL in +the ENGINE's flags, and it can expose an array of control command descriptions. +If an ENGINE specifies the ENGINE_FLAGS_MANUAL_CMD_CTRL flag, then it will +simply pass all these "core" control commands directly to the ENGINE's ctrl() +handler (and thus, it must have supplied one), so it is up to the ENGINE to +reply to these "discovery" commands itself. If that flag is not set, then the +OpenSSL framework code will work with the following rules; + + if no ctrl() handler supplied; + ENGINE_HAS_CTRL_FUNCTION returns FALSE (zero), + all other commands fail. + if a ctrl() handler was supplied but no array of control commands; + ENGINE_HAS_CTRL_FUNCTION returns TRUE, + all other commands fail. + if a ctrl() handler and array of control commands was supplied; + ENGINE_HAS_CTRL_FUNCTION returns TRUE, + all other commands proceed processing ... + +If the ENGINE's array of control commands is empty then all other commands will +fail, otherwise; ENGINE_CTRL_GET_FIRST_CMD_TYPE returns the identifier of +the first command supported by the ENGINE, ENGINE_GET_NEXT_CMD_TYPE takes the +identifier of a command supported by the ENGINE and returns the next command +identifier or fails if there are no more, ENGINE_CMD_FROM_NAME takes a string +name for a command and returns the corresponding identifier or fails if no such +command name exists, and the remaining commands take a command identifier and +return properties of the corresponding commands. All except +ENGINE_CTRL_GET_FLAGS return the string length of a command name or description, +or populate a supplied character buffer with a copy of the command name or +description. ENGINE_CTRL_GET_FLAGS returns a bitwise-OR'd mask of the following +possible values; + + #define ENGINE_CMD_FLAG_NUMERIC (unsigned int)0x0001 + #define ENGINE_CMD_FLAG_STRING (unsigned int)0x0002 + #define ENGINE_CMD_FLAG_NO_INPUT (unsigned int)0x0004 + #define ENGINE_CMD_FLAG_INTERNAL (unsigned int)0x0008 + +If the ENGINE_CMD_FLAG_INTERNAL flag is set, then any other flags are purely +informational to the caller - this flag will prevent the command being usable +for any higher-level ENGINE functions such as ENGINE_ctrl_cmd_string(). +"INTERNAL" commands are not intended to be exposed to text-based configuration +by applications, administrations, users, etc. These can support arbitrary +operations via ENGINE_ctrl(), including passing to and/or from the control +commands data of any arbitrary type. These commands are supported in the +discovery mechanisms simply to allow applications determinie if an ENGINE +supports certain specific commands it might want to use (eg. application "foo" +might query various ENGINEs to see if they implement "FOO_GET_VENDOR_LOGO_GIF" - +and ENGINE could therefore decide whether or not to support this "foo"-specific +extension). + +=head2 Future developments + +The ENGINE API and internal architecture is currently being reviewed. Slated for +possible release in 0.9.8 is support for transparent loading of "dynamic" +ENGINEs (built as self-contained shared-libraries). This would allow ENGINE +implementations to be provided independently of OpenSSL libraries and/or +OpenSSL-based applications, and would also remove any requirement for +applications to explicitly use the "dynamic" ENGINE to bind to shared-library +implementations. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/err.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/err.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..6f729554d --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/err.pod @@ -0,0 +1,187 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +err - error codes + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned long ERR_get_error(void); + unsigned long ERR_peek_error(void); + unsigned long ERR_get_error_line(const char **file, int *line); + unsigned long ERR_peek_error_line(const char **file, int *line); + unsigned long ERR_get_error_line_data(const char **file, int *line, + const char **data, int *flags); + unsigned long ERR_peek_error_line_data(const char **file, int *line, + const char **data, int *flags); + + int ERR_GET_LIB(unsigned long e); + int ERR_GET_FUNC(unsigned long e); + int ERR_GET_REASON(unsigned long e); + + void ERR_clear_error(void); + + char *ERR_error_string(unsigned long e, char *buf); + const char *ERR_lib_error_string(unsigned long e); + const char *ERR_func_error_string(unsigned long e); + const char *ERR_reason_error_string(unsigned long e); + + void ERR_print_errors(BIO *bp); + void ERR_print_errors_fp(FILE *fp); + + void ERR_load_crypto_strings(void); + void ERR_free_strings(void); + + void ERR_remove_state(unsigned long pid); + + void ERR_put_error(int lib, int func, int reason, const char *file, + int line); + void ERR_add_error_data(int num, ...); + + void ERR_load_strings(int lib,ERR_STRING_DATA str[]); + unsigned long ERR_PACK(int lib, int func, int reason); + int ERR_get_next_error_library(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +When a call to the OpenSSL library fails, this is usually signalled +by the return value, and an error code is stored in an error queue +associated with the current thread. The B library provides +functions to obtain these error codes and textual error messages. + +The L manpage describes how to +access error codes. + +Error codes contain information about where the error occurred, and +what went wrong. L describes how to +extract this information. A method to obtain human-readable error +messages is described in L. + +L can be used to clear the +error queue. + +Note that L should be used to +avoid memory leaks when threads are terminated. + +=head1 ADDING NEW ERROR CODES TO OPENSSL + +See L if you want to record error codes in the +OpenSSL error system from within your application. + +The remainder of this section is of interest only if you want to add +new error codes to OpenSSL or add error codes from external libraries. + +=head2 Reporting errors + +Each sub-library has a specific macro XXXerr() that is used to report +errors. Its first argument is a function code B, the second +argument is a reason code B. Function codes are derived +from the function names; reason codes consist of textual error +descriptions. For example, the function ssl23_read() reports a +"handshake failure" as follows: + + SSLerr(SSL_F_SSL23_READ, SSL_R_SSL_HANDSHAKE_FAILURE); + +Function and reason codes should consist of upper case characters, +numbers and underscores only. The error file generation script translates +function codes into function names by looking in the header files +for an appropriate function name, if none is found it just uses +the capitalized form such as "SSL23_READ" in the above example. + +The trailing section of a reason code (after the "_R_") is translated +into lower case and underscores changed to spaces. + +When you are using new function or reason codes, run B. +The necessary B<#define>s will then automatically be added to the +sub-library's header file. + +Although a library will normally report errors using its own specific +XXXerr macro, another library's macro can be used. This is normally +only done when a library wants to include ASN1 code which must use +the ASN1err() macro. + +=head2 Adding new libraries + +When adding a new sub-library to OpenSSL, assign it a library number +B, define a macro XXXerr() (both in B), add its +name to B (in B), and add +C to the ERR_load_crypto_strings() function +(in B). Finally, add an entry + + L XXX xxx.h xxx_err.c + +to B, and add B to the Makefile. +Running B will then generate a file B, and +add all error codes used in the library to B. + +Additionally the library include file must have a certain form. +Typically it will initially look like this: + + #ifndef HEADER_XXX_H + #define HEADER_XXX_H + + #ifdef __cplusplus + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Include files */ + + #include + #include + + /* Macros, structures and function prototypes */ + + + /* BEGIN ERROR CODES */ + +The B sequence is used by the error code +generation script as the point to place new error codes, any text +after this point will be overwritten when B is run. +The closing #endif etc will be automatically added by the script. + +The generated C error code file B will load the header +files B, B and B so the +header file must load any additional header files containing any +definitions it uses. + +=head1 USING ERROR CODES IN EXTERNAL LIBRARIES + +It is also possible to use OpenSSL's error code scheme in external +libraries. The library needs to load its own codes and call the OpenSSL +error code insertion script B explicitly to add codes to +the header file and generate the C error code file. This will normally +be done if the external library needs to generate new ASN1 structures +but it can also be used to add more general purpose error code handling. + +TBA more details + +=head1 INTERNALS + +The error queues are stored in a hash table with one B +entry for each pid. ERR_get_state() returns the current thread's +B. An B can hold up to B error +codes. When more error codes are added, the old ones are overwritten, +on the assumption that the most recent errors are most important. + +Error strings are also stored in hash table. The hash tables can +be obtained by calling ERR_get_err_state_table(void) and +ERR_get_string_table(void) respectively. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/evp.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/evp.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b3ca14314 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/evp.pod @@ -0,0 +1,45 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +evp - high-level cryptographic functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The EVP library provides a high-level interface to cryptographic +functions. + +BI<...> and BI<...> provide public key encryption +and decryption to implement digital "envelopes". + +The BI<...> and BI<...> functions implement +digital signatures. + +Symmetric encryption is available with the BI<...> +functions. The BI<...> functions provide message digests. + +Algorithms are loaded with OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms(3). + +All the symmetric algorithms (ciphers) and digests can be replaced by ENGINE +modules providing alternative implementations. If ENGINE implementations of +ciphers or digests are registered as defaults, then the various EVP functions +will automatically use those implementations automatically in preference to +built in software implementations. For more information, consult the engine(3) +man page. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/hmac.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/hmac.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..0bd79a6d3 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/hmac.pod @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +HMAC, HMAC_Init, HMAC_Update, HMAC_Final, HMAC_cleanup - HMAC message +authentication code + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned char *HMAC(const EVP_MD *evp_md, const void *key, + int key_len, const unsigned char *d, int n, + unsigned char *md, unsigned int *md_len); + + void HMAC_CTX_init(HMAC_CTX *ctx); + + void HMAC_Init(HMAC_CTX *ctx, const void *key, int key_len, + const EVP_MD *md); + void HMAC_Init_ex(HMAC_CTX *ctx, const void *key, int key_len, + const EVP_MD *md, ENGINE *impl); + void HMAC_Update(HMAC_CTX *ctx, const unsigned char *data, int len); + void HMAC_Final(HMAC_CTX *ctx, unsigned char *md, unsigned int *len); + + void HMAC_CTX_cleanup(HMAC_CTX *ctx); + void HMAC_cleanup(HMAC_CTX *ctx); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +HMAC is a MAC (message authentication code), i.e. a keyed hash +function used for message authentication, which is based on a hash +function. + +HMAC() computes the message authentication code of the B bytes at +B using the hash function B and the key B which is +B bytes long. + +It places the result in B (which must have space for the output of +the hash function, which is no more than B bytes). +If B is NULL, the digest is placed in a static array. The size of +the output is placed in B, unless it is B. + +B can be EVP_sha1(), EVP_ripemd160() etc. +B and B may be B if a key and hash function have +been set in a previous call to HMAC_Init() for that B. + +HMAC_CTX_init() initialises a B before first use. It must be +called. + +HMAC_CTX_cleanup() erases the key and other data from the B +and releases any associated resources. It must be called when an +B is no longer required. + +HMAC_cleanup() is an alias for HMAC_CTX_cleanup() included for back +compatibility with 0.9.6b, it is deprecated. + +The following functions may be used if the message is not completely +stored in memory: + +HMAC_Init() initializes a B structure to use the hash +function B and the key B which is B bytes +long. It is deprecated and only included for backward compatibility +with OpenSSL 0.9.6b. + +HMAC_Init_ex() initializes or reuses a B structure to use +the function B and key B. Either can be NULL, in which +case the existing one will be reused. HMAC_CTX_init() must have been +called before the first use of an B in this +function. B. + +HMAC_Update() can be called repeatedly with chunks of the message to +be authenticated (B bytes at B). + +HMAC_Final() places the message authentication code in B, which +must have space for the hash function output. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +HMAC() returns a pointer to the message authentication code. + +HMAC_CTX_init(), HMAC_Init_ex(), HMAC_Update(), HMAC_Final() and +HMAC_CTX_cleanup() do not return values. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +RFC 2104 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +HMAC(), HMAC_Init(), HMAC_Update(), HMAC_Final() and HMAC_cleanup() +are available since SSLeay 0.9.0. + +HMAC_CTX_init(), HMAC_Init_ex() and HMAC_CTX_cleanup() are available +since OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/lh_stats.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/lh_stats.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3eeaa72e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/lh_stats.pod @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +lh_stats, lh_node_stats, lh_node_usage_stats, lh_stats_bio, +lh_node_stats_bio, lh_node_usage_stats_bio - LHASH statistics + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void lh_stats(LHASH *table, FILE *out); + void lh_node_stats(LHASH *table, FILE *out); + void lh_node_usage_stats(LHASH *table, FILE *out); + + void lh_stats_bio(LHASH *table, BIO *out); + void lh_node_stats_bio(LHASH *table, BIO *out); + void lh_node_usage_stats_bio(LHASH *table, BIO *out); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The B structure records statistics about most aspects of +accessing the hash table. This is mostly a legacy of Eric Young +writing this library for the reasons of implementing what looked like +a nice algorithm rather than for a particular software product. + +lh_stats() prints out statistics on the size of the hash table, how +many entries are in it, and the number and result of calls to the +routines in this library. + +lh_node_stats() prints the number of entries for each 'bucket' in the +hash table. + +lh_node_usage_stats() prints out a short summary of the state of the +hash table. It prints the 'load' and the 'actual load'. The load is +the average number of data items per 'bucket' in the hash table. The +'actual load' is the average number of items per 'bucket', but only +for buckets which contain entries. So the 'actual load' is the +average number of searches that will need to find an item in the hash +table, while the 'load' is the average number that will be done to +record a miss. + +lh_stats_bio(), lh_node_stats_bio() and lh_node_usage_stats_bio() +are the same as the above, except that the output goes to a B. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +These functions do not return values. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +These functions are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +This manpage is derived from the SSLeay documentation. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/lhash.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/lhash.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..dcdbb43a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/lhash.pod @@ -0,0 +1,294 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +lh_new, lh_free, lh_insert, lh_delete, lh_retrieve, lh_doall, lh_doall_arg, lh_error - dynamic hash table + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + LHASH *lh_new(LHASH_HASH_FN_TYPE hash, LHASH_COMP_FN_TYPE compare); + void lh_free(LHASH *table); + + void *lh_insert(LHASH *table, void *data); + void *lh_delete(LHASH *table, void *data); + void *lh_retrieve(LHASH *table, void *data); + + void lh_doall(LHASH *table, LHASH_DOALL_FN_TYPE func); + void lh_doall_arg(LHASH *table, LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN_TYPE func, + void *arg); + + int lh_error(LHASH *table); + + typedef int (*LHASH_COMP_FN_TYPE)(const void *, const void *); + typedef unsigned long (*LHASH_HASH_FN_TYPE)(const void *); + typedef void (*LHASH_DOALL_FN_TYPE)(const void *); + typedef void (*LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN_TYPE)(const void *, const void *); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This library implements dynamic hash tables. The hash table entries +can be arbitrary structures. Usually they consist of key and value +fields. + +lh_new() creates a new B structure to store arbitrary data +entries, and provides the 'hash' and 'compare' callbacks to be used in +organising the table's entries. The B callback takes a pointer +to a table entry as its argument and returns an unsigned long hash +value for its key field. The hash value is normally truncated to a +power of 2, so make sure that your hash function returns well mixed +low order bits. The B callback takes two arguments (pointers +to two hash table entries), and returns 0 if their keys are equal, +non-zero otherwise. If your hash table will contain items of some +particular type and the B and B callbacks hash/compare +these types, then the B and +B macros can be used to create callback +wrappers of the prototypes required by lh_new(). These provide +per-variable casts before calling the type-specific callbacks written +by the application author. These macros, as well as those used for +the "doall" callbacks, are defined as; + + #define DECLARE_LHASH_HASH_FN(f_name,o_type) \ + unsigned long f_name##_LHASH_HASH(const void *); + #define IMPLEMENT_LHASH_HASH_FN(f_name,o_type) \ + unsigned long f_name##_LHASH_HASH(const void *arg) { \ + o_type a = (o_type)arg; \ + return f_name(a); } + #define LHASH_HASH_FN(f_name) f_name##_LHASH_HASH + + #define DECLARE_LHASH_COMP_FN(f_name,o_type) \ + int f_name##_LHASH_COMP(const void *, const void *); + #define IMPLEMENT_LHASH_COMP_FN(f_name,o_type) \ + int f_name##_LHASH_COMP(const void *arg1, const void *arg2) { \ + o_type a = (o_type)arg1; \ + o_type b = (o_type)arg2; \ + return f_name(a,b); } + #define LHASH_COMP_FN(f_name) f_name##_LHASH_COMP + + #define DECLARE_LHASH_DOALL_FN(f_name,o_type) \ + void f_name##_LHASH_DOALL(const void *); + #define IMPLEMENT_LHASH_DOALL_FN(f_name,o_type) \ + void f_name##_LHASH_DOALL(const void *arg) { \ + o_type a = (o_type)arg; \ + f_name(a); } + #define LHASH_DOALL_FN(f_name) f_name##_LHASH_DOALL + + #define DECLARE_LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN(f_name,o_type,a_type) \ + void f_name##_LHASH_DOALL_ARG(const void *, const void *); + #define IMPLEMENT_LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN(f_name,o_type,a_type) \ + void f_name##_LHASH_DOALL_ARG(const void *arg1, const void *arg2) { \ + o_type a = (o_type)arg1; \ + a_type b = (a_type)arg2; \ + f_name(a,b); } + #define LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN(f_name) f_name##_LHASH_DOALL_ARG + +An example of a hash table storing (pointers to) structures of type 'STUFF' +could be defined as follows; + + /* Calculates the hash value of 'tohash' (implemented elsewhere) */ + unsigned long STUFF_hash(const STUFF *tohash); + /* Orders 'arg1' and 'arg2' (implemented elsewhere) */ + int STUFF_cmp(const STUFF *arg1, const STUFF *arg2); + /* Create the type-safe wrapper functions for use in the LHASH internals */ + static IMPLEMENT_LHASH_HASH_FN(STUFF_hash, const STUFF *) + static IMPLEMENT_LHASH_COMP_FN(STUFF_cmp, const STUFF *); + /* ... */ + int main(int argc, char *argv[]) { + /* Create the new hash table using the hash/compare wrappers */ + LHASH *hashtable = lh_new(LHASH_HASH_FN(STUFF_hash), + LHASH_COMP_FN(STUFF_cmp)); + /* ... */ + } + +lh_free() frees the B structure B. Allocated hash table +entries will not be freed; consider using lh_doall() to deallocate any +remaining entries in the hash table (see below). + +lh_insert() inserts the structure pointed to by B into B
. +If there already is an entry with the same key, the old value is +replaced. Note that lh_insert() stores pointers, the data are not +copied. + +lh_delete() deletes an entry from B
. + +lh_retrieve() looks up an entry in B
. Normally, B is +a structure with the key field(s) set; the function will return a +pointer to a fully populated structure. + +lh_doall() will, for every entry in the hash table, call B with +the data item as its parameter. For lh_doall() and lh_doall_arg(), +function pointer casting should be avoided in the callbacks (see +B) - instead, either declare the callbacks to match the +prototype required in lh_new() or use the declare/implement macros to +create type-safe wrappers that cast variables prior to calling your +type-specific callbacks. An example of this is illustrated here where +the callback is used to cleanup resources for items in the hash table +prior to the hashtable itself being deallocated: + + /* Cleans up resources belonging to 'a' (this is implemented elsewhere) */ + void STUFF_cleanup(STUFF *a); + /* Implement a prototype-compatible wrapper for "STUFF_cleanup" */ + IMPLEMENT_LHASH_DOALL_FN(STUFF_cleanup, STUFF *) + /* ... then later in the code ... */ + /* So to run "STUFF_cleanup" against all items in a hash table ... */ + lh_doall(hashtable, LHASH_DOALL_FN(STUFF_cleanup)); + /* Then the hash table itself can be deallocated */ + lh_free(hashtable); + +When doing this, be careful if you delete entries from the hash table +in your callbacks: the table may decrease in size, moving the item +that you are currently on down lower in the hash table - this could +cause some entries to be skipped during the iteration. The second +best solution to this problem is to set hash-Edown_load=0 before +you start (which will stop the hash table ever decreasing in size). +The best solution is probably to avoid deleting items from the hash +table inside a "doall" callback! + +lh_doall_arg() is the same as lh_doall() except that B will be +called with B as the second argument and B should be of +type B (a callback prototype that is passed +both the table entry and an extra argument). As with lh_doall(), you +can instead choose to declare your callback with a prototype matching +the types you are dealing with and use the declare/implement macros to +create compatible wrappers that cast variables before calling your +type-specific callbacks. An example of this is demonstrated here +(printing all hash table entries to a BIO that is provided by the +caller): + + /* Prints item 'a' to 'output_bio' (this is implemented elsewhere) */ + void STUFF_print(const STUFF *a, BIO *output_bio); + /* Implement a prototype-compatible wrapper for "STUFF_print" */ + static IMPLEMENT_LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN(STUFF_print, const STUFF *, BIO *) + /* ... then later in the code ... */ + /* Print out the entire hashtable to a particular BIO */ + lh_doall_arg(hashtable, LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN(STUFF_print), logging_bio); + +lh_error() can be used to determine if an error occurred in the last +operation. lh_error() is a macro. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +lh_new() returns B on error, otherwise a pointer to the new +B structure. + +When a hash table entry is replaced, lh_insert() returns the value +being replaced. B is returned on normal operation and on error. + +lh_delete() returns the entry being deleted. B is returned if +there is no such value in the hash table. + +lh_retrieve() returns the hash table entry if it has been found, +B otherwise. + +lh_error() returns 1 if an error occurred in the last operation, 0 +otherwise. + +lh_free(), lh_doall() and lh_doall_arg() return no values. + +=head1 NOTE + +The various LHASH macros and callback types exist to make it possible +to write type-safe code without resorting to function-prototype +casting - an evil that makes application code much harder to +audit/verify and also opens the window of opportunity for stack +corruption and other hard-to-find bugs. It also, apparently, violates +ANSI-C. + +The LHASH code regards table entries as constant data. As such, it +internally represents lh_insert()'d items with a "const void *" +pointer type. This is why callbacks such as those used by lh_doall() +and lh_doall_arg() declare their prototypes with "const", even for the +parameters that pass back the table items' data pointers - for +consistency, user-provided data is "const" at all times as far as the +LHASH code is concerned. However, as callers are themselves providing +these pointers, they can choose whether they too should be treating +all such parameters as constant. + +As an example, a hash table may be maintained by code that, for +reasons of encapsulation, has only "const" access to the data being +indexed in the hash table (ie. it is returned as "const" from +elsewhere in their code) - in this case the LHASH prototypes are +appropriate as-is. Conversely, if the caller is responsible for the +life-time of the data in question, then they may well wish to make +modifications to table item passed back in the lh_doall() or +lh_doall_arg() callbacks (see the "STUFF_cleanup" example above). If +so, the caller can either cast the "const" away (if they're providing +the raw callbacks themselves) or use the macros to declare/implement +the wrapper functions without "const" types. + +Callers that only have "const" access to data they're indexing in a +table, yet declare callbacks without constant types (or cast the +"const" away themselves), are therefore creating their own risks/bugs +without being encouraged to do so by the API. On a related note, +those auditing code should pay special attention to any instances of +DECLARE/IMPLEMENT_LHASH_DOALL_[ARG_]_FN macros that provide types +without any "const" qualifiers. + +=head1 BUGS + +lh_insert() returns B both for success and error. + +=head1 INTERNALS + +The following description is based on the SSLeay documentation: + +The B library implements a hash table described in the +I in 1991. What makes this hash table +different is that as the table fills, the hash table is increased (or +decreased) in size via OPENSSL_realloc(). When a 'resize' is done, instead of +all hashes being redistributed over twice as many 'buckets', one +bucket is split. So when an 'expand' is done, there is only a minimal +cost to redistribute some values. Subsequent inserts will cause more +single 'bucket' redistributions but there will never be a sudden large +cost due to redistributing all the 'buckets'. + +The state for a particular hash table is kept in the B structure. +The decision to increase or decrease the hash table size is made +depending on the 'load' of the hash table. The load is the number of +items in the hash table divided by the size of the hash table. The +default values are as follows. If (hash->up_load E load) =E +expand. if (hash-Edown_load E load) =E contract. The +B has a default value of 1 and B has a default value +of 2. These numbers can be modified by the application by just +playing with the B and B variables. The 'load' is +kept in a form which is multiplied by 256. So +hash-Eup_load=8*256; will cause a load of 8 to be set. + +If you are interested in performance the field to watch is +num_comp_calls. The hash library keeps track of the 'hash' value for +each item so when a lookup is done, the 'hashes' are compared, if +there is a match, then a full compare is done, and +hash-Enum_comp_calls is incremented. If num_comp_calls is not equal +to num_delete plus num_retrieve it means that your hash function is +generating hashes that are the same for different values. It is +probably worth changing your hash function if this is the case because +even if your hash table has 10 items in a 'bucket', it can be searched +with 10 B compares and 10 linked list traverses. This +will be much less expensive that 10 calls to your compare function. + +lh_strhash() is a demo string hashing function: + + unsigned long lh_strhash(const char *c); + +Since the B routines would normally be passed structures, this +routine would not normally be passed to lh_new(), rather it would be +used in the function passed to lh_new(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The B library is available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +lh_error() was added in SSLeay 0.9.1b. + +This manpage is derived from the SSLeay documentation. + +In OpenSSL 0.9.7, all lhash functions that were passed function pointers +were changed for better type safety, and the function types LHASH_COMP_FN_TYPE, +LHASH_HASH_FN_TYPE, LHASH_DOALL_FN_TYPE and LHASH_DOALL_ARG_FN_TYPE +became available. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/md5.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/md5.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..d11d5c32c --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/md5.pod @@ -0,0 +1,101 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +MD2, MD4, MD5, MD2_Init, MD2_Update, MD2_Final, MD4_Init, MD4_Update, +MD4_Final, MD5_Init, MD5_Update, MD5_Final - MD2, MD4, and MD5 hash functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned char *MD2(const unsigned char *d, unsigned long n, + unsigned char *md); + + int MD2_Init(MD2_CTX *c); + int MD2_Update(MD2_CTX *c, const unsigned char *data, + unsigned long len); + int MD2_Final(unsigned char *md, MD2_CTX *c); + + + #include + + unsigned char *MD4(const unsigned char *d, unsigned long n, + unsigned char *md); + + int MD4_Init(MD4_CTX *c); + int MD4_Update(MD4_CTX *c, const void *data, + unsigned long len); + int MD4_Final(unsigned char *md, MD4_CTX *c); + + + #include + + unsigned char *MD5(const unsigned char *d, unsigned long n, + unsigned char *md); + + int MD5_Init(MD5_CTX *c); + int MD5_Update(MD5_CTX *c, const void *data, + unsigned long len); + int MD5_Final(unsigned char *md, MD5_CTX *c); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +MD2, MD4, and MD5 are cryptographic hash functions with a 128 bit output. + +MD2(), MD4(), and MD5() compute the MD2, MD4, and MD5 message digest +of the B bytes at B and place it in B (which must have space +for MD2_DIGEST_LENGTH == MD4_DIGEST_LENGTH == MD5_DIGEST_LENGTH == 16 +bytes of output). If B is NULL, the digest is placed in a static +array. + +The following functions may be used if the message is not completely +stored in memory: + +MD2_Init() initializes a B structure. + +MD2_Update() can be called repeatedly with chunks of the message to +be hashed (B bytes at B). + +MD2_Final() places the message digest in B, which must have space +for MD2_DIGEST_LENGTH == 16 bytes of output, and erases the B. + +MD4_Init(), MD4_Update(), MD4_Final(), MD5_Init(), MD5_Update(), and +MD5_Final() are analogous using an B and B structure. + +Applications should use the higher level functions +L +etc. instead of calling the hash functions directly. + +=head1 NOTE + +MD2, MD4, and MD5 are recommended only for compatibility with existing +applications. In new applications, SHA-1 or RIPEMD-160 should be +preferred. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +MD2(), MD4(), and MD5() return pointers to the hash value. + +MD2_Init(), MD2_Update(), MD2_Final(), MD4_Init(), MD4_Update(), +MD4_Final(), MD5_Init(), MD5_Update(), and MD5_Final() return 1 for +success, 0 otherwise. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +RFC 1319, RFC 1320, RFC 1321 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +MD2(), MD2_Init(), MD2_Update() MD2_Final(), MD5(), MD5_Init(), +MD5_Update() and MD5_Final() are available in all versions of SSLeay +and OpenSSL. + +MD4(), MD4_Init(), and MD4_Update() are available in OpenSSL 0.9.6 and +above. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/mdc2.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/mdc2.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..41f648af3 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/mdc2.pod @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +MDC2, MDC2_Init, MDC2_Update, MDC2_Final - MDC2 hash function + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned char *MDC2(const unsigned char *d, unsigned long n, + unsigned char *md); + + int MDC2_Init(MDC2_CTX *c); + int MDC2_Update(MDC2_CTX *c, const unsigned char *data, + unsigned long len); + int MDC2_Final(unsigned char *md, MDC2_CTX *c); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +MDC2 is a method to construct hash functions with 128 bit output from +block ciphers. These functions are an implementation of MDC2 with +DES. + +MDC2() computes the MDC2 message digest of the B +bytes at B and places it in B (which must have space for +MDC2_DIGEST_LENGTH == 16 bytes of output). If B is NULL, the digest +is placed in a static array. + +The following functions may be used if the message is not completely +stored in memory: + +MDC2_Init() initializes a B structure. + +MDC2_Update() can be called repeatedly with chunks of the message to +be hashed (B bytes at B). + +MDC2_Final() places the message digest in B, which must have space +for MDC2_DIGEST_LENGTH == 16 bytes of output, and erases the B. + +Applications should use the higher level functions +L etc. instead of calling the +hash functions directly. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +MDC2() returns a pointer to the hash value. + +MDC2_Init(), MDC2_Update() and MDC2_Final() return 1 for success, 0 otherwise. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +ISO/IEC 10118-2, with DES + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +MDC2(), MDC2_Init(), MDC2_Update() and MDC2_Final() are available since +SSLeay 0.8. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/pem.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/pem.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..4f9a27df0 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/pem.pod @@ -0,0 +1,476 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +PEM - PEM routines + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + EVP_PKEY *PEM_read_bio_PrivateKey(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + EVP_PKEY *PEM_read_PrivateKey(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_PrivateKey(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + unsigned char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_PrivateKey(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + unsigned char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_PKCS8PrivateKey(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_PKCS8PrivateKey(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY *x, int nid, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY *x, int nid, + char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + EVP_PKEY *PEM_read_bio_PUBKEY(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + EVP_PKEY *PEM_read_PUBKEY(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_PUBKEY(BIO *bp, EVP_PKEY *x); + int PEM_write_PUBKEY(FILE *fp, EVP_PKEY *x); + + RSA *PEM_read_bio_RSAPrivateKey(BIO *bp, RSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + RSA *PEM_read_RSAPrivateKey(FILE *fp, RSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_RSAPrivateKey(BIO *bp, RSA *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + unsigned char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_RSAPrivateKey(FILE *fp, RSA *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + unsigned char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + RSA *PEM_read_bio_RSAPublicKey(BIO *bp, RSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + RSA *PEM_read_RSAPublicKey(FILE *fp, RSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_RSAPublicKey(BIO *bp, RSA *x); + + int PEM_write_RSAPublicKey(FILE *fp, RSA *x); + + RSA *PEM_read_bio_RSA_PUBKEY(BIO *bp, RSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + RSA *PEM_read_RSA_PUBKEY(FILE *fp, RSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_RSA_PUBKEY(BIO *bp, RSA *x); + + int PEM_write_RSA_PUBKEY(FILE *fp, RSA *x); + + DSA *PEM_read_bio_DSAPrivateKey(BIO *bp, DSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + DSA *PEM_read_DSAPrivateKey(FILE *fp, DSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_DSAPrivateKey(BIO *bp, DSA *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + unsigned char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_DSAPrivateKey(FILE *fp, DSA *x, const EVP_CIPHER *enc, + unsigned char *kstr, int klen, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + DSA *PEM_read_bio_DSA_PUBKEY(BIO *bp, DSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + DSA *PEM_read_DSA_PUBKEY(FILE *fp, DSA **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_DSA_PUBKEY(BIO *bp, DSA *x); + + int PEM_write_DSA_PUBKEY(FILE *fp, DSA *x); + + DSA *PEM_read_bio_DSAparams(BIO *bp, DSA **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + DSA *PEM_read_DSAparams(FILE *fp, DSA **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_DSAparams(BIO *bp, DSA *x); + + int PEM_write_DSAparams(FILE *fp, DSA *x); + + DH *PEM_read_bio_DHparams(BIO *bp, DH **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + DH *PEM_read_DHparams(FILE *fp, DH **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_DHparams(BIO *bp, DH *x); + + int PEM_write_DHparams(FILE *fp, DH *x); + + X509 *PEM_read_bio_X509(BIO *bp, X509 **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + X509 *PEM_read_X509(FILE *fp, X509 **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_X509(BIO *bp, X509 *x); + + int PEM_write_X509(FILE *fp, X509 *x); + + X509 *PEM_read_bio_X509_AUX(BIO *bp, X509 **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + X509 *PEM_read_X509_AUX(FILE *fp, X509 **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_X509_AUX(BIO *bp, X509 *x); + + int PEM_write_X509_AUX(FILE *fp, X509 *x); + + X509_REQ *PEM_read_bio_X509_REQ(BIO *bp, X509_REQ **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + X509_REQ *PEM_read_X509_REQ(FILE *fp, X509_REQ **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_X509_REQ(BIO *bp, X509_REQ *x); + + int PEM_write_X509_REQ(FILE *fp, X509_REQ *x); + + int PEM_write_bio_X509_REQ_NEW(BIO *bp, X509_REQ *x); + + int PEM_write_X509_REQ_NEW(FILE *fp, X509_REQ *x); + + X509_CRL *PEM_read_bio_X509_CRL(BIO *bp, X509_CRL **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + X509_CRL *PEM_read_X509_CRL(FILE *fp, X509_CRL **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + int PEM_write_bio_X509_CRL(BIO *bp, X509_CRL *x); + int PEM_write_X509_CRL(FILE *fp, X509_CRL *x); + + PKCS7 *PEM_read_bio_PKCS7(BIO *bp, PKCS7 **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + PKCS7 *PEM_read_PKCS7(FILE *fp, PKCS7 **x, pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_PKCS7(BIO *bp, PKCS7 *x); + + int PEM_write_PKCS7(FILE *fp, PKCS7 *x); + + NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE *PEM_read_bio_NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE(BIO *bp, + NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE *PEM_read_NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE(FILE *fp, + NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE **x, + pem_password_cb *cb, void *u); + + int PEM_write_bio_NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE(BIO *bp, NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE *x); + + int PEM_write_NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE(FILE *fp, NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE *x); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The PEM functions read or write structures in PEM format. In +this sense PEM format is simply base64 encoded data surrounded +by header lines. + +For more details about the meaning of arguments see the +B section. + +Each operation has four functions associated with it. For +clarity the term "B functions" will be used to collectively +refer to the PEM_read_bio_foobar(), PEM_read_foobar(), +PEM_write_bio_foobar() and PEM_write_foobar() functions. + +The B functions read or write a private key in +PEM format using an EVP_PKEY structure. The write routines use +"traditional" private key format and can handle both RSA and DSA +private keys. The read functions can additionally transparently +handle PKCS#8 format encrypted and unencrypted keys too. + +PEM_write_bio_PKCS8PrivateKey() and PEM_write_PKCS8PrivateKey() +write a private key in an EVP_PKEY structure in PKCS#8 +EncryptedPrivateKeyInfo format using PKCS#5 v2.0 password based encryption +algorithms. The B argument specifies the encryption algoritm to +use: unlike all other PEM routines the encryption is applied at the +PKCS#8 level and not in the PEM headers. If B is NULL then no +encryption is used and a PKCS#8 PrivateKeyInfo structure is used instead. + +PEM_write_bio_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid() and PEM_write_PKCS8PrivateKey_nid() +also write out a private key as a PKCS#8 EncryptedPrivateKeyInfo however +it uses PKCS#5 v1.5 or PKCS#12 encryption algorithms instead. The algorithm +to use is specified in the B parameter and should be the NID of the +corresponding OBJECT IDENTIFIER (see NOTES section). + +The B functions process a public key using an EVP_PKEY +structure. The public key is encoded as a SubjectPublicKeyInfo +structure. + +The B functions process an RSA private key using an +RSA structure. It handles the same formats as the B +functions but an error occurs if the private key is not RSA. + +The B functions process an RSA public key using an +RSA structure. The public key is encoded using a PKCS#1 RSAPublicKey +structure. + +The B functions also process an RSA public key using +an RSA structure. However the public key is encoded using a +SubjectPublicKeyInfo structure and an error occurs if the public +key is not RSA. + +The B functions process a DSA private key using a +DSA structure. It handles the same formats as the B +functions but an error occurs if the private key is not DSA. + +The B functions process a DSA public key using +a DSA structure. The public key is encoded using a +SubjectPublicKeyInfo structure and an error occurs if the public +key is not DSA. + +The B functions process DSA parameters using a DSA +structure. The parameters are encoded using a foobar structure. + +The B functions process DH parameters using a DH +structure. The parameters are encoded using a PKCS#3 DHparameter +structure. + +The B functions process an X509 certificate using an X509 +structure. They will also process a trusted X509 certificate but +any trust settings are discarded. + +The B functions process a trusted X509 certificate using +an X509 structure. + +The B and B functions process a PKCS#10 +certificate request using an X509_REQ structure. The B +write functions use B in the header whereas +the B functions use B +(as required by some CAs). The B read functions will +handle either form so there are no B read functions. + +The B functions process an X509 CRL using an X509_CRL +structure. + +The B functions process a PKCS#7 ContentInfo using a PKCS7 +structure. + +The B functions process a Netscape Certificate +Sequence using a NETSCAPE_CERT_SEQUENCE structure. + +=head1 PEM FUNCTION ARGUMENTS + +The PEM functions have many common arguments. + +The B BIO parameter (if present) specifies the BIO to read from +or write to. + +The B FILE parameter (if present) specifies the FILE pointer to +read from or write to. + +The PEM read functions all take an argument B and return +a B pointer. Where B is whatever structure the function +uses. If B is NULL then the parameter is ignored. If B is not +NULL but B<*x> is NULL then the structure returned will be written +to B<*x>. If neither B nor B<*x> is NULL then an attempt is made +to reuse the structure at B<*x> (but see BUGS and EXAMPLES sections). +Irrespective of the value of B a pointer to the structure is always +returned (or NULL if an error occurred). + +The PEM functions which write private keys take an B parameter +which specifies the encryption algorithm to use, encryption is done +at the PEM level. If this parameter is set to NULL then the private +key is written in unencrypted form. + +The B argument is the callback to use when querying for the pass +phrase used for encrypted PEM structures (normally only private keys). + +For the PEM write routines if the B parameter is not NULL then +B bytes at B are used as the passphrase and B is +ignored. + +If the B parameters is set to NULL and the B parameter is not +NULL then the B parameter is interpreted as a null terminated string +to use as the passphrase. If both B and B are NULL then the +default callback routine is used which will typically prompt for the +passphrase on the current terminal with echoing turned off. + +The default passphrase callback is sometimes inappropriate (for example +in a GUI application) so an alternative can be supplied. The callback +routine has the following form: + + int cb(char *buf, int size, int rwflag, void *u); + +B is the buffer to write the passphrase to. B is the maximum +length of the passphrase (i.e. the size of buf). B is a flag +which is set to 0 when reading and 1 when writing. A typical routine +will ask the user to verify the passphrase (for example by prompting +for it twice) if B is 1. The B parameter has the same +value as the B parameter passed to the PEM routine. It allows +arbitrary data to be passed to the callback by the application +(for example a window handle in a GUI application). The callback +B return the number of characters in the passphrase or 0 if +an error occurred. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +Although the PEM routines take several arguments in almost all applications +most of them are set to 0 or NULL. + +Read a certificate in PEM format from a BIO: + + X509 *x; + x = PEM_read_bio_X509(bp, NULL, 0, NULL); + if (x == NULL) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Alternative method: + + X509 *x = NULL; + if (!PEM_read_bio_X509(bp, &x, 0, NULL)) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Write a certificate to a BIO: + + if (!PEM_write_bio_X509(bp, x)) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Write an unencrypted private key to a FILE pointer: + + if (!PEM_write_PrivateKey(fp, key, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL)) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Write a private key (using traditional format) to a BIO using +triple DES encryption, the pass phrase is prompted for: + + if (!PEM_write_bio_PrivateKey(bp, key, EVP_des_ede3_cbc(), NULL, 0, 0, NULL)) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Write a private key (using PKCS#8 format) to a BIO using triple +DES encryption, using the pass phrase "hello": + + if (!PEM_write_bio_PKCS8PrivateKey(bp, key, EVP_des_ede3_cbc(), NULL, 0, 0, "hello")) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Read a private key from a BIO using the pass phrase "hello": + + key = PEM_read_bio_PrivateKey(bp, NULL, 0, "hello"); + if (key == NULL) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Read a private key from a BIO using a pass phrase callback: + + key = PEM_read_bio_PrivateKey(bp, NULL, pass_cb, "My Private Key"); + if (key == NULL) + { + /* Error */ + } + +Skeleton pass phrase callback: + + int pass_cb(char *buf, int size, int rwflag, void *u); + { + int len; + char *tmp; + /* We'd probably do something else if 'rwflag' is 1 */ + printf("Enter pass phrase for \"%s\"\n", u); + + /* get pass phrase, length 'len' into 'tmp' */ + tmp = "hello"; + len = strlen(tmp); + + if (len <= 0) return 0; + /* if too long, truncate */ + if (len > size) len = size; + memcpy(buf, tmp, len); + return len; + } + +=head1 NOTES + +The old B write routines are retained for compatibility. +New applications should write private keys using the +PEM_write_bio_PKCS8PrivateKey() or PEM_write_PKCS8PrivateKey() routines +because they are more secure (they use an iteration count of 2048 whereas +the traditional routines use a count of 1) unless compatibility with older +versions of OpenSSL is important. + +The B read routines can be used in all applications because +they handle all formats transparently. + +A frequent cause of problems is attempting to use the PEM routines like +this: + + X509 *x; + PEM_read_bio_X509(bp, &x, 0, NULL); + +this is a bug because an attempt will be made to reuse the data at B +which is an uninitialised pointer. + +=head1 PEM ENCRYPTION FORMAT + +This old B routines use a non standard technique for encryption. + +The private key (or other data) takes the following form: + + -----BEGIN RSA PRIVATE KEY----- + Proc-Type: 4,ENCRYPTED + DEK-Info: DES-EDE3-CBC,3F17F5316E2BAC89 + + ...base64 encoded data... + -----END RSA PRIVATE KEY----- + +The line beginning DEK-Info contains two comma separated pieces of information: +the encryption algorithm name as used by EVP_get_cipherbyname() and an 8 +byte B encoded as a set of hexadecimal digits. + +After this is the base64 encoded encrypted data. + +The encryption key is determined using EVP_bytestokey(), using B and an +iteration count of 1. The IV used is the value of B and *not* the IV +returned by EVP_bytestokey(). + +=head1 BUGS + +The PEM read routines in some versions of OpenSSL will not correctly reuse +an existing structure. Therefore the following: + + PEM_read_bio_X509(bp, &x, 0, NULL); + +where B already contains a valid certificate, may not work, whereas: + + X509_free(x); + x = PEM_read_bio_X509(bp, NULL, 0, NULL); + +is guaranteed to work. + +=head1 RETURN CODES + +The read routines return either a pointer to the structure read or NULL +if an error occurred. + +The write routines return 1 for success or 0 for failure. diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/rand.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/rand.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..1c068c85b --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/rand.pod @@ -0,0 +1,175 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +rand - pseudo-random number generator + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + int RAND_set_rand_engine(ENGINE *engine); + + int RAND_bytes(unsigned char *buf, int num); + int RAND_pseudo_bytes(unsigned char *buf, int num); + + void RAND_seed(const void *buf, int num); + void RAND_add(const void *buf, int num, int entropy); + int RAND_status(void); + + int RAND_load_file(const char *file, long max_bytes); + int RAND_write_file(const char *file); + const char *RAND_file_name(char *file, size_t num); + + int RAND_egd(const char *path); + + void RAND_set_rand_method(const RAND_METHOD *meth); + const RAND_METHOD *RAND_get_rand_method(void); + RAND_METHOD *RAND_SSLeay(void); + + void RAND_cleanup(void); + + /* For Win32 only */ + void RAND_screen(void); + int RAND_event(UINT, WPARAM, LPARAM); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +Since the introduction of the ENGINE API, the recommended way of controlling +default implementations is by using the ENGINE API functions. The default +B, as set by RAND_set_rand_method() and returned by +RAND_get_rand_method(), is only used if no ENGINE has been set as the default +"rand" implementation. Hence, these two functions are no longer the recommened +way to control defaults. + +If an alternative B implementation is being used (either set +directly or as provided by an ENGINE module), then it is entirely responsible +for the generation and management of a cryptographically secure PRNG stream. The +mechanisms described below relate solely to the software PRNG implementation +built in to OpenSSL and used by default. + +These functions implement a cryptographically secure pseudo-random +number generator (PRNG). It is used by other library functions for +example to generate random keys, and applications can use it when they +need randomness. + +A cryptographic PRNG must be seeded with unpredictable data such as +mouse movements or keys pressed at random by the user. This is +described in L. Its state can be saved in a seed file +(see L) to avoid having to go through the +seeding process whenever the application is started. + +L describes how to obtain random data from the +PRNG. + +=head1 INTERNALS + +The RAND_SSLeay() method implements a PRNG based on a cryptographic +hash function. + +The following description of its design is based on the SSLeay +documentation: + +First up I will state the things I believe I need for a good RNG. + +=over 4 + +=item 1 + +A good hashing algorithm to mix things up and to convert the RNG 'state' +to random numbers. + +=item 2 + +An initial source of random 'state'. + +=item 3 + +The state should be very large. If the RNG is being used to generate +4096 bit RSA keys, 2 2048 bit random strings are required (at a minimum). +If your RNG state only has 128 bits, you are obviously limiting the +search space to 128 bits, not 2048. I'm probably getting a little +carried away on this last point but it does indicate that it may not be +a bad idea to keep quite a lot of RNG state. It should be easier to +break a cipher than guess the RNG seed data. + +=item 4 + +Any RNG seed data should influence all subsequent random numbers +generated. This implies that any random seed data entered will have +an influence on all subsequent random numbers generated. + +=item 5 + +When using data to seed the RNG state, the data used should not be +extractable from the RNG state. I believe this should be a +requirement because one possible source of 'secret' semi random +data would be a private key or a password. This data must +not be disclosed by either subsequent random numbers or a +'core' dump left by a program crash. + +=item 6 + +Given the same initial 'state', 2 systems should deviate in their RNG state +(and hence the random numbers generated) over time if at all possible. + +=item 7 + +Given the random number output stream, it should not be possible to determine +the RNG state or the next random number. + +=back + +The algorithm is as follows. + +There is global state made up of a 1023 byte buffer (the 'state'), a +working hash value ('md'), and a counter ('count'). + +Whenever seed data is added, it is inserted into the 'state' as +follows. + +The input is chopped up into units of 20 bytes (or less for +the last block). Each of these blocks is run through the hash +function as follows: The data passed to the hash function +is the current 'md', the same number of bytes from the 'state' +(the location determined by in incremented looping index) as +the current 'block', the new key data 'block', and 'count' +(which is incremented after each use). +The result of this is kept in 'md' and also xored into the +'state' at the same locations that were used as input into the +hash function. I +believe this system addresses points 1 (hash function; currently +SHA-1), 3 (the 'state'), 4 (via the 'md'), 5 (by the use of a hash +function and xor). + +When bytes are extracted from the RNG, the following process is used. +For each group of 10 bytes (or less), we do the following: + +Input into the hash function the local 'md' (which is initialized from +the global 'md' before any bytes are generated), the bytes that are to +be overwritten by the random bytes, and bytes from the 'state' +(incrementing looping index). From this digest output (which is kept +in 'md'), the top (up to) 10 bytes are returned to the caller and the +bottom 10 bytes are xored into the 'state'. + +Finally, after we have finished 'num' random bytes for the caller, +'count' (which is incremented) and the local and global 'md' are fed +into the hash function and the results are kept in the global 'md'. + +I believe the above addressed points 1 (use of SHA-1), 6 (by hashing +into the 'state' the 'old' data from the caller that is about to be +overwritten) and 7 (by not using the 10 bytes given to the caller to +update the 'state', but they are used to update 'md'). + +So of the points raised, only 2 is not addressed (but see +L). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, +L, L, +L, +L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/rc4.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/rc4.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b6d3a4342 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/rc4.pod @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RC4_set_key, RC4 - RC4 encryption + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void RC4_set_key(RC4_KEY *key, int len, const unsigned char *data); + + void RC4(RC4_KEY *key, unsigned long len, const unsigned char *indata, + unsigned char *outdata); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +This library implements the Alleged RC4 cipher, which is described for +example in I. It is believed to be compatible +with RC4[TM], a proprietary cipher of RSA Security Inc. + +RC4 is a stream cipher with variable key length. Typically, 128 bit +(16 byte) keys are used for strong encryption, but shorter insecure +key sizes have been widely used due to export restrictions. + +RC4 consists of a key setup phase and the actual encryption or +decryption phase. + +RC4_set_key() sets up the B B using the B bytes long +key at B. + +RC4() encrypts or decrypts the B bytes of data at B using +B and places the result at B. Repeated RC4() calls with +the same B yield a continuous key stream. + +Since RC4 is a stream cipher (the input is XORed with a pseudo-random +key stream to produce the output), decryption uses the same function +calls as encryption. + +Applications should use the higher level functions +L +etc. instead of calling the RC4 functions directly. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RC4_set_key() and RC4() do not return values. + +=head1 NOTE + +Certain conditions have to be observed to securely use stream ciphers. +It is not permissible to perform multiple encryptions using the same +key stream. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RC4_set_key() and RC4() are available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ripemd.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ripemd.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..264bb99ae --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ripemd.pod @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +RIPEMD160, RIPEMD160_Init, RIPEMD160_Update, RIPEMD160_Final - +RIPEMD-160 hash function + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned char *RIPEMD160(const unsigned char *d, unsigned long n, + unsigned char *md); + + int RIPEMD160_Init(RIPEMD160_CTX *c); + int RIPEMD160_Update(RIPEMD_CTX *c, const void *data, + unsigned long len); + int RIPEMD160_Final(unsigned char *md, RIPEMD160_CTX *c); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +RIPEMD-160 is a cryptographic hash function with a +160 bit output. + +RIPEMD160() computes the RIPEMD-160 message digest of the B +bytes at B and places it in B (which must have space for +RIPEMD160_DIGEST_LENGTH == 20 bytes of output). If B is NULL, the digest +is placed in a static array. + +The following functions may be used if the message is not completely +stored in memory: + +RIPEMD160_Init() initializes a B structure. + +RIPEMD160_Update() can be called repeatedly with chunks of the message to +be hashed (B bytes at B). + +RIPEMD160_Final() places the message digest in B, which must have +space for RIPEMD160_DIGEST_LENGTH == 20 bytes of output, and erases +the B. + +Applications should use the higher level functions +L etc. instead of calling the +hash functions directly. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +RIPEMD160() returns a pointer to the hash value. + +RIPEMD160_Init(), RIPEMD160_Update() and RIPEMD160_Final() return 1 for +success, 0 otherwise. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +ISO/IEC 10118-3 (draft) (??) + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +RIPEMD160(), RIPEMD160_Init(), RIPEMD160_Update() and +RIPEMD160_Final() are available since SSLeay 0.9.0. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/rsa.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/rsa.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..45ac53ffc --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/rsa.pod @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +rsa - RSA public key cryptosystem + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + #include + + RSA * RSA_new(void); + void RSA_free(RSA *rsa); + + int RSA_public_encrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + int RSA_private_decrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa, int padding); + int RSA_private_encrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa,int padding); + int RSA_public_decrypt(int flen, unsigned char *from, + unsigned char *to, RSA *rsa,int padding); + + int RSA_sign(int type, unsigned char *m, unsigned int m_len, + unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, RSA *rsa); + int RSA_verify(int type, unsigned char *m, unsigned int m_len, + unsigned char *sigbuf, unsigned int siglen, RSA *rsa); + + int RSA_size(const RSA *rsa); + + RSA *RSA_generate_key(int num, unsigned long e, + void (*callback)(int,int,void *), void *cb_arg); + + int RSA_check_key(RSA *rsa); + + int RSA_blinding_on(RSA *rsa, BN_CTX *ctx); + void RSA_blinding_off(RSA *rsa); + + void RSA_set_default_method(const RSA_METHOD *meth); + const RSA_METHOD *RSA_get_default_method(void); + int RSA_set_method(RSA *rsa, const RSA_METHOD *meth); + const RSA_METHOD *RSA_get_method(const RSA *rsa); + RSA_METHOD *RSA_PKCS1_SSLeay(void); + RSA_METHOD *RSA_null_method(void); + int RSA_flags(const RSA *rsa); + RSA *RSA_new_method(ENGINE *engine); + + int RSA_print(BIO *bp, RSA *x, int offset); + int RSA_print_fp(FILE *fp, RSA *x, int offset); + + int RSA_get_ex_new_index(long argl, char *argp, int (*new_func)(), + int (*dup_func)(), void (*free_func)()); + int RSA_set_ex_data(RSA *r,int idx,char *arg); + char *RSA_get_ex_data(RSA *r, int idx); + + int RSA_sign_ASN1_OCTET_STRING(int dummy, unsigned char *m, + unsigned int m_len, unsigned char *sigret, unsigned int *siglen, + RSA *rsa); + int RSA_verify_ASN1_OCTET_STRING(int dummy, unsigned char *m, + unsigned int m_len, unsigned char *sigbuf, unsigned int siglen, + RSA *rsa); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +These functions implement RSA public key encryption and signatures +as defined in PKCS #1 v2.0 [RFC 2437]. + +The B structure consists of several BIGNUM components. It can +contain public as well as private RSA keys: + + struct + { + BIGNUM *n; // public modulus + BIGNUM *e; // public exponent + BIGNUM *d; // private exponent + BIGNUM *p; // secret prime factor + BIGNUM *q; // secret prime factor + BIGNUM *dmp1; // d mod (p-1) + BIGNUM *dmq1; // d mod (q-1) + BIGNUM *iqmp; // q^-1 mod p + // ... + }; + RSA + +In public keys, the private exponent and the related secret values are +B. + +B

, B, B, B and B may be B in private +keys, but the RSA operations are much faster when these values are +available. + +Note that RSA keys may use non-standard B implementations, +either directly or by the use of B modules. In some cases (eg. an +ENGINE providing support for hardware-embedded keys), these BIGNUM values +will not be used by the implementation or may be used for alternative data +storage. For this reason, applications should generally avoid using RSA +structure elements directly and instead use API functions to query or +modify keys. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +SSL, PKCS #1 v2.0 + +=head1 PATENTS + +RSA was covered by a US patent which expired in September 2000. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L, L, +L, L, L, +L, +L, L, +L, +L, +L, +L, L, +L, +L, +L, +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/sha.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/sha.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..94ab7bc72 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/sha.pod @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +SHA1, SHA1_Init, SHA1_Update, SHA1_Final - Secure Hash Algorithm + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + unsigned char *SHA1(const unsigned char *d, unsigned long n, + unsigned char *md); + + int SHA1_Init(SHA_CTX *c); + int SHA1_Update(SHA_CTX *c, const void *data, + unsigned long len); + int SHA1_Final(unsigned char *md, SHA_CTX *c); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +SHA-1 (Secure Hash Algorithm) is a cryptographic hash function with a +160 bit output. + +SHA1() computes the SHA-1 message digest of the B +bytes at B and places it in B (which must have space for +SHA_DIGEST_LENGTH == 20 bytes of output). If B is NULL, the digest +is placed in a static array. + +The following functions may be used if the message is not completely +stored in memory: + +SHA1_Init() initializes a B structure. + +SHA1_Update() can be called repeatedly with chunks of the message to +be hashed (B bytes at B). + +SHA1_Final() places the message digest in B, which must have space +for SHA_DIGEST_LENGTH == 20 bytes of output, and erases the B. + +Applications should use the higher level functions +L +etc. instead of calling the hash functions directly. + +The predecessor of SHA-1, SHA, is also implemented, but it should be +used only when backward compatibility is required. + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +SHA1() returns a pointer to the hash value. + +SHA1_Init(), SHA1_Update() and SHA1_Final() return 1 for success, 0 otherwise. + +=head1 CONFORMING TO + +SHA: US Federal Information Processing Standard FIPS PUB 180 (Secure Hash +Standard), +SHA-1: US Federal Information Processing Standard FIPS PUB 180-1 (Secure Hash +Standard), +ANSI X9.30 + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +SHA1(), SHA1_Init(), SHA1_Update() and SHA1_Final() are available in all +versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/threads.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/threads.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..3df4ecd77 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/threads.pod @@ -0,0 +1,175 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +CRYPTO_set_locking_callback, CRYPTO_set_id_callback, CRYPTO_num_locks, +CRYPTO_set_dynlock_create_callback, CRYPTO_set_dynlock_lock_callback, +CRYPTO_set_dynlock_destroy_callback, CRYPTO_get_new_dynlockid, +CRYPTO_destroy_dynlockid, CRYPTO_lock - OpenSSL thread support + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + void CRYPTO_set_locking_callback(void (*locking_function)(int mode, + int n, const char *file, int line)); + + void CRYPTO_set_id_callback(unsigned long (*id_function)(void)); + + int CRYPTO_num_locks(void); + + + /* struct CRYPTO_dynlock_value needs to be defined by the user */ + struct CRYPTO_dynlock_value; + + void CRYPTO_set_dynlock_create_callback(struct CRYPTO_dynlock_value * + (*dyn_create_function)(char *file, int line)); + void CRYPTO_set_dynlock_lock_callback(void (*dyn_lock_function) + (int mode, struct CRYPTO_dynlock_value *l, + const char *file, int line)); + void CRYPTO_set_dynlock_destroy_callback(void (*dyn_destroy_function) + (struct CRYPTO_dynlock_value *l, const char *file, int line)); + + int CRYPTO_get_new_dynlockid(void); + + void CRYPTO_destroy_dynlockid(int i); + + void CRYPTO_lock(int mode, int n, const char *file, int line); + + #define CRYPTO_w_lock(type) \ + CRYPTO_lock(CRYPTO_LOCK|CRYPTO_WRITE,type,__FILE__,__LINE__) + #define CRYPTO_w_unlock(type) \ + CRYPTO_lock(CRYPTO_UNLOCK|CRYPTO_WRITE,type,__FILE__,__LINE__) + #define CRYPTO_r_lock(type) \ + CRYPTO_lock(CRYPTO_LOCK|CRYPTO_READ,type,__FILE__,__LINE__) + #define CRYPTO_r_unlock(type) \ + CRYPTO_lock(CRYPTO_UNLOCK|CRYPTO_READ,type,__FILE__,__LINE__) + #define CRYPTO_add(addr,amount,type) \ + CRYPTO_add_lock(addr,amount,type,__FILE__,__LINE__) + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +OpenSSL can safely be used in multi-threaded applications provided +that at least two callback functions are set. + +locking_function(int mode, int n, const char *file, int line) is +needed to perform locking on shared data structures. +(Note that OpenSSL uses a number of global data structures that +will be implicitly shared whenever multiple threads use OpenSSL.) +Multi-threaded applications will crash at random if it is not set. + +locking_function() must be able to handle up to CRYPTO_num_locks() +different mutex locks. It sets the B-th lock if B & +B, and releases it otherwise. + +B and B are the file number of the function setting the +lock. They can be useful for debugging. + +id_function(void) is a function that returns a thread ID, for example +pthread_self() if it returns an integer (see NOTES below). It isn't +needed on Windows nor on platforms where getpid() returns a different +ID for each thread (see NOTES below). + +Additionally, OpenSSL supports dynamic locks, and sometimes, some parts +of OpenSSL need it for better performance. To enable this, the following +is required: + +=over 4 + +=item * +Three additional callback function, dyn_create_function, dyn_lock_function +and dyn_destroy_function. + +=item * +A structure defined with the data that each lock needs to handle. + +=back + +struct CRYPTO_dynlock_value has to be defined to contain whatever structure +is needed to handle locks. + +dyn_create_function(const char *file, int line) is needed to create a +lock. Multi-threaded applications might crash at random if it is not set. + +dyn_lock_function(int mode, CRYPTO_dynlock *l, const char *file, int line) +is needed to perform locking off dynamic lock numbered n. Multi-threaded +applications might crash at random if it is not set. + +dyn_destroy_function(CRYPTO_dynlock *l, const char *file, int line) is +needed to destroy the lock l. Multi-threaded applications might crash at +random if it is not set. + +CRYPTO_get_new_dynlockid() is used to create locks. It will call +dyn_create_function for the actual creation. + +CRYPTO_destroy_dynlockid() is used to destroy locks. It will call +dyn_destroy_function for the actual destruction. + +CRYPTO_lock() is used to lock and unlock the locks. mode is a bitfield +describing what should be done with the lock. n is the number of the +lock as returned from CRYPTO_get_new_dynlockid(). mode can be combined +from the following values. These values are pairwise exclusive, with +undefined behaviour if misused (for example, CRYPTO_READ and CRYPTO_WRITE +should not be used together): + + CRYPTO_LOCK 0x01 + CRYPTO_UNLOCK 0x02 + CRYPTO_READ 0x04 + CRYPTO_WRITE 0x08 + +=head1 RETURN VALUES + +CRYPTO_num_locks() returns the required number of locks. + +CRYPTO_get_new_dynlockid() returns the index to the newly created lock. + +The other functions return no values. + +=head1 NOTES + +You can find out if OpenSSL was configured with thread support: + + #define OPENSSL_THREAD_DEFINES + #include + #if defined(OPENSSL_THREADS) + // thread support enabled + #else + // no thread support + #endif + +Also, dynamic locks are currently not used internally by OpenSSL, but +may do so in the future. + +Defining id_function(void) has it's own issues. Generally speaking, +pthread_self() should be used, even on platforms where getpid() gives +different answers in each thread, since that may depend on the machine +the program is run on, not the machine where the program is being +compiled. For instance, Red Hat 8 Linux and earlier used +LinuxThreads, whose getpid() returns a different value for each +thread. Red Hat 9 Linux and later use NPTL, which is +Posix-conformant, and has a getpid() that returns the same value for +all threads in a process. A program compiled on Red Hat 8 and run on +Red Hat 9 will therefore see getpid() returning the same value for +all threads. + +There is still the issue of platforms where pthread_self() returns +something other than an integer. This is a bit unusual, and this +manual has no cookbook solution for that case. + +=head1 EXAMPLES + +B shows examples of the callback functions on +Solaris, Irix and Win32. + +=head1 HISTORY + +CRYPTO_set_locking_callback() and CRYPTO_set_id_callback() are +available in all versions of SSLeay and OpenSSL. +CRYPTO_num_locks() was added in OpenSSL 0.9.4. +All functions dealing with dynamic locks were added in OpenSSL 0.9.5b-dev. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ui.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ui.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..6df68d604 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ui.pod @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +UI_new, UI_new_method, UI_free, UI_add_input_string, UI_dup_input_string, +UI_add_verify_string, UI_dup_verify_string, UI_add_input_boolean, +UI_dup_input_boolean, UI_add_info_string, UI_dup_info_string, +UI_add_error_string, UI_dup_error_string, UI_construct_prompt, +UI_add_user_data, UI_get0_user_data, UI_get0_result, UI_process, +UI_ctrl, UI_set_default_method, UI_get_default_method, UI_get_method, +UI_set_method, UI_OpenSSL, ERR_load_UI_strings - New User Interface + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + + typedef struct ui_st UI; + typedef struct ui_method_st UI_METHOD; + + UI *UI_new(void); + UI *UI_new_method(const UI_METHOD *method); + void UI_free(UI *ui); + + int UI_add_input_string(UI *ui, const char *prompt, int flags, + char *result_buf, int minsize, int maxsize); + int UI_dup_input_string(UI *ui, const char *prompt, int flags, + char *result_buf, int minsize, int maxsize); + int UI_add_verify_string(UI *ui, const char *prompt, int flags, + char *result_buf, int minsize, int maxsize, const char *test_buf); + int UI_dup_verify_string(UI *ui, const char *prompt, int flags, + char *result_buf, int minsize, int maxsize, const char *test_buf); + int UI_add_input_boolean(UI *ui, const char *prompt, const char *action_desc, + const char *ok_chars, const char *cancel_chars, + int flags, char *result_buf); + int UI_dup_input_boolean(UI *ui, const char *prompt, const char *action_desc, + const char *ok_chars, const char *cancel_chars, + int flags, char *result_buf); + int UI_add_info_string(UI *ui, const char *text); + int UI_dup_info_string(UI *ui, const char *text); + int UI_add_error_string(UI *ui, const char *text); + int UI_dup_error_string(UI *ui, const char *text); + + /* These are the possible flags. They can be or'ed together. */ + #define UI_INPUT_FLAG_ECHO 0x01 + #define UI_INPUT_FLAG_DEFAULT_PWD 0x02 + + char *UI_construct_prompt(UI *ui_method, + const char *object_desc, const char *object_name); + + void *UI_add_user_data(UI *ui, void *user_data); + void *UI_get0_user_data(UI *ui); + + const char *UI_get0_result(UI *ui, int i); + + int UI_process(UI *ui); + + int UI_ctrl(UI *ui, int cmd, long i, void *p, void (*f)()); + #define UI_CTRL_PRINT_ERRORS 1 + #define UI_CTRL_IS_REDOABLE 2 + + void UI_set_default_method(const UI_METHOD *meth); + const UI_METHOD *UI_get_default_method(void); + const UI_METHOD *UI_get_method(UI *ui); + const UI_METHOD *UI_set_method(UI *ui, const UI_METHOD *meth); + + UI_METHOD *UI_OpenSSL(void); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +UI stands for User Interface, and is general purpose set of routines to +prompt the user for text-based information. Through user-written methods +(see L), prompting can be done in any way +imaginable, be it plain text prompting, through dialog boxes or from a +cell phone. + +All the functions work through a context of the type UI. This context +contains all the information needed to prompt correctly as well as a +reference to a UI_METHOD, which is an ordered vector of functions that +carry out the actual prompting. + +The first thing to do is to create a UI with UI_new() or UI_new_method(), +then add information to it with the UI_add or UI_dup functions. Also, +user-defined random data can be passed down to the underlying method +through calls to UI_add_user_data. The default UI method doesn't care +about these data, but other methods might. Finally, use UI_process() +to actually perform the prompting and UI_get0_result() to find the result +to the prompt. + +A UI can contain more than one prompt, which are performed in the given +sequence. Each prompt gets an index number which is returned by the +UI_add and UI_dup functions, and has to be used to get the corresponding +result with UI_get0_result(). + +The functions are as follows: + +UI_new() creates a new UI using the default UI method. When done with +this UI, it should be freed using UI_free(). + +UI_new_method() creates a new UI using the given UI method. When done with +this UI, it should be freed using UI_free(). + +UI_OpenSSL() returns the built-in UI method (note: not the default one, +since the default can be changed. See further on). This method is the +most machine/OS dependent part of OpenSSL and normally generates the +most problems when porting. + +UI_free() removes a UI from memory, along with all other pieces of memory +that's connected to it, like duplicated input strings, results and others. + +UI_add_input_string() and UI_add_verify_string() add a prompt to the UI, +as well as flags and a result buffer and the desired minimum and maximum +sizes of the result. The given information is used to prompt for +information, for example a password, and to verify a password (i.e. having +the user enter it twice and check that the same string was entered twice). +UI_add_verify_string() takes and extra argument that should be a pointer +to the result buffer of the input string that it's supposed to verify, or +verification will fail. + +UI_add_input_boolean() adds a prompt to the UI that's supposed to be answered +in a boolean way, with a single character for yes and a different character +for no. A set of characters that can be used to cancel the prompt is given +as well. The prompt itself is really divided in two, one part being the +descriptive text (given through the I argument) and one describing +the possible answers (given through the I argument). + +UI_add_info_string() and UI_add_error_string() add strings that are shown at +the same time as the prompt for extra information or to show an error string. +The difference between the two is only conceptual. With the builtin method, +there's no technical difference between them. Other methods may make a +difference between them, however. + +The flags currently supported are UI_INPUT_FLAG_ECHO, which is relevant for +UI_add_input_string() and will have the users response be echoed (when +prompting for a password, this flag should obviously not be used, and +UI_INPUT_FLAG_DEFAULT_PWD, which means that a default password of some +sort will be used (completely depending on the application and the UI +method). + +UI_dup_input_string(), UI_dup_verify_string(), UI_dup_input_boolean(), +UI_dup_info_string() and UI_dup_error_string() are basically the same +as their UI_add counterparts, except that they make their own copies +of all strings. + +UI_construct_prompt() is a helper function that can be used to create +a prompt from two pieces of information: an description and a name. +The default constructor (if there is none provided by the method used) +creates a string "Enter I for I:". With the +description "pass phrase" and the file name "foo.key", that becomes +"Enter pass phrase for foo.key:". Other methods may create whatever +string and may include encodings that will be processed by the other +method functions. + +UI_add_user_data() adds a piece of memory for the method to use at any +time. The builtin UI method doesn't care about this info. Note that several +calls to this function doesn't add data, it replaces the previous blob +with the one given as argument. + +UI_get0_user_data() retrieves the data that has last been given to the +UI with UI_add_user_data(). + +UI_get0_result() returns a pointer to the result buffer associated with +the information indexed by I. + +UI_process() goes through the information given so far, does all the printing +and prompting and returns. + +UI_ctrl() adds extra control for the application author. For now, it +understands two commands: UI_CTRL_PRINT_ERRORS, which makes UI_process() +print the OpenSSL error stack as part of processing the UI, and +UI_CTRL_IS_REDOABLE, which returns a flag saying if the used UI can +be used again or not. + +UI_set_default_method() changes the default UI method to the one given. + +UI_get_default_method() returns a pointer to the current default UI method. + +UI_get_method() returns the UI method associated with a given UI. + +UI_set_method() changes the UI method associated with a given UI. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 HISTORY + +The UI section was first introduced in OpenSSL 0.9.7. + +=head1 AUTHOR + +Richard Levitte (richard@levitte.org) for the OpenSSL project +(http://www.openssl.org). + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/ui_compat.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/ui_compat.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9ab3c69bf --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/ui_compat.pod @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +des_read_password, des_read_2passwords, des_read_pw_string, des_read_pw - +Compatibility user interface functions + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + int des_read_password(DES_cblock *key,const char *prompt,int verify); + int des_read_2passwords(DES_cblock *key1,DES_cblock *key2, + const char *prompt,int verify); + + int des_read_pw_string(char *buf,int length,const char *prompt,int verify); + int des_read_pw(char *buf,char *buff,int size,const char *prompt,int verify); + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +The DES library contained a few routines to prompt for passwords. These +aren't necessarely dependent on DES, and have therefore become part of the +UI compatibility library. + +des_read_pw() writes the string specified by I to standard output +turns echo off and reads an input string from the terminal. The string is +returned in I, which must have spac for at least I bytes. +If I is set, the user is asked for the password twice and unless +the two copies match, an error is returned. The second password is stored +in I, which must therefore also be at least I bytes. A return +code of -1 indicates a system error, 1 failure due to use interaction, and +0 is success. All other functions described here use des_read_pw() to do +the work. + +des_read_pw_string() is a variant of des_read_pw() that provides a buffer +for you if I is set. + +des_read_password() calls des_read_pw() and converts the password to a +DES key by calling DES_string_to_key(); des_read_2password() operates in +the same way as des_read_password() except that it generates two keys +by using the DES_string_to_2key() function. + +=head1 NOTES + +des_read_pw_string() is available in the MIT Kerberos library as well, and +is also available under the name EVP_read_pw_string(). + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, L + +=head1 AUTHOR + +Richard Levitte (richard@levitte.org) for the OpenSSL project +(http://www.openssl.org). + +=cut diff --git a/openssl/doc/crypto/x509.pod b/openssl/doc/crypto/x509.pod new file mode 100644 index 000000000..f9e58e0e4 --- /dev/null +++ b/openssl/doc/crypto/x509.pod @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +=pod + +=head1 NAME + +x509 - X.509 certificate handling + +=head1 SYNOPSIS + + #include + +=head1 DESCRIPTION + +A X.509 certificate is a structured grouping of information about +an individual, a device, or anything one can imagine. A X.509 CRL +(certificate revocation list) is a tool to help determine if a +certificate is still valid. The exact definition of those can be +found in the X.509 document from ITU-T, or in RFC3280 from PKIX. +In OpenSSL, the type X509 is used to express such a certificate, and +the type X509_CRL is used to express a CRL. + +A related structure is a certificate request, defined in PKCS#10 from +RSA Security, Inc, also reflected in RFC2896. In OpenSSL, the type +X509_REQ is used to express such a certificate request. + +To handle some complex parts of a certificate, there are the types +X509_NAME (to express a certificate name), X509_ATTRIBUTE (to express +a certificate attributes), X509_EXTENSION (to express a certificate +extension) and a few more. + +Finally, there's the supertype X509_INFO, which can contain a CRL, a +certificate and a corresponding private key. + +BI<...>, BI<...> and BI<...> handle X.509 +certificates, with some exceptions, shown below. + +BI<...>, BI<...> and BI<...> +handle X.509 CRLs. + +BI<...>, BI<...> and BI<...> +handle PKCS#10 certificate requests. + +BI<...> handle certificate names. + +BI<...> handle certificate attributes. + +BI<...> handle certificate extensions. + +=head1 SEE ALSO + +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L, +L + +=cut -- cgit v1.2.3